US9605037B2 - Recombinant host cells and nucleic acid constructs encoding polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity - Google Patents
Recombinant host cells and nucleic acid constructs encoding polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US9605037B2 US9605037B2 US15/182,170 US201615182170A US9605037B2 US 9605037 B2 US9605037 B2 US 9605037B2 US 201615182170 A US201615182170 A US 201615182170A US 9605037 B2 US9605037 B2 US 9605037B2
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- polypeptide
- seq
- enhancing activity
- cellulolytic enhancing
- polynucleotide
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Active
Links
Images
Classifications
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N9/00—Enzymes; Proenzymes; Compositions thereof; Processes for preparing, activating, inhibiting, separating or purifying enzymes
- C12N9/0004—Oxidoreductases (1.)
- C12N9/0071—Oxidoreductases (1.) acting on paired donors with incorporation of molecular oxygen (1.14)
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K14/00—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
- C07K14/37—Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from fungi
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N15/00—Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
- C12N15/09—Recombinant DNA-technology
- C12N15/63—Introduction of foreign genetic material using vectors; Vectors; Use of hosts therefor; Regulation of expression
- C12N15/79—Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts
- C12N15/82—Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts for plant cells, e.g. plant artificial chromosomes (PACs)
- C12N15/8241—Phenotypically and genetically modified plants via recombinant DNA technology
- C12N15/8242—Phenotypically and genetically modified plants via recombinant DNA technology with non-agronomic quality (output) traits, e.g. for industrial processing; Value added, non-agronomic traits
- C12N15/8243—Phenotypically and genetically modified plants via recombinant DNA technology with non-agronomic quality (output) traits, e.g. for industrial processing; Value added, non-agronomic traits involving biosynthetic or metabolic pathways, i.e. metabolic engineering, e.g. nicotine, caffeine
- C12N15/8245—Phenotypically and genetically modified plants via recombinant DNA technology with non-agronomic quality (output) traits, e.g. for industrial processing; Value added, non-agronomic traits involving biosynthetic or metabolic pathways, i.e. metabolic engineering, e.g. nicotine, caffeine involving modified carbohydrate or sugar alcohol metabolism, e.g. starch biosynthesis
- C12N15/8246—Non-starch polysaccharides, e.g. cellulose, fructans, levans
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N15/00—Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
- C12N15/09—Recombinant DNA-technology
- C12N15/63—Introduction of foreign genetic material using vectors; Vectors; Use of hosts therefor; Regulation of expression
- C12N15/79—Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts
- C12N15/82—Vectors or expression systems specially adapted for eukaryotic hosts for plant cells, e.g. plant artificial chromosomes (PACs)
- C12N15/8241—Phenotypically and genetically modified plants via recombinant DNA technology
- C12N15/8242—Phenotypically and genetically modified plants via recombinant DNA technology with non-agronomic quality (output) traits, e.g. for industrial processing; Value added, non-agronomic traits
- C12N15/8257—Phenotypically and genetically modified plants via recombinant DNA technology with non-agronomic quality (output) traits, e.g. for industrial processing; Value added, non-agronomic traits for the production of primary gene products, e.g. pharmaceutical products, interferon
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N9/00—Enzymes; Proenzymes; Compositions thereof; Processes for preparing, activating, inhibiting, separating or purifying enzymes
- C12N9/14—Hydrolases (3)
- C12N9/24—Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2)
- C12N9/2402—Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2) hydrolysing O- and S- glycosyl compounds (3.2.1)
- C12N9/2405—Glucanases
- C12N9/2434—Glucanases acting on beta-1,4-glucosidic bonds
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N9/00—Enzymes; Proenzymes; Compositions thereof; Processes for preparing, activating, inhibiting, separating or purifying enzymes
- C12N9/14—Hydrolases (3)
- C12N9/24—Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2)
- C12N9/2402—Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2) hydrolysing O- and S- glycosyl compounds (3.2.1)
- C12N9/2405—Glucanases
- C12N9/2434—Glucanases acting on beta-1,4-glucosidic bonds
- C12N9/2437—Cellulases (3.2.1.4; 3.2.1.74; 3.2.1.91; 3.2.1.150)
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N9/00—Enzymes; Proenzymes; Compositions thereof; Processes for preparing, activating, inhibiting, separating or purifying enzymes
- C12N9/14—Hydrolases (3)
- C12N9/24—Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2)
- C12N9/2402—Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2) hydrolysing O- and S- glycosyl compounds (3.2.1)
- C12N9/2405—Glucanases
- C12N9/2434—Glucanases acting on beta-1,4-glucosidic bonds
- C12N9/2445—Beta-glucosidase (3.2.1.21)
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12P—FERMENTATION OR ENZYME-USING PROCESSES TO SYNTHESISE A DESIRED CHEMICAL COMPOUND OR COMPOSITION OR TO SEPARATE OPTICAL ISOMERS FROM A RACEMIC MIXTURE
- C12P19/00—Preparation of compounds containing saccharide radicals
- C12P19/02—Monosaccharides
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12P—FERMENTATION OR ENZYME-USING PROCESSES TO SYNTHESISE A DESIRED CHEMICAL COMPOUND OR COMPOSITION OR TO SEPARATE OPTICAL ISOMERS FROM A RACEMIC MIXTURE
- C12P19/00—Preparation of compounds containing saccharide radicals
- C12P19/14—Preparation of compounds containing saccharide radicals produced by the action of a carbohydrase (EC 3.2.x), e.g. by alpha-amylase, e.g. by cellulase, hemicellulase
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12P—FERMENTATION OR ENZYME-USING PROCESSES TO SYNTHESISE A DESIRED CHEMICAL COMPOUND OR COMPOSITION OR TO SEPARATE OPTICAL ISOMERS FROM A RACEMIC MIXTURE
- C12P7/00—Preparation of oxygen-containing organic compounds
- C12P7/02—Preparation of oxygen-containing organic compounds containing a hydroxy group
- C12P7/04—Preparation of oxygen-containing organic compounds containing a hydroxy group acyclic
- C12P7/06—Ethanol, i.e. non-beverage
- C12P7/08—Ethanol, i.e. non-beverage produced as by-product or from waste or cellulosic material substrate
- C12P7/10—Ethanol, i.e. non-beverage produced as by-product or from waste or cellulosic material substrate substrate containing cellulosic material
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12P—FERMENTATION OR ENZYME-USING PROCESSES TO SYNTHESISE A DESIRED CHEMICAL COMPOUND OR COMPOSITION OR TO SEPARATE OPTICAL ISOMERS FROM A RACEMIC MIXTURE
- C12P7/00—Preparation of oxygen-containing organic compounds
- C12P7/02—Preparation of oxygen-containing organic compounds containing a hydroxy group
- C12P7/04—Preparation of oxygen-containing organic compounds containing a hydroxy group acyclic
- C12P7/06—Ethanol, i.e. non-beverage
- C12P7/14—Multiple stages of fermentation; Multiple types of microorganisms or re-use of microorganisms
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12Y—ENZYMES
- C12Y302/00—Hydrolases acting on glycosyl compounds, i.e. glycosylases (3.2)
- C12Y302/01—Glycosidases, i.e. enzymes hydrolysing O- and S-glycosyl compounds (3.2.1)
- C12Y302/01021—Beta-glucosidase (3.2.1.21)
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07K—PEPTIDES
- C07K2319/00—Fusion polypeptide
- C07K2319/01—Fusion polypeptide containing a localisation/targetting motif
- C07K2319/02—Fusion polypeptide containing a localisation/targetting motif containing a signal sequence
-
- Y—GENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y02—TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
- Y02E—REDUCTION OF GREENHOUSE GAS [GHG] EMISSIONS, RELATED TO ENERGY GENERATION, TRANSMISSION OR DISTRIBUTION
- Y02E50/00—Technologies for the production of fuel of non-fossil origin
- Y02E50/10—Biofuels, e.g. bio-diesel
-
- Y02E50/16—
-
- Y—GENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y02—TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
- Y02P—CLIMATE CHANGE MITIGATION TECHNOLOGIES IN THE PRODUCTION OR PROCESSING OF GOODS
- Y02P20/00—Technologies relating to chemical industry
- Y02P20/50—Improvements relating to the production of bulk chemicals
- Y02P20/52—Improvements relating to the production of bulk chemicals using catalysts, e.g. selective catalysts
Definitions
- the present invention relates to polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding the polypeptides.
- the invention also relates to nucleic acid constructs, vectors, and host cells comprising the polynucleotides as well as methods of producing and using the polypeptides.
- Cellulose is a polymer of the simple sugar glucose covalently linked by beta-1,4-bonds. Many microorganisms produce enzymes that hydrolyze beta-linked glucans. These enzymes include endoglucanases, cellobiohydrolases, and beta-glucosidases.
- Endoglucanases digest the cellulose polymer at random locations, opening it to attack by cellobiohydrolases.
- Cellobiohydrolases sequentially release molecules of cellobiose from the ends of the cellulose polymer.
- Cellobiose is a water-soluble beta-1,4-linked dimer of glucose. Beta-glucosidases hydrolyze cellobiose to glucose.
- lignocellulosic feedstocks into ethanol has the advantages of the ready availability of large amounts of feedstock, the desirability of avoiding burning or land filling the materials, and the cleanliness of the ethanol fuel. Wood, agricultural residues, herbaceous crops, and municipal solid wastes have been considered as feedstocks for ethanol production. These materials primarily consist of cellulose, hemicellulose, and lignin. Once the lignocellulose is converted to fermentable sugars, e.g., glucose, the fermentable sugars are easily fermented by yeast into ethanol.
- fermentable sugars e.g., glucose
- WO 2005/074647, WO 2008/148131, and WO 2011/035027 disclose isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thielavia terrestris .
- WO 2005/074656 and WO 2010/065830 disclose isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thermoascus aurantiacus .
- WO 2007/089290 discloses an isolated GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotide thereof from Trichoderma reesei .
- WO 2009/085935, WO 2009/085859, WO 2009/085864, and WO 2009/085868 disclose isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Myceliophthora thermophila .
- WO 2010/138754 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Aspergillus fumigatus .
- WO 2011/005867 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Penicillium pinophilum .
- WO 2011/039319 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thermoascus sp.
- WO 2011/041397 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Penicillium sp.
- WO 2011/041504 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thermoascus crustaceus .
- WO 2008/151043 discloses methods of increasing the activity of a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity by adding a soluble activating divalent metal cation to a composition comprising the polypeptide.
- the present invention provides GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding the polypeptides.
- the present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity selected from the group consisting of:
- polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under medium-high, high, or very high stringency conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (iii) the full-length complement of (i) or (ii);
- the present invention also relates to isolated polynucleotides encoding the polypeptides of the present invention; nucleic acid constructs; recombinant expression vectors; recombinant host cells comprising the polynucleotides; and methods of producing the polypeptides.
- the present invention also relates to methods for degrading or converting a cellulosic material, comprising: treating the cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide of the present invention.
- the present invention also relates to methods for producing a fermentation product, comprising: (a) saccharifying a cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide of the present invention; (b) fermenting the saccharified cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms to produce the fermentation product; and (c) recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
- the present invention also relates to methods of fermenting a cellulosic material, comprising: fermenting the cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms, wherein the cellulosic material is saccharified with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide of the present invention.
- the present invention also relates to a polynucleotide encoding a signal peptide comprising or consisting of amino acids 1 to 20 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 1 to 17 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 1 to 23 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 1 to 16 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 1 to 19 of SEQ ID NO: 10, which is operably linked to a gene encoding a protein; nucleic acid constructs, expression vectors, and recombinant host cells comprising the polynucleotides; and methods of producing a protein.
- FIG. 1 shows the effect of an Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide on enzymatic hydrolysis of pretreated corn stover.
- FIG. 2 shows the effect of an Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide on enzymatic hydrolysis of pretreated corn stover.
- FIG. 3 shows the effect of a Trichophaea saccata Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide on enzymatic hydrolysis of pretreated corn stover.
- FIG. 4 shows the effect of a Trichophaea saccata Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide on enzymatic hydrolysis of pretreated corn stover.
- FIG. 5 shows the effect of a Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 polypeptide on enzymatic hydrolysis of pretreated corn stover.
- Acetylxylan esterase means a carboxylesterase (EC 3.1.1.72) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of acetyl groups from polymeric xylan, acetylated xylose, acetylated glucose, alpha-napthyl acetate, and p-nitrophenyl acetate.
- acetylxylan esterase activity is determined using 0.5 mM p-nitrophenylacetate as substrate in 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5.0 containing 0.01% TWEENTM 20 (polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate).
- One unit of acetylxylan esterase is defined as the amount of enzyme capable of releasing 1 ⁇ mole of p-nitrophenolate anion per minute at pH 5, 25° C.
- allelic variant means any of two or more alternative forms of a gene occupying the same chromosomal locus. Allelic variation arises naturally through mutation, and may result in polymorphism within populations. Gene mutations can be silent (no change in the encoded polypeptide) or may encode polypeptides having altered amino acid sequences.
- An allelic variant of a polypeptide is a polypeptide encoded by an allelic variant of a gene.
- Alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase means an alpha-L-arabinofuranoside arabinofuranohydrolase (EC 3.2.1.55) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of terminal non-reducing alpha-L-arabinofuranoside residues in alpha-L-arabinosides.
- the enzyme acts on alpha-L-arabinofuranosides, alpha-L-arabinans containing (1,3)- and/or (1,5)-linkages, arabinoxylans, and arabinogalactans.
- Alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase is also known as arabinosidase, alpha-arabinosidase, alpha-L-arabinosidase, alpha-arabinofuranosidase, polysaccharide alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase, alpha-L-arabinofuranoside hydrolase, L-arabinosidase, or alpha-L-arabinanase.
- alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase activity is determined using 5 mg of medium viscosity wheat arabinoxylan (Megazyme International Ireland, Ltd., Bray, Co.
- Alpha-glucuronidase means an alpha-D-glucosiduronate glucuronohydrolase (EC 3.2.1.139) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of an alpha-D-glucuronoside to D-glucuronate and an alcohol.
- alpha-glucuronidase activity is determined according to de Vries, 1998 , J. Bacteriol. 180: 243-249.
- One unit of alpha-glucuronidase equals the amount of enzyme capable of releasing 1 ⁇ mole of glucuronic or 4-O-methylglucuronic acid per minute at pH 5, 40° C.
- Beta-glucosidase means a beta-D-glucoside glucohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.21) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of terminal non-reducing beta-D-glucose residues with the release of beta-D-glucose.
- beta-glucosidase activity is determined using p-nitrophenyl-beta-D-glucopyranoside as substrate according to the procedure of Venturi et al., 2002, Extracellular beta-D-glucosidase from Chaetomium thermophilum var. coprophilum : production, purification and some biochemical properties, J. Basic Microbiol.
- beta-glucosidase is defined as 1.0 ⁇ mole of p-nitrophenolate anion produced per minute at 25° C., pH 4.8 from 1 mM p-nitrophenyl-beta-D-glucopyranoside as substrate in 50 mM sodium citrate containing 0.01% TWEEN® 20.
- Beta-xylosidase means a beta-D-xyloside xylohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.37) that catalyzes the exo-hydrolysis of short beta (1 ⁇ 4)-xylool igosaccharides, to remove successive D-xylose residues from non-reducing termini.
- one unit of beta-xylosidase is defined as 1.0 ⁇ mole of p-nitrophenolate anion produced per minute at 40° C., pH 5 from 1 mM p-nitrophenyl-beta-D-xyloside as substrate in 100 mM sodium citrate containing 0.01% TWEEN® 20.
- Catalytic domain means the portion of an enzyme containing the catalytic machinery of the enzyme.
- Cellobiohydrolase means a 1,4-beta-D-glucan cellobiohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.91 and E.C. 3.2.1.176) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of 1,4-beta-D-glucosidic linkages in cellulose, cellooligosaccharides, or any beta-1,4-linked glucose containing polymer, releasing cellobiose from the reducing or non-reducing ends of the chain (Teeri, 1997, Crystalline cellulose degradation: New insight into the function of cellobiohydrolases, Trends in Biotechnology 15: 160-167; Teeri et al., 1998, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolases: why so efficient on crystalline cellulose?, Biochem.
- Cellulolytic enzyme or cellulase means one or more (e.g., several) enzymes that hydrolyze a cellulosic material. Such enzymes include endoglucanase(s), cellobiohydrolase(s), beta-glucosidase(s), or combinations thereof.
- the two basic approaches for measuring cellulolytic activity include: (1) measuring the total cellulolytic activity, and (2) measuring the individual cellulolytic activities (endoglucanases, cellobiohydrolases, and beta-glucosidases) as reviewed in Zhang et al., Outlook for cellulase improvement: Screening and selection strategies, 2006 , Biotechnology Advances 24: 452-481.
- Total cellulolytic activity is usually measured using insoluble substrates, including Whatman N21 filter paper, microcrystalline cellulose, bacterial cellulose, algal cellulose, cotton, pretreated lignocellulose, etc.
- the most common total cellulolytic activity assay is the filter paper assay using Whatman N21 filter paper as the substrate.
- the assay was established by the International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry (IUPAC) (Ghose, 1987, Measurement of cellulase activities, Pure Appl. Chem. 59: 257-68).
- cellulolytic enzyme activity is determined by measuring the increase in hydrolysis of a cellulosic material by cellulolytic enzyme(s) under the following conditions: 1-50 mg of cellulolytic enzyme protein/g of cellulose in PCS (or other pretreated cellulosic material) for 3-7 days at a suitable temperature, e.g., 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., compared to a control hydrolysis without addition of cellulolytic enzyme protein.
- Typical conditions are 1 ml reactions, washed or unwashed PCS, 5% insoluble solids, 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5, 1 mM MnSO 4 , 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., 72 hours, sugar analysis by AMINEX® HPX-87H column (Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc., Hercules, Calif., USA).
- Cellulose binding domain means the portion of an enzyme that mediates binding of the enzyme to amorphous regions of a cellulose substrate.
- the cellulose binding domain (CBD) is found either at the N-terminal or at the C-terminal extremity of an enzyme.
- Cellulosic material means any material containing cellulose.
- the predominant polysaccharide in the primary cell wall of biomass is cellulose, the second most abundant is hemicellulose, and the third is pectin.
- the secondary cell wall, produced after the cell has stopped growing, also contains polysaccharides and is strengthened by polymeric lignin covalently cross-linked to hemicellulose.
- Cellulose is a homopolymer of anhydrocellobiose and thus a linear beta-(1-4)-D-glucan, while hemicelluloses include a variety of compounds, such as xylans, xyloglucans, arabinoxylans, and mannans in complex branched structures with a spectrum of substituents.
- cellulose is found in plant tissue primarily as an insoluble crystalline matrix of parallel glucan chains. Hemicelluloses usually hydrogen bond to cellulose, as well as to other hemicelluloses, which help stabilize the cell wall matrix.
- Cellulose is generally found, for example, in the stems, leaves, hulls, husks, and cobs of plants or leaves, branches, and wood of trees.
- the cellulosic material can be, but is not limited to, agricultural residue, herbaceous material (including energy crops), municipal solid waste, pulp and paper mill residue, waste paper, and wood (including forestry residue) (see, for example, Wiselogel et al., 1995, in Handbook on Bioethanol (Charles E. Wyman, editor), pp.
- the cellulose may be in the form of lignocellulose, a plant cell wall material containing lignin, cellulose, and hemicellulose in a mixed matrix.
- the cellulosic material is any biomass material.
- the cellulosic material is lignocellulose, which comprises cellulose, hemicelluloses, and lignin.
- the cellulosic material is agricultural residue. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is herbaceous material (including energy crops). In another aspect, the cellulosic material is municipal solid waste. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is pulp and paper mill residue. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is waste paper. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is wood (including forestry residue).
- the cellulosic material is arundo .
- the cellulosic material is bagasse.
- the cellulosic material is bamboo.
- the cellulosic material is corn cob.
- the cellulosic material is corn fiber.
- the cellulosic material is corn stover.
- the cellulosic material is miscanthus .
- the cellulosic material is orange peel.
- the cellulosic material is rice straw.
- the cellulosic material is switchgrass.
- the cellulosic material is wheat straw.
- the cellulosic material is aspen. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is eucalyptus . In another aspect, the cellulosic material is fir. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is pine. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is poplar. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is spruce. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is willow. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is algal cellulose. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is bacterial cellulose. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is cotton linter. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is filter paper. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is microcrystalline cellulose. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is phosphoric-acid treated cellulose.
- the cellulosic material is an aquatic biomass.
- aquatic biomass means biomass produced in an aquatic environment by a photosynthesis process.
- the aquatic biomass can be algae, emergent plants, floating-leaf plants, or submerged plants.
- the cellulosic material may be used as is or may be subjected to pretreatment, using conventional methods known in the art, as described herein. In a preferred aspect, the cellulosic material is pretreated.
- cDNA means a DNA molecule that can be prepared by reverse transcription from a mature, spliced, mRNA molecule obtained from a eukaryotic or prokaryotic cell. cDNA lacks intron sequences that may be present in the corresponding genomic DNA.
- the initial, primary RNA transcript is a precursor to mRNA that is processed through a series of steps, including splicing, before appearing as mature spliced mRNA.
- Coding sequence means a polynucleotide, which directly specifies the amino acid sequence of a polypeptide.
- the boundaries of the coding sequence are generally determined by an open reading frame, which begins with a start codon such as ATG, GTG, or TTG and ends with a stop codon such as TAA, TAG, or TGA.
- the coding sequence may be a genomic DNA, cDNA, synthetic DNA, or a combination thereof.
- control sequences means nucleic acid sequences necessary for expression of a polynucleotide encoding a mature polypeptide of the present invention.
- Each control sequence may be native (i.e., from the same gene) or foreign (i.e., from a different gene) to the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide or native or foreign to each other.
- control sequences include, but are not limited to, a leader, polyadenylation sequence, propeptide sequence, promoter, signal peptide sequence, and transcription terminator.
- the control sequences include a promoter, and transcriptional and translational stop signals.
- the control sequences may be provided with linkers for the purpose of introducing specific restriction sites facilitating ligation of the control sequences with the coding region of the polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide.
- Endoglucanase means an endo-1,4-(1,3;1,4)-beta-D-glucan 4-glucanohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.4) that catalyzes endohydrolysis of 1,4-beta-D-glycosidic linkages in cellulose, cellulose derivatives (such as carboxymethyl cellulose and hydroxyethyl cellulose), lichenin, beta-1,4 bonds in mixed beta-1,3 glucans such as cereal beta-D-glucans or xyloglucans, and other plant material containing cellulosic components.
- Endoglucanase activity can be determined by measuring reduction in substrate viscosity or increase in reducing ends determined by a reducing sugar assay (Zhang et al., 2006 , Biotechnology Advances 24: 452-481). For purposes of the present invention, endoglucanase activity is determined using carboxymethyl cellulose (CMC) as substrate according to the procedure of Ghose, 1987 , Pure and Appl. Chem. 59: 257-268, at pH 5, 40° C.
- CMC carboxymethyl cellulose
- expression includes any step involved in the production of a polypeptide including, but not limited to, transcription, post-transcriptional modification, translation, post-translational modification, and secretion.
- Expression vector means a linear or circular DNA molecule that comprises a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide and is operably linked to control sequences that provide for its expression.
- Family 61 glycoside hydrolase The term “Family 61 glycoside hydrolase” or “Family GH61” or “GH61” means a polypeptide falling into the glycoside hydrolase Family 61 according to Henrissat B., 1991, A classification of glycosyl hydrolases based on amino-acid sequence similarities, Biochem. J. 280: 309-316, and Henrissat B., and Bairoch A., 1996, Updating the sequence-based classification of glycosyl hydrolases, Biochem. J. 316: 695-696. The enzymes in this family were originally classified as a glycoside hydrolase family based on measurement of very weak endo-1,4-beta-D-glucanase activity in one family member.
- Feruloyl esterase means a 4-hydroxy-3-methoxycinnamoyl-sugar hydrolase (EC 3.1.1.73) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of 4-hydroxy-3-methoxycinnamoyl (feruloyl) groups from esterified sugar, which is usually arabinose in natural biomass substrates, to produce ferulate (4-hydroxy-3-methoxycinnamate).
- Feruloyl esterase is also known as ferulic acid esterase, hydroxycinnamoyl esterase, FAE-III, cinnamoyl ester hydrolase, FAEA, cinnAE, FAE-I, or FAE-II.
- feruloyl esterase activity is determined using 0.5 mM p-nitrophenylferulate as substrate in 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5.0.
- One unit of feruloyl esterase equals the amount of enzyme capable of releasing 1 ⁇ mole of p-nitrophenolate anion per minute at pH 5, 25° C.
- fragment means a polypeptide or a domain thereof having one or more (e.g., several) amino acids absent from the amino and/or carboxyl terminus of a mature polypeptide or a domain thereof; wherein the fragment has cellulolytic enhancing activity or cellulose binding activity.
- a fragment contains at least 255 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 270 amino acid residues or at least 285 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2.
- a fragment contains at least at least 185 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 195 amino acid residues or at least 205 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4.
- a fragment contains at least 180 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 190 amino acid residues or at least 200 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6. In another aspect, a fragment contains at least 190 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 200 amino acid residues or at least 210 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 8. In another aspect, a fragment contains at least 385 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 410 amino acid residues or at least 435 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10.
- Hemicellulolytic enzyme or hemicellulase means one or more (e.g., several) enzymes that hydrolyze a hemicellulosic material. See, for example, Shallom, D. and Shoham, Y. Microbial hemicellulases. Current Opinion In Microbiology, 2003, 6(3): 219-228). Hemicellulases are key components in the degradation of plant biomass.
- hemicellulases include, but are not limited to, an acetylmannan esterase, an acetylxylan esterase, an arabinanase, an arabinofuranosidase, a coumaric acid esterase, a feruloyl esterase, a galactosidase, a glucuronidase, a glucuronoyl esterase, a mannanase, a mannosidase, a xylanase, and a xylosidase.
- the substrates of these enzymes are a heterogeneous group of branched and linear polysaccharides that are bound via hydrogen bonds to the cellulose microfibrils in the plant cell wall, crosslinking them into a robust network. Hemicelluloses are also covalently attached to lignin, forming together with cellulose a highly complex structure. The variable structure and organization of hemicelluloses require the concerted action of many enzymes for its complete degradation.
- the catalytic modules of hemicellulases are either glycoside hydrolases (GHs) that hydrolyze glycosidic bonds, or carbohydrate esterases (CEs), which hydrolyze ester linkages of acetate or ferulic acid side groups.
- GHs glycoside hydrolases
- CEs carbohydrate esterases
- catalytic modules based on homology of their primary sequence, can be assigned into GH and CE families. Some families, with an overall similar fold, can be further grouped into clans, marked alphabetically (e.g., GH-A).
- GH-A GH-A
- a most informative and updated classification of these and other carbohydrate active enzymes is available in the Carbohydrate-Active Enzymes (CAZy) database. Hemicellulolytic enzyme activities can be measured according to Ghose and Bisaria, 1987 , Pure & Appl. Chem. 59: 1739-1752, at a suitable temperature, e.g., 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., and pH, e.g., 5.0 or 5.5.
- High stringency conditions means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5 ⁇ SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2 ⁇ SSC, 0.2% SDS at 65° C.
- host cell means any cell type that is susceptible to transformation, transfection, transduction, or the like with a nucleic acid construct or expression vector comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention.
- host cell encompasses any progeny of a parent cell that is not identical to the parent cell due to mutations that occur during replication.
- Isolated means a substance in a form or environment that does not occur in nature.
- isolated substances include (1) any non-naturally occurring substance, (2) any substance including, but not limited to, any enzyme, variant, nucleic acid, protein, peptide or cofactor, that is at least partially removed from one or more or all of the naturally occurring constituents with which it is associated in nature; (3) any substance modified by the hand of man relative to that substance found in nature; or (4) any substance modified by increasing the amount of the substance relative to other components with which it is naturally associated (e.g., recombinant production in a host cell; multiple copies of a gene encoding the substance; and use of a stronger promoter than the promoter naturally associated with the gene encoding the substance).
- Low stringency conditions means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5 ⁇ SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 25% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2 ⁇ SSC, 0.2% SDS at 50° C.
- Mature polypeptide means a polypeptide in its final form following translation and any post-translational modifications, such as N-terminal processing, C-terminal truncation, glycosylation, phosphorylation, etc.
- the mature polypeptide is amino acids 21 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2 based on the SignalP program (Nielsen et al., 1997 , Protein Engineering 10: 1-6) that predicts amino acids 1 to 20 of SEQ ID NO: 2 are a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide is amino acids 18 to 234 of SEQ ID NO: 4 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 17 of SEQ ID NO: 4 are a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide is amino acids 24 to 233 of SEQ ID NO: 6 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 23 of SEQ ID NO: 6 are a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide is amino acids 17 to 237 of SEQ ID NO: 8 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 16 of SEQ ID NO: 8 are a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide is amino acids 20 to 484 of SEQ ID NO: 10 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 19 of SEQ ID NO: 10 are a signal peptide. It is known in the art that a host cell may produce a mixture of two of more different mature polypeptides (i.e., with a different C-terminal and/or N-terminal amino acid) expressed by the same polynucleotide.
- Mature polypeptide coding sequence means a polynucleotide that encodes a mature polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 61 to 966 of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra) that predicts nucleotides 1 to 60 of SEQ ID NO: 1 encode a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 52 to 702 of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 51 of SEQ ID NO: 3 encode a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 70 to 699 of SEQ ID NO: 5 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 69 of SEQ ID NO: 5 encode a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 49 to 711 of SEQ ID NO: 7 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 48 of SEQ ID NO: 7 encode a signal peptide.
- the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 58 to 1452 of SEQ ID NO: 9 based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 57 of SEQ ID NO: 9 encode a signal peptide.
- Medium stringency conditions means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5 ⁇ SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 35% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2 ⁇ SSC, 0.2% SDS at 55° C.
- Medium-high stringency conditions means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5 ⁇ SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 35% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2 ⁇ SSC, 0.2% SDS at 60° C.
- nucleic acid construct means a nucleic acid molecule, either single- or double-stranded, which is isolated from a naturally occurring gene or is modified to contain segments of nucleic acids in a manner that would not otherwise exist in nature or which is synthetic, which comprises one or more control sequences.
- operably linked means a configuration in which a control sequence is placed at an appropriate position relative to the coding sequence of a polynucleotide such that the control sequence directs expression of the coding sequence.
- Polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity means a GH61 polypeptide that catalyzes the enhancement of the hydrolysis of a cellulosic material by enzyme having cellulolytic activity.
- cellulolytic enhancing activity is determined by measuring the increase in reducing sugars or the increase of the total of cellobiose and glucose from the hydrolysis of a cellulosic material by cellulolytic enzyme under the following conditions: 1-50 mg of total protein/g of cellulose in PCS, wherein total protein is comprised of 50-99.5% w/w cellulolytic enzyme protein and 0.5-50% w/w protein of a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity for 1-7 days at a suitable temperature, e.g., 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., and pH, e.g., 5.0 or 5.5, compared to a control hydrolysis with equal total protein loading without cellulolytic enhancing activity (1-50 mg of cellulolytic protein/g of cellulose in PCS).
- a suitable temperature e.g., 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C.
- pH e.g., 5.0 or 5.5
- a mixture of CELLUCLAST® 1.5 L (Novozymes A/S, Bagsvrd, Denmark) in the presence of 2-3% of total protein weight Aspergillus oryzae beta-glucosidase (recombinantly produced in Aspergillus oryzae according to WO 02/095014) or 2-3% of total protein weight Aspergillus fumigatus beta-glucosidase (recombinantly produced in Aspergillus oryzae as described in WO 2002/095014) of cellulase protein loading is used as the source of the cellulolytic activity.
- the GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity enhance the hydrolysis of a cellulosic material catalyzed by enzyme having cellulolytic activity by reducing the amount of cellulolytic enzyme required to reach the same degree of hydrolysis preferably at least 1.01-fold, e.g., at least 1.05-fold, at least 1.10-fold, at least 1.25-fold, at least 1.5-fold, at least 2-fold, at least 3-fold, at least 4-fold, at least 5-fold, at least 10-fold, or at least 20-fold.
- polypeptides of the present invention have at least 20%, e.g., at least 40%, at least 50%, at least 60%, at least 70%, at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, and at least 100% of the cellulolytic enhancing activity of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
- Pretreated corn stover The term “PCS” or “Pretreated Corn Stover” means a cellulosic material derived from corn stover by treatment with heat and dilute sulfuric acid, alkaline pretreatment, or neutral pretreatment.
- Sequence identity The relatedness between two amino acid sequences or between two nucleotide sequences is described by the parameter “sequence identity”.
- the sequence identity between two amino acid sequences is determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970 , J. Mol. Biol. 48: 443-453) as implemented in the Needle program of the EMBOSS package (EMBOSS: The European Molecular Biology Open Software Suite, Rice et al., 2000 , Trends Genet. 16: 276-277), preferably version 5.0.0 or later.
- the parameters used are gap open penalty of 10, gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EBLOSUM62 (EMBOSS version of BLOSUM62) substitution matrix.
- sequence identity between two deoxyribonucleotide sequences is determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, supra) as implemented in the Needle program of the EMBOSS package (EMBOSS: The European Molecular Biology Open Software Suite, Rice et al., 2000, supra), preferably version 5.0.0 or later.
- the parameters used are gap open penalty of 10, gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EDNAFULL (EMBOSS version of NCBI NUC4.4) substitution matrix.
- Subsequence means a polynucleotide having one or more (e.g., several) nucleotides absent from the 5′ and/or 3′ end of a mature polypeptide coding sequence; wherein the subsequence encodes a fragment having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- a subsequence contains at least 765 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 810 or at least nucleotides 855 of SEQ ID NO: 1; or the cDNA sequence thereof.
- a subsequence contains at least 555 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 585 or at least nucleotides 615 of SEQ ID NO: 3; or the genomic DNA sequence thereof.
- a subsequence contains at least 540 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 570 or at least nucleotides 600 of SEQ ID NO: 5; or the genomic DNA sequence thereof.
- a subsequence contains at least 570 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 600 or at least nucleotides 630 of SEQ ID NO: 7; or the genomic DNA sequence thereof.
- a subsequence contains at least 1155 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 1230 or at least nucleotides 1305 of SEQ ID NO: 9.
- variant means a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprising an alteration, i.e., a substitution, insertion, and/or deletion, at one or more (e.g., several) positions.
- a substitution means replacement of the amino acid occupying a position with a different amino acid;
- a deletion means removal of the amino acid occupying a position; and
- an insertion means adding an amino acid adjacent to and immediately following the amino acid occupying a position.
- Very high stringency conditions means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5 ⁇ SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2 ⁇ SSC, 0.2% SDS at 70° C.
- Very low stringency conditions means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5 ⁇ SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 25% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2 ⁇ SSC, 0.2% SDS at 45° C.
- xylan degrading activity or xylanolytic activity means a biological activity that hydrolyzes xylan-containing material.
- the two basic approaches for measuring xylanolytic activity include: (1) measuring the total xylanolytic activity, and (2) measuring the individual xylanolytic activities (e.g., endoxylanases, beta-xylosidases, arabinofuranosidases, alpha-glucuronidases, acetylxylan esterases, feruloyl esterases, and alpha-glucuronyl esterases).
- Total xylan degrading activity can be measured by determining the reducing sugars formed from various types of xylan, including, for example, oat spelt, beechwood, and larchwood xylans, or by photometric determination of dyed xylan fragments released from various covalently dyed xylans.
- the most common total xylanolytic activity assay is based on production of reducing sugars from polymeric 4-O-methyl glucuronoxylan as described in Bailey, Biely, Poutanen, 1992, Interlaboratory testing of methods for assay of xylanase activity, Journal of Biotechnology 23(3): 257-270.
- Xylanase activity can also be determined with 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 0.01% TRITON® X-100 (4-(1,1,3,3-tetramethylbutyl)phenyl-polyethylene glycol) and 200 mM sodium phosphate buffer pH 6 at 37° C.
- TRITON® X-100 (4-(1,1,3,3-tetramethylbutyl)phenyl-polyethylene glycol)
- 200 mM sodium phosphate buffer pH 6 at 37° C.
- One unit of xylanase activity is defined as 1.0 ⁇ mole of azurine produced per minute at 37° C., pH 6 from 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 200 mM sodium phosphate pH 6 buffer.
- xylan degrading activity is determined by measuring the increase in hydrolysis of birchwood xylan (Sigma Chemical Co., Inc., St. Louis, Mo., USA) by xylan-degrading enzyme(s) under the following typical conditions: 1 ml reactions, 5 mg/ml substrate (total solids), 5 mg of xylanolytic protein/g of substrate, 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5, 50° C., 24 hours, sugar analysis using p-hydroxybenzoic acid hydrazide (PHBAH) assay as described by Lever, 1972, A new reaction for colorimetric determination of carbohydrates, Anal. Biochem 47: 273-279.
- PBAH p-hydroxybenzoic acid hydrazide
- xylanase means a 1,4-beta-D-xylan-xylohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.8) that catalyzes the endohydrolysis of 1,4-beta-D-xylosidic linkages in xylans.
- xylanase activity is determined with 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 0.01% TRITON® X-100 and 200 mM sodium phosphate buffer pH 6 at 37° C.
- One unit of xylanase activity is defined as 1.0 ⁇ mole of azurine produced per minute at 37° C., pH 6 from 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 200 mM sodium phosphate pH 6 buffer.
- the present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having a sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6 or SEQ ID NO: 8 of at least 60%, e.g., at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4 of at least 65%, e.g., at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10 of at least 70%, e.g., at least 75%, at least 80%,
- polypeptides differ by up to 10 amino acids, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10, from the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
- a polypeptide of the present invention preferably comprises or consists of the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 or an allelic variant thereof; or is a fragment thereof having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the polypeptide comprises or consists of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
- the polypeptide comprises or consists of amino acids 21 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 18 to 234 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 24 to 233 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 17 to 237 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 20 to 484 of SEQ ID NO: 10.
- the present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity that are encoded by polynucleotides that hybridize under very low stringency conditions, low stringency conditions, medium stringency conditions, medium-high stringency conditions, high stringency conditions, or very high stringency conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (iii) the full-length complement of (i) or (ii) (Sambrook et al., 1989 , Molecular Cloning, A Laboratory Manual, 2d edition, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y.)
- polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, or a subsequence thereof, as well as the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10, or a fragment thereof, may be used to design nucleic acid probes to identify and clone DNA encoding polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity from strains of different genera or species according to methods well known in the art.
- probes can be used for hybridization with the genomic DNA or cDNA of a cell of interest, following standard Southern blotting procedures, in order to identify and isolate the corresponding gene therein.
- probes can be considerably shorter than the entire sequence, but should be at least 15, e.g., at least 25, at least 35, or at least 70 nucleotides in length.
- the nucleic acid probe is at least 100 nucleotides in length, e.g., at least 200 nucleotides, at least 300 nucleotides, at least 400 nucleotides, at least 500 nucleotides, at least 600 nucleotides, at least 700 nucleotides, at least 800 nucleotides, or at least 900 nucleotides in length.
- Both DNA and RNA probes can be used.
- the probes are typically labeled for detecting the corresponding gene (for example, with 32 P, 3 H, 35 S, biotin, or avidin). Such probes are encompassed by the present invention.
- a genomic DNA or cDNA library prepared from such other strains may be screened for DNA that hybridizes with the probes described above and encodes a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- Genomic or other DNA from such other strains may be separated by agarose or polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis, or other separation techniques.
- DNA from the libraries or the separated DNA may be transferred to and immobilized on nitrocellulose or other suitable carrier material.
- the carrier material is preferably used in a Southern blot.
- hybridization indicates that the polynucleotide hybridizes to a labeled nucleic acid probe corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9; the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9; the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1; or a full-length complement thereof; or a subsequence thereof; under very low to very high stringency conditions.
- Molecules to which the nucleic acid probe hybridizes under these conditions can be detected using, for example, X-ray film or any other detection means known in the art.
- the nucleic acid probe is a polynucleotide that encodes the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10; the mature polypeptide thereof; or a fragment thereof.
- the nucleic acid probe is SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof, SEQ ID NO: 9, or SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof.
- the present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity encoded by polynucleotides having a sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 5 or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof, of at least 60%, e.g., at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof, of at least 65%, e.g., at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least at least 99%
- the present invention relates to variants of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 comprising a substitution, deletion, and/or insertion at one or more (e.g., several) positions.
- the number of amino acid substitutions, deletions and/or insertions introduced into the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 is up to 10, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
- amino acid changes may be of a minor nature, that is conservative amino acid substitutions or insertions that do not significantly affect the folding and/or activity of the protein; small deletions, typically of 1-30 amino acids; small amino- or carboxyl-terminal extensions, such as an amino-terminal methionine residue; a small linker peptide of up to 20-25 residues; or a small extension that facilitates purification by changing net charge or another function, such as a poly-histidine tract, an antigenic epitope or a binding domain.
- conservative substitutions are within the groups of basic amino acids (arginine, lysine and histidine), acidic amino acids (glutamic acid and aspartic acid), polar amino acids (glutamine and asparagine), hydrophobic amino acids (leucine, isoleucine and valine), aromatic amino acids (phenylalanine, tryptophan and tyrosine), and small amino acids (glycine, alanine, serine, threonine and methionine).
- Amino acid substitutions that do not generally alter specific activity are known in the art and are described, for example, by H. Neurath and R. L. Hill, 1979 , In, The Proteins , Academic Press, New York.
- amino acid changes are of such a nature that the physico-chemical properties of the polypeptides are altered.
- amino acid changes may improve the thermal stability of the polypeptide, alter the substrate specificity, change the pH optimum, and the like.
- Essential amino acids in a polypeptide can be identified according to procedures known in the art, such as site-directed mutagenesis or alanine-scanning mutagenesis (Cunningham and Wells, 1989 , Science 244: 1081-1085). In the latter technique, single alanine mutations are introduced at every residue in the molecule, and the resultant mutant molecules are tested for cellulolytic enhancing activity to identify amino acid residues that are critical to the activity of the molecule. See also, Hilton et al., 1996 , J. Biol. Chem. 271: 4699-4708.
- the active site of the enzyme or other biological interaction can also be determined by physical analysis of structure, as determined by such techniques as nuclear magnetic resonance, crystallography, electron diffraction, or photoaffinity labeling, in conjunction with mutation of putative contact site amino acids. See, for example, de Vos et al., 1992 , Science 255: 306-312; Smith et al., 1992 , J. Mol. Biol. 224: 899-904; Wlodaver et al., 1992 , FEBS Lett. 309: 59-64.
- the identity of essential amino acids can also be inferred from an alignment with a related polypeptide.
- Single or multiple amino acid substitutions, deletions, and/or insertions can be made and tested using known methods of mutagenesis, recombination, and/or shuffling, followed by a relevant screening procedure, such as those disclosed by Reidhaar-Olson and Sauer, 1988, Science 241: 53-57; Bowie and Sauer, 1989 , Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 86: 2152-2156; WO 95/17413; or WO 95/22625.
- Other methods that can be used include error-prone PCR, phage display (e.g., Lowman et al., 1991 , Biochemistry 30: 10832-10837; U.S. Pat. No. 5,223,409; WO 92/06204), and region-directed mutagenesis (Derbyshire et al., 1986 , Gene 46: 145; Ner et al., 1988 , DNA 7: 127).
- Mutagenesis/shuffling methods can be combined with high-throughput, automated screening methods to detect activity of cloned, mutagenized polypeptides expressed by host cells (Ness et al., 1999 , Nature Biotechnology 17: 893-896). Mutagenized DNA molecules that encode active polypeptides can be recovered from the host cells and rapidly sequenced using standard methods in the art. These methods allow the rapid determination of the importance of individual amino acid residues in a polypeptide.
- the polypeptide may be a hybrid polypeptide in which a region of one polypeptide is fused at the N-terminus or the C-terminus of a region of another polypeptide.
- the polypeptide may be a fusion polypeptide or cleavable fusion polypeptide in which another polypeptide is fused at the N-terminus or the C-terminus of the polypeptide of the present invention.
- a fusion polypeptide is produced by fusing a polynucleotide encoding another polypeptide to a polynucleotide of the present invention.
- Techniques for producing fusion polypeptides are known in the art, and include ligating the coding sequences encoding the polypeptides so that they are in frame and that expression of the fusion polypeptide is under control of the same promoter(s) and terminator.
- Fusion polypeptides may also be constructed using intein technology in which fusion polypeptides are created post-translationally (Cooper et al., 1993 , EMBO J. 12: 2575-2583; Dawson et al., 1994 , Science 266: 776-779).
- a fusion polypeptide can further comprise a cleavage site between the two polypeptides. Upon secretion of the fusion protein, the site is cleaved releasing the two polypeptides.
- cleavage sites include, but are not limited to, the sites disclosed in Martin et al., 2003 , J. Ind. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 3: 568-576; Svetina et al., 2000 , J. Biotechnol. 76: 245-251; Rasmussen-Wilson et al., 1997 , Appl. Environ. Microbiol.
- a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention may be obtained from microorganisms of any genus.
- the term “obtained from” as used herein in connection with a given source shall mean that the polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide is produced by the source or by a strain in which the polynucleotide from the source has been inserted.
- the polypeptide obtained from a given source is secreted extracellularly.
- the polypeptide may be a fungal polypeptide.
- the polypeptide may be a yeast polypeptide such as a Candida, Kluyveromyces, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Schizosaccharomyces , or Yarrowia polypeptide; or a filamentous fungal polypeptide such as an Acremonium, Agaricus, Alternaria, Aspergillus, Aureobasidium, Botryosphaeria, Ceriporiopsis, Chaetomidium, Chrysosporium, Claviceps, Cochliobolus, Coprinopsis, Coptotermes, Corynascus, Cryphonectria, Cryptococcus, Diplodia, Exidia, Filibasidium, Fusarium, Gibberella, Holomastigotoides, Humicola, Irpex, Lentinula , Leptospaeria, Magnaporthe, Melanocarpus, Meripilus, Mucor, Myceli
- the polypeptide is a Saccharomyces carlsbergensis, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Saccharomyces diastaticus, Saccharomyces douglasii, Saccharomyces kluyveri, Saccharomyces norbensis , or Saccharomyces oviformis polypeptide.
- the polypeptide is an Acremonium cellulolyticus, Aspergillus aculeatus, Aspergillus awamori, Aspergillus foetidus, Aspergillus fumigatus, Aspergillus japonicus, Aspergillus nidulans, Aspergillus niger, Aspergillus oryzae, Chrysosporium inops, Chrysosporium keratinophilum, Chrysosporium lucknowense, Chrysosporium merdarium, Chrysosporium pannicola, Chrysosporium queenslandicum, Chrysosporium tropicum, Chrysosporium zonatum, Fusarium bactridioides, Fusarium cerealis, Fusarium crookwellense, Fusarium culmorum, Fusarium graminearum, Fusarium graminum, Fusarium heterosporum, Fusa
- the polypeptide is an Aurantiporus alborubescens polypeptide, e.g., a polypeptide obtained from Aurantiporus alborubescens NN008024.
- the polypeptide is an Trichophaea saccata polypeptide, e.g., a polypeptide obtained from Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70.
- the polypeptide is a Penicillium thomii polypeptide, e.g., a polypeptide obtained from Penicillium thomii IBT 10776.
- ATCC American Type Culture Collection
- DSMZ Deutsche Sammlung von Mikroorganismen and Zellkulturen GmbH
- CBS Centraalbureau Voor Schimmelcultures
- NRRL Northern Regional Research Center
- the polypeptide may be identified and obtained from other sources including microorganisms isolated from nature (e.g., soil, composts, water, etc.) or DNA samples obtained directly from natural materials (e.g., soil, composts, water, etc.) using the above-mentioned probes. Techniques for isolating microorganisms and DNA directly from natural habitats are well known in the art. A polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide may then be obtained by similarly screening a genomic DNA or cDNA library of another microorganism or mixed DNA sample.
- the polynucleotide can be isolated or cloned by utilizing techniques that are known to those of ordinary skill in the art (see, e.g., Sambrook et al., 1989, supra).
- the present invention also relates to isolated polynucleotides encoding polypeptides of the present invention, as described herein.
- the techniques used to isolate or clone a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide include isolation from genomic DNA or cDNA, or a combination thereof.
- the cloning of the polynucleotides from genomic DNA can be effected, e.g., by using the well known polymerase chain reaction (PCR) or antibody screening of expression libraries to detect cloned DNA fragments with shared structural features. See, e.g., Innis et al., 1990, PCR: A Guide to Methods and Application , Academic Press, New York.
- LCR ligase chain reaction
- LAT ligation activated transcription
- NASBA polynucleotide-based amplification
- the polynucleotides may be cloned from a strain of Aurantiporus, Trichophaea , or Penicillium , or a related organism and thus, for example, may be an allelic or species variant of the polypeptide encoding region of the polynucleotide.
- Modification of a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide of the present invention may be necessary for synthesizing polypeptides substantially similar to the polypeptide.
- the term “substantially similar” to the polypeptide refers to non-naturally occurring forms of the polypeptide.
- These polypeptides may differ in some engineered way from the polypeptide isolated from its native source, e.g., variants that differ in specific activity, thermostability, pH optimum, or the like.
- the variants may be constructed on the basis of the polynucleotide presented as the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof, SEQ ID NO: 9, or SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA thereof, e.g., a subsequence thereof, and/or by introduction of nucleotide substitutions that do not result in a change in the amino acid sequence of the polypeptide, but which correspond to the codon usage of the host organism intended for production of the enzyme, or by introduction of nucleotide substitutions that may give rise to a different amino acid sequence.
- nucleotide substitution see, e.g., Ford et al., 1991 , Protein Expression and Purification 2: 95-107.
- the present invention also relates to nucleic acid constructs comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the expression of the coding sequence in a suitable host cell under conditions compatible with the control sequences.
- the polynucleotide may be manipulated in a variety of ways to provide for expression of the polypeptide. Manipulation of the polynucleotide prior to its insertion into a vector may be desirable or necessary depending on the expression vector. The techniques for modifying polynucleotides utilizing recombinant DNA methods are well known in the art.
- the control sequence may be a promoter, a polynucleotide that is recognized by a host cell for expression of a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide of the present invention.
- the promoter contains transcriptional control sequences that mediate the expression of the polypeptide.
- the promoter may be any polynucleotide that shows transcriptional activity in the host cell including mutant, truncated, and hybrid promoters, and may be obtained from genes encoding extracellular or intracellular polypeptides either homologous or heterologous to the host cell.
- suitable promoters for directing transcription of the nucleic acid constructs of the present invention in a bacterial host cell are the promoters obtained from the Bacillus amyloliquefaciens alpha-amylase gene (amyQ), Bacillus licheniformis alpha-amylase gene (amyL), Bacillus licheniformis penicillinase gene (penP), Bacillus stearothermophilus maltogenic amylase gene (amyM), Bacillus subtilis levansucrase gene (sacB), Bacillus subtilis xylA and xylB genes, Bacillus thuringiensis cryIIIA gene (Agaisse and Lereclus, 1994 , Molecular Microbiology 13: 97-107), E.
- E. coli lac operon E. coli trc promoter (Egon et al., 1988 , Gene 69: 301-315), Streptomyces coelicolor agarase gene (dagA), and prokaryotic beta-lactamase gene (Villa-Kamaroff et al., 1978 , Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci . USA 75: 3727-3731), as well as the tac promoter (DeBoer et al., 1983 , Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 80: 21-25).
- promoters for directing transcription of the nucleic acid constructs of the present invention in a filamentous fungal host cell are promoters obtained from the genes for Aspergillus nidulans acetamidase, Aspergillus niger neutral alpha-amylase, Aspergillus niger acid stable alpha-amylase, Aspergillus niger or Aspergillus awamori glucoamylase (glaA), Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, Aspergillus oryzae alkaline protease, Aspergillus oryzae triose phosphate isomerase, Fusarium oxysporum trypsin-like protease (WO 96/00787), Fusarium venenatum amyloglucosidase (WO 00/56900), Fusarium venenatum Dania (WO 00/56900), Fusarium venenatum Quinn
- useful promoters are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase (ENO-1), Saccharomyces cerevisiae galactokinase (GAL1), Saccharomyces cerevisiae alcohol dehydrogenase/glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase (ADH1, ADH2/GAP), Saccharomyces cerevisiae triose phosphate isomerase (TPI), Saccharomyces cerevisiae metallothionein (CUP1), and Saccharomyces cerevisiae 3-phosphoglycerate kinase.
- ENO-1 Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase
- GAL1 Saccharomyces cerevisiae galactokinase
- ADH1, ADH2/GAP Saccharomyces cerevisiae triose phosphate isomerase
- TPI Saccharomyces cerevisiae metallothionein
- the control sequence may also be a transcription terminator, which is recognized by a host cell to terminate transcription.
- the terminator is operably linked to the 3′-terminus of the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide. Any terminator that is functional in the host cell may be used in the present invention.
- Preferred terminators for bacterial host cells are obtained from the genes for Bacillus clausii alkaline protease (aprH), Bacillus licheniformis alpha-amylase (amyL), and Escherichia coli ribosomal RNA (rrnB).
- Preferred terminators for filamentous fungal host cells are obtained from the genes for Aspergillus nidulans acetamidase, Aspergillus nidulans anthranilate synthase, Aspergillus niger glucoamylase, Aspergillus niger alpha-glucosidase, Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, Fusarium oxysporum trypsin-like protease, Trichoderma reesei beta-glucosidase, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase I, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase II, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase I, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase II, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase Ill, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase V, Trichoderma re
- Preferred terminators for yeast host cells are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase, Saccharomyces cerevisiae cytochrome C (CYC1), and Saccharomyces cerevisiae glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase.
- Other useful terminators for yeast host cells are described by Romanos et al., 1992, supra.
- control sequence may also be an mRNA stabilizer region downstream of a promoter and upstream of the coding sequence of a gene which increases expression of the gene.
- mRNA stabilizer regions are obtained from a Bacillus thuringiensis cryIIIA gene (WO 94/25612) and a Bacillus subtilis SP82 gene (Hue et al., 1995 , Journal of Bacteriology 177: 3465-3471).
- the control sequence may also be a leader, a nontranslated region of an mRNA that is important for translation by the host cell.
- the leader is operably linked to the 5′-terminus of the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide. Any leader that is functional in the host cell may be used.
- Preferred leaders for filamentous fungal host cells are obtained from the genes for Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase and Aspergillus nidulans triose phosphate isomerase.
- Suitable leaders for yeast host cells are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase (ENO-1), Saccharomyces cerevisiae 3-phosphoglycerate kinase, Saccharomyces cerevisiae alpha-factor, and Saccharomyces cerevisiae alcohol dehydrogenase/glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase (ADH2/GAP).
- ENO-1 Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase
- Saccharomyces cerevisiae 3-phosphoglycerate kinase Saccharomyces cerevisiae alpha-factor
- Saccharomyces cerevisiae alcohol dehydrogenase/glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase ADH2/GAP
- the control sequence may also be a polyadenylation sequence, a sequence operably linked to the 3′-terminus of the polynucleotide and, when transcribed, is recognized by the host cell as a signal to add polyadenosine residues to transcribed mRNA. Any polyadenylation sequence that is functional in the host cell may be used.
- Preferred polyadenylation sequences for filamentous fungal host cells are obtained from the genes for Aspergillus nidulans anthranilate synthase, Aspergillus niger glucoamylase, Aspergillus niger alpha-glucosidase Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, and Fusarium oxysporum trypsin-like protease.
- yeast host cells Useful polyadenylation sequences for yeast host cells are described by Guo and Sherman, 1995 , Mol. Cellular Biol. 15: 5983-5990.
- the control sequence may also be a signal peptide coding region that encodes a signal peptide linked to the N-terminus of a polypeptide and directs the polypeptide into the cell's secretory pathway.
- the 5′-end of the coding sequence of the polynucleotide may inherently contain a signal peptide coding sequence naturally linked in translation reading frame with the segment of the coding sequence that encodes the polypeptide.
- the 5′-end of the coding sequence may contain a signal peptide coding sequence that is foreign to the coding sequence.
- a foreign signal peptide coding sequence may be required where the coding sequence does not naturally contain a signal peptide coding sequence.
- a foreign signal peptide coding sequence may simply replace the natural signal peptide coding sequence in order to enhance secretion of the polypeptide.
- any signal peptide coding sequence that directs the expressed polypeptide into the secretory pathway of a host cell may be used.
- Effective signal peptide coding sequences for bacterial host cells are the signal peptide coding sequences obtained from the genes for Bacillus NCIB 11837 maltogenic amylase, Bacillus licheniformis subtilisin, Bacillus licheniformis beta-lactamase, Bacillus stearothermophilus alpha-amylase, Bacillus stearothermophilus neutral proteases (nprT, nprS, nprM), and Bacillus subtilis prsA. Further signal peptides are described by Simonen and Palva, 1993, Microbiological Reviews 57: 109-137.
- Effective signal peptide coding sequences for filamentous fungal host cells are the signal peptide coding sequences obtained from the genes for Aspergillus niger neutral amylase, Aspergillus niger glucoamylase, Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, Humicola insolens cellulase, Humicola insolens endoglucanase V, Humicola lanuginosa lipase, and Rhizomucor miehei aspartic proteinase.
- Useful signal peptides for yeast host cells are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae alpha-factor and Saccharomyces cerevisiae invertase. Other useful signal peptide coding sequences are described by Romanos et al., 1992, supra.
- the control sequence may also be a propeptide coding sequence that encodes a propeptide positioned at the N-terminus of a polypeptide.
- the resultant polypeptide is known as a proenzyme or propolypeptide (or a zymogen in some cases).
- a propolypeptide is generally inactive and can be converted to an active polypeptide by catalytic or autocatalytic cleavage of the propeptide from the propolypeptide.
- the propeptide coding sequence may be obtained from the genes for Bacillus subtilis alkaline protease (aprE), Bacillus subtilis neutral protease (nprT), Myceliophthora thermophila laccase (WO 95/33836), Rhizomucor miehei aspartic proteinase, and Saccharomyces cerevisiae alpha-factor.
- the propeptide sequence is positioned next to the N-terminus of a polypeptide and the signal peptide sequence is positioned next to the N-terminus of the propeptide sequence.
- regulatory sequences that regulate expression of the polypeptide relative to the growth of the host cell.
- regulatory sequences are those that cause expression of the gene to be turned on or off in response to a chemical or physical stimulus, including the presence of a regulatory compound.
- Regulatory sequences in prokaryotic systems include the lac, tac, and trp operator systems.
- yeast the ADH2 system or GAL1 system may be used.
- the Aspergillus niger glucoamylase promoter In filamentous fungi, the Aspergillus niger glucoamylase promoter, Aspergillus oryzae TAKA alpha-amylase promoter, and Aspergillus oryzae glucoamylase promoter, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase I promoter, and Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase II promoter may be used.
- Other examples of regulatory sequences are those that allow for gene amplification. In eukaryotic systems, these regulatory sequences include the dihydrofolate reductase gene that is amplified in the presence of methotrexate, and the metallothionein genes that are amplified with heavy metals. In these cases, the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide would be operably linked to the regulatory sequence.
- the present invention also relates to recombinant expression vectors comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention, a promoter, and transcriptional and translational stop signals.
- the various nucleotide and control sequences may be joined together to produce a recombinant expression vector that may include one or more convenient restriction sites to allow for insertion or substitution of the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide at such sites.
- the polynucleotide may be expressed by inserting the polynucleotide or a nucleic acid construct comprising the polynucleotide into an appropriate vector for expression.
- the coding sequence is located in the vector so that the coding sequence is operably linked with the appropriate control sequences for expression.
- the recombinant expression vector may be any vector (e.g., a plasmid or virus) that can be conveniently subjected to recombinant DNA procedures and can bring about expression of the polynucleotide.
- the choice of the vector will typically depend on the compatibility of the vector with the host cell into which the vector is to be introduced.
- the vector may be a linear or closed circular plasmid.
- the vector may be an autonomously replicating vector, i.e., a vector that exists as an extrachromosomal entity, the replication of which is independent of chromosomal replication, e.g., a plasmid, an extrachromosomal element, a minichromosome, or an artificial chromosome.
- the vector may contain any means for assuring self-replication.
- the vector may be one that, when introduced into the host cell, is integrated into the genome and replicated together with the chromosome(s) into which it has been integrated.
- a single vector or plasmid or two or more vectors or plasmids that together contain the total DNA to be introduced into the genome of the host cell, or a transposon may be used.
- the vector preferably contains one or more selectable markers that permit easy selection of transformed, transfected, transduced, or the like cells.
- a selectable marker is a gene the product of which provides for biocide or viral resistance, resistance to heavy metals, prototrophy to auxotrophs, and the like.
- bacterial selectable markers are Bacillus licheniformis or Bacillus subtilis dal genes, or markers that confer antibiotic resistance such as ampicillin, chloramphenicol, kanamycin, neomycin, spectinomycin, or tetracycline resistance.
- Suitable markers for yeast host cells include, but are not limited to, ADE2, HIS3, LEU2, LYS2, MET3, TRP1, and URA3.
- Selectable markers for use in a filamentous fungal host cell include, but are not limited to, adeA (phosphoribosylam inoimidazole-succinocarboxam ide synthase), adeB (phosphoribosyl-aminoimidazole synthase), amdS (acetamidase), argB (ornithine carbamoyltransferase), bar (phosphinothricin acetyltransferase), hph (hygromycin phosphotransferase), niaD (nitrate reductase), pyrG (orotidine-5′-phosphate decarboxylase), sC (sulfate adenyltransferase), and trpC (anthranilate synthase), as well as equivalents thereof.
- adeA phosphoribosylam inoimidazole-succinocarboxam ide synthase
- Preferred for use in a Trichoderma cell are adeA, adeB, amdS, hph, and pyrG genes.
- the selectable marker may be a dual selectable marker system as described in WO 2010/039889.
- the dual selectable marker is a hph-tk dual selectable marker system.
- the vector preferably contains an element(s) that permits integration of the vector into the host cell's genome or autonomous replication of the vector in the cell independent of the genome.
- the vector may rely on the polynucleotide's sequence encoding the polypeptide or any other element of the vector for integration into the genome by homologous or non-homologous recombination.
- the vector may contain additional polynucleotides for directing integration by homologous recombination into the genome of the host cell at a precise location(s) in the chromosome(s).
- the integrational elements should contain a sufficient number of nucleic acids, such as 100 to 10,000 base pairs, 400 to 10,000 base pairs, and 800 to 10,000 base pairs, which have a high degree of sequence identity to the corresponding target sequence to enhance the probability of homologous recombination.
- the integrational elements may be any sequence that is homologous with the target sequence in the genome of the host cell. Furthermore, the integrational elements may be non-encoding or encoding polynucleotides. On the other hand, the vector may be integrated into the genome of the host cell by non-homologous recombination.
- the vector may further comprise an origin of replication enabling the vector to replicate autonomously in the host cell in question.
- the origin of replication may be any plasmid replicator mediating autonomous replication that functions in a cell.
- the term “origin of replication” or “plasmid replicator” means a polynucleotide that enables a plasmid or vector to replicate in vivo.
- bacterial origins of replication are the origins of replication of plasmids pBR322, pUC19, pACYC177, and pACYC184 permitting replication in E. coli , and pUB110, pE194, pTA1060, and pAM ⁇ 1 permitting replication in Bacillus.
- origins of replication for use in a yeast host cell are the 2 micron origin of replication, ARS1, ARS4, the combination of ARS1 and CEN3, and the combination of ARS4 and CEN6.
- AMA1 and ANSI examples of origins of replication useful in a filamentous fungal cell are AMA1 and ANSI (Gems et al., 1991 , Gene 98: 61-67; Cullen et al., 1987 , Nucleic Acids Res. 15: 9163-9175; WO 00/24883). Isolation of the AMA1 gene and construction of plasmids or vectors comprising the gene can be accomplished according to the methods disclosed in WO 00/24883.
- More than one copy of a polynucleotide of the present invention may be inserted into a host cell to increase production of a polypeptide.
- An increase in the copy number of the polynucleotide can be obtained by integrating at least one additional copy of the sequence into the host cell genome or by including an amplifiable selectable marker gene with the polynucleotide where cells containing amplified copies of the selectable marker gene, and thereby additional copies of the polynucleotide, can be selected for by cultivating the cells in the presence of the appropriate selectable agent.
- the present invention also relates to recombinant host cells, comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the production of a polypeptide of the present invention.
- a construct or vector comprising a polynucleotide is introduced into a host cell so that the construct or vector is maintained as a chromosomal integrant or as a self-replicating extra-chromosomal vector as described earlier.
- the term “host cell” encompasses any progeny of a parent cell that is not identical to the parent cell due to mutations that occur during replication. The choice of a host cell will to a large extent depend upon the gene encoding the polypeptide and its source.
- the host cell may be any cell useful in the recombinant production of a polypeptide of the present invention, e.g., a prokaryote or a eukaryote.
- the prokaryotic host cell may be any Gram-positive or Gram-negative bacterium.
- Gram-positive bacteria include, but are not limited to, Bacillus, Clostridium, Enterococcus, Geobacillus, Lactobacillus, Lactococcus, Oceanobacillus, Staphylococcus, Streptococcus , and Streptomyces .
- Gram-negative bacteria include, but are not limited to, Campylobacter, E. coli, Flavobacterium, Fusobacterium, Helicobacter, Ilyobacter, Neisseria, Pseudomonas, Salmonella , and Ureaplasma.
- the bacterial host cell may be any Bacillus cell including, but not limited to, Bacillus alkalophilus, Bacillus amyloliquefaciens, Bacillus brevis, Bacillus circulans, Bacillus clausii, Bacillus coagulans, Bacillus firmus, Bacillus lautus, Bacillus lentus, Bacillus licheniformis, Bacillus megaterium, Bacillus pumilus, Bacillus stearothermophilus, Bacillus subtilis , and Bacillus thuringiensis cells.
- Bacillus alkalophilus Bacillus amyloliquefaciens
- Bacillus brevis Bacillus circulans
- Bacillus clausii Bacillus coagulans
- Bacillus firmus Bacillus lautus
- Bacillus lentus Bacillus licheniformis
- Bacillus megaterium Bacillus pumilus
- Bacillus stearothermophilus Bacillus subtilis
- the bacterial host cell may also be any Streptococcus cell including, but not limited to, Streptococcus equisimilis, Streptococcus pyogenes, Streptococcus uberis , and Streptococcus equi subsp. Zooepidemicus cells.
- the bacterial host cell may also be any Streptomyces cell including, but not limited to, Streptomyces achromogenes, Streptomyces avermitilis, Streptomyces coelicolor, Streptomyces griseus , and Streptomyces lividans cells.
- the introduction of DNA into a Bacillus cell may be effected by protoplast transformation (see, e.g., Chang and Cohen, 1979 , Mol. Gen. Genet. 168: 111-115), competent cell transformation (see, e.g., Young and Spizizen, 1961 , J. Bacteriol. 81: 823-829, or Dubnau and Davidoff-Abelson, 1971 , J. Mol. Biol. 56: 209-221), electroporation (see, e.g., Shigekawa and Dower, 1988 , Biotechniques 6: 742-751), or conjugation (see, e.g., Koehler and Thorne, 1987 , J. Bacteriol. 169: 5271-5278).
- protoplast transformation see, e.g., Chang and Cohen, 1979 , Mol. Gen. Genet. 168: 111-115
- competent cell transformation see, e.g., Young and Spizizen, 1961 , J. Bacteriol.
- the introduction of DNA into an E. coli cell may be effected by protoplast transformation (see, e.g., Hanahan, 1983 , J. Mol. Biol. 166: 557-580) or electroporation (see, e.g., Dower et al., 1988 , Nucleic Acids Res. 16: 6127-6145).
- the introduction of DNA into a Streptomyces cell may be effected by protoplast transformation, electroporation (see, e.g., Gong et al., 2004 , Folia Microbiol . (Praha) 49: 399-405), conjugation (see, e.g., Mazodier et al., 1989 , J. Bacteriol.
- DNA into a Pseudomonas cell may be effected by electroporation (see, e.g., Choi et al., 2006 , J. Microbiol. Methods 64: 391-397) or conjugation (see, e.g., Pinedo and Smets, 2005 , Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 71: 51-57).
- the introduction of DNA into a Streptococcus cell may be effected by natural competence (see, e.g., Perry and Kuramitsu, 1981 , Infect Immun. 32: 1295-1297), protoplast transformation (see, e.g., Catt and Jollick, 1991 , Microbios 68: 189-207), electroporation (see, e.g., Buckley et al., 1999 , Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 65: 3800-3804), or conjugation (see, e.g., Clewell, 1981 , Microbiol. Rev. 45: 409-436).
- any method known in the art for introducing DNA into a host cell can be used.
- the host cell may also be a eukaryote, such as a mammalian, insect, plant, or fungal cell.
- the host cell may be a fungal cell.
- “Fungi” as used herein includes the phyla Ascomycota, Basidiomycota, Chytridiomycota, and Zygomycota as well as the Oomycota and all mitosporic fungi (as defined by Hawksworth et al., In, Ainsworth and Bisby's Dictionary of The Fungi, 8th edition, 1995, CAB International, University Press, Cambridge, UK).
- the fungal host cell may be a yeast cell.
- yeast as used herein includes ascosporogenous yeast (Endomycetales), basidiosporogenous yeast, and yeast belonging to the Fungi Imperfecti (Blastomycetes). Since the classification of yeast may change in the future, for the purposes of this invention, yeast shall be defined as described in Biology and Activities of Yeast (Skinner, Passmore, and Davenport, editors, Soc. App. Bacteriol. Symposium Series No. 9, 1980).
- the yeast host cell may be a Candida, Hansenula, Kluyveromyces, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Schizosaccharomyces , or Yarrowia cell, such as a Kluyveromyces lactis, Saccharomyces carlsbergensis, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Saccharomyces diastaticus, Saccharomyces douglasii, Saccharomyces kluyveri, Saccharomyces norbensis, Saccharomyces oviformis , or Yarrowia lipolytica cell.
- the fungal host cell may be a filamentous fungal cell.
- “Filamentous fungi” include all filamentous forms of the subdivision Eumycota and Oomycota (as defined by Hawksworth et al., 1995, supra).
- the filamentous fungi are generally characterized by a mycelial wall composed of chitin, cellulose, glucan, chitosan, mannan, and other complex polysaccharides. Vegetative growth is by hyphal elongation and carbon catabolism is obligately aerobic. In contrast, vegetative growth by yeasts such as Saccharomyces cerevisiae is by budding of a unicellular thallus and carbon catabolism may be fermentative.
- the filamentous fungal host cell may be an Acremonium, Aspergillus, Aureobasidium, Bjerkandera, Ceriporiopsis, Chrysosporium, Coprinus, Coriolus, Cryptococcus, Filibasidium, Fusarium, Humicola, Magnaporthe, Mucor, Myceliophthora, Neocallimastix, Neurospora, Paecilomyces, Penicillium, Phanerochaete, Phiebia, Piromyces, Pleurotus, Schizophyllum, Talaromyces, Thermoascus, Thielavia, Tolypocladium, Trametes , or Trichoderma cell.
- the filamentous fungal host cell may be an Aspergillus awamori, Aspergillus foetidus, Aspergillus fumigatus, Aspergillus japonicus, Aspergillus nidulans, Aspergillus niger, Aspergillus oryzae, Bjerkandera adusta, Ceriporiopsis aneirina, Ceriporiopsis caregiea, Ceriporiopsis gilvescens, Ceriporiopsis pannocinta, Ceriporiopsis rivulosa, Ceriporiopsis subrufa, Ceriporiopsis subvermispora, Chrysosporium inops, Chrysosporium keratinophilum, Chrysosporium lucknowense, Chrysosporium merdarium, Chrysosporium pannicola, Chrysosporium queenslandicum, Chrysosporium tropicum, Chrysosporium zona
- Fungal cells may be transformed by a process involving protoplast formation, transformation of the protoplasts, and regeneration of the cell wall in a manner known per se. Suitable procedures for transformation of Aspergillus and Trichoderma host cells are described in EP 238023, Yelton et al., 1984 , Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 81: 1470-1474, and Christensen et al., 1988 , Bio/Technology 6: 1419-1422. Suitable methods for transforming Fusarium species are described by Malardier et al., 1989 , Gene 78: 147-156, and WO 96/00787. Yeast may be transformed using the procedures described by Becker and Guarente, In Abelson, J. N.
- the present invention also relates to methods of producing a polypeptide of the present invention, comprising: (a) cultivating a cell, which in its wild-type form produces the polypeptide, under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide; and optionally (b) recovering the polypeptide.
- the cell is an Aurantiporus cell.
- the cell is an Aurantiporus alborubescens cell.
- the cell is Aurantiporus alborubescens strain NN00802.
- the cell is a Trichophaea cell.
- the cell is a Trichophaea saccata cell.
- the cell is Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70.
- the cell is a Penicillium cell.
- the cell is a Penicillium thomii cell.
- the cell is Penicillium thomii IBT 10776.
- the present invention also relates to methods of producing a polypeptide of the present invention, comprising: (a) cultivating a recombinant host cell of the present invention under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide; and optionally (b) recovering the polypeptide.
- the host cells are cultivated in a nutrient medium suitable for production of the polypeptide using methods known in the art.
- the cells may be cultivated by shake flask cultivation, or small-scale or large-scale fermentation (including continuous, batch, fed-batch, or solid state fermentations) in laboratory or industrial fermentors in a suitable medium and under conditions allowing the polypeptide to be expressed and/or isolated.
- the cultivation takes place in a suitable nutrient medium comprising carbon and nitrogen sources and inorganic salts, using procedures known in the art. Suitable media are available from commercial suppliers or may be prepared according to published compositions (e.g., in catalogues of the American Type Culture Collection). If the polypeptide is secreted into the nutrient medium, the polypeptide can be recovered directly from the medium. If the polypeptide is not secreted, it can be recovered from cell lysates.
- the polypeptide may be detected using methods known in the art that are specific for the polypeptides. These detection methods include, but are not limited to, use of specific antibodies, formation of an enzyme product, or disappearance of an enzyme substrate. For example, an enzyme assay may be used to determine the activity of the polypeptide.
- the polypeptide may be recovered using methods known in the art.
- the polypeptide may be recovered from the nutrient medium by conventional procedures including, but not limited to, collection, centrifugation, filtration, extraction, spray-drying, evaporation, or precipitation.
- a fermentation broth comprising the polypeptide is recovered.
- the polypeptide may be purified by a variety of procedures known in the art including, but not limited to, chromatography (e.g., ion exchange, affinity, hydrophobic, chromatofocusing, and size exclusion), electrophoretic procedures (e.g., preparative isoelectric focusing), differential solubility (e.g., ammonium sulfate precipitation), SDS-PAGE, or extraction (see, e.g., Protein Purification , Janson and Ryden, editors, VCH Publishers, New York, 1989) to obtain substantially pure polypeptides.
- chromatography e.g., ion exchange, affinity, hydrophobic, chromatofocusing, and size exclusion
- electrophoretic procedures e.g., preparative isoelectric focusing
- differential solubility e.g., ammonium sulfate precipitation
- SDS-PAGE or extraction
- polypeptide is not recovered, but rather a host cell of the present invention expressing the polypeptide is used as a source of the polypeptide.
- the present invention also relates to isolated plants, e.g., a transgenic plant, plant part, or plant cell, comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention so as to express and produce a polypeptide or domain in recoverable quantities.
- the polypeptide or domain may be recovered from the plant or plant part.
- the plant or plant part containing the polypeptide or domain may be used as such for improving the quality of a food or feed, e.g., improving nutritional value, palatability, and rheological properties, or to destroy an antinutritive factor.
- the transgenic plant can be dicotyledonous (a dicot) or monocotyledonous (a monocot).
- monocot plants are grasses, such as meadow grass (blue grass, Poa), forage grass such as Festuca, Lolium , temperate grass, such as Agrostis , and cereals, e.g., wheat, oats, rye, barley, rice, sorghum, and maize (corn).
- dicot plants are tobacco, legumes, such as lupins, potato, sugar beet, pea, bean and soybean, and cruciferous plants (family Brassicaceae), such as cauliflower, rape seed, and the closely related model organism Arabidopsis thaliana.
- plant parts are stem, callus, leaves, root, fruits, seeds, and tubers as well as the individual tissues comprising these parts, e.g., epidermis, mesophyll, parenchyme, vascular tissues, meristems.
- Specific plant cell compartments such as chloroplasts, apoplasts, mitochondria, vacuoles, peroxisomes and cytoplasm are also considered to be a plant part.
- any plant cell whatever the tissue origin, is considered to be a plant part.
- plant parts such as specific tissues and cells isolated to facilitate the utilization of the invention are also considered plant parts, e.g., embryos, endosperms, aleurone and seed coats.
- the transgenic plant or plant cell expressing the polypeptide or domain may be constructed in accordance with methods known in the art.
- the plant or plant cell is constructed by incorporating one or more expression constructs encoding the polypeptide or domain into the plant host genome or chloroplast genome and propagating the resulting modified plant or plant cell into a transgenic plant or plant cell.
- the expression construct is conveniently a nucleic acid construct that comprises a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide or domain operably linked with appropriate regulatory sequences required for expression of the polynucleotide in the plant or plant part of choice.
- the expression construct may comprise a selectable marker useful for identifying plant cells into which the expression construct has been integrated and DNA sequences necessary for introduction of the construct into the plant in question (the latter depends on the DNA introduction method to be used).
- regulatory sequences such as promoter and terminator sequences and optionally signal or transit sequences
- expression of the gene encoding a polypeptide or domain may be constitutive or inducible, or may be developmental, stage or tissue specific, and the gene product may be targeted to a specific tissue or plant part such as seeds or leaves.
- Regulatory sequences are, for example, described by Tague et al., 1988 , Plant Physiology 86: 506.
- the 35S-CaMV, the maize ubiquitin 1, or the rice actin 1 promoter may be used (Franck et al., 1980 , Cell 21: 285-294; Christensen et al., 1992 , Plant Mol. Biol. 18: 675-689; Zhang et al., 1991 , Plant Cell 3: 1155-1165).
- Organ-specific promoters may be, for example, a promoter from storage sink tissues such as seeds, potato tubers, and fruits (Edwards and Coruzzi, 1990 , Ann. Rev. Genet. 24: 275-303), or from metabolic sink tissues such as meristems (Ito et al., 1994 , Plant Mol. Biol.
- a seed specific promoter such as the glutelin, prolamin, globulin, or albumin promoter from rice (Wu et al., 1998 , Plant Cell Physiol. 39: 885-889), a Vicia faba promoter from the legumin B4 and the unknown seed protein gene from Vicia faba (Conrad et al., 1998 , J. Plant Physiol. 152: 708-711), a promoter from a seed oil body protein (Chen et al., 1998 , Plant Cell Physiol.
- the storage protein napA promoter from Brassica napus , or any other seed specific promoter known in the art, e.g., as described in WO 91/14772.
- the promoter may be a leaf specific promoter such as the rbcs promoter from rice or tomato (Kyozuka et al., 1993 , Plant Physiol. 102: 991-1000), the chlorella virus adenine methyltransferase gene promoter (Mitra and Higgins, 1994 , Plant Mol. Biol. 26: 85-93), the aldP gene promoter from rice (Kagaya et al., 1995 , Mol. Gen. Genet.
- the promoter may be induced by abiotic treatments such as temperature, drought, or alterations in salinity or induced by exogenously applied substances that activate the promoter, e.g., ethanol, oestrogens, plant hormones such as ethylene, abscisic acid, and gibberellic acid, and heavy metals.
- a promoter enhancer element may also be used to achieve higher expression of a polypeptide or domain in the plant.
- the promoter enhancer element may be an intron that is placed between the promoter and the polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide or domain.
- Xu et al., 1993, supra disclose the use of the first intron of the rice actin 1 gene to enhance expression.
- the selectable marker gene and any other parts of the expression construct may be chosen from those available in the art.
- the nucleic acid construct is incorporated into the plant genome according to conventional techniques known in the art, including Agrobacterium -mediated transformation, virus-mediated transformation, microinjection, particle bombardment, biolistic transformation, and electroporation (Gasser et al., 1990 , Science 244: 1293; Potrykus, 1990 , Bio/Technology 8: 535; Shimamoto et al., 1989 , Nature 338: 274).
- Agrobacterium tumefaciens -mediated gene transfer is a method for generating transgenic dicots (for a review, see Hooykas and Schilperoort, 1992 , Plant Mol. Biol. 19: 15-38) and for transforming monocots, although other transformation methods may be used for these plants.
- a method for generating transgenic monocots is particle bombardment (microscopic gold or tungsten particles coated with the transforming DNA) of embryonic calli or developing embryos (Christou, 1992 , Plant J. 2: 275-281; Shimamoto, 1994 , Curr. Opin. Biotechnol. 5: 158-162; Vasil et al., 1992 , Bio/Technology 10: 667-674).
- the transformants having incorporated the expression construct are selected and regenerated into whole plants according to methods well known in the art.
- the transformation procedure is designed for the selective elimination of selection genes either during regeneration or in the following generations by using, for example, co-transformation with two separate T-DNA constructs or site specific excision of the selection gene by a specific recombinase.
- transgenic plants may be made by crossing a plant having the construct to a second plant lacking the construct.
- a construct encoding a polypeptide or domain can be introduced into a particular plant variety by crossing, without the need for ever directly transforming a plant of that given variety. Therefore, the present invention encompasses not only a plant directly regenerated from cells which have been transformed in accordance with the present invention, but also the progeny of such plants.
- progeny may refer to the offspring of any generation of a parent plant prepared in accordance with the present invention.
- progeny may include a DNA construct prepared in accordance with the present invention.
- Crossing results in the introduction of a transgene into a plant line by cross pollinating a starting line with a donor plant line. Non-limiting examples of such steps are described in U.S. Pat. No. 7,151,204.
- Plants may be generated through a process of backcross conversion.
- plants include plants referred to as a backcross converted genotype, line, inbred, or hybrid.
- Genetic markers may be used to assist in the introgression of one or more transgenes of the invention from one genetic background into another. Marker assisted selection offers advantages relative to conventional breeding in that it can be used to avoid errors caused by phenotypic variations. Further, genetic markers may provide data regarding the relative degree of elite germplasm in the individual progeny of a particular cross. For example, when a plant with a desired trait which otherwise has a non-agronomically desirable genetic background is crossed to an elite parent, genetic markers may be used to select progeny which not only possess the trait of interest, but also have a relatively large proportion of the desired germplasm. In this way, the number of generations required to introgress one or more traits into a particular genetic background is minimized.
- the present invention also relates to methods of producing a polypeptide of the present invention comprising: (a) cultivating a transgenic plant or a plant cell comprising a polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide or domain; and (b) recovering the polypeptide.
- the present invention also relates to methods of producing a mutant of a parent cell, which comprises disrupting or deleting a polynucleotide, or a portion thereof, encoding a polypeptide of the present invention, which results in the mutant cell producing less of the polypeptide than the parent cell when cultivated under the same conditions.
- the mutant cell may be constructed by reducing or eliminating expression of the polynucleotide using methods well known in the art, for example, insertions, disruptions, replacements, or deletions.
- the polynucleotide is inactivated.
- the polynucleotide to be modified or inactivated may be, for example, the coding region or a part thereof essential for activity, or a regulatory element required for expression of the coding region.
- An example of such a regulatory or control sequence may be a promoter sequence or a functional part thereof, i.e., a part that is sufficient for affecting expression of the polynucleotide.
- Other control sequences for possible modification include, but are not limited to, a leader, polyadenylation sequence, propeptide sequence, signal peptide sequence, transcription terminator, and transcriptional activator.
- Modification or inactivation of the polynucleotide may be performed by subjecting the parent cell to mutagenesis and selecting for mutant cells in which expression of the polynucleotide has been reduced or eliminated.
- the mutagenesis which may be specific or random, may be performed, for example, by use of a suitable physical or chemical mutagenizing agent, by use of a suitable oligonucleotide, or by subjecting the DNA sequence to PCR generated mutagenesis. Furthermore, the mutagenesis may be performed by use of any combination of these mutagenizing agents.
- Examples of a physical or chemical mutagenizing agent suitable for the present purpose include ultraviolet (UV) irradiation, hydroxylamine, N-methyl-N′-nitro-N-nitrosoguanidine (MNNG), O-methyl hydroxylamine, nitrous acid, ethyl methane sulphonate (EMS), sodium bisulphite, formic acid, and nucleotide analogues.
- UV ultraviolet
- MNNG N-methyl-N′-nitro-N-nitrosoguanidine
- EMS ethyl methane sulphonate
- sodium bisulphite formic acid
- nucleotide analogues examples include ultraviolet (UV) irradiation, hydroxylamine, N-methyl-N′-nitro-N-nitrosoguanidine (MNNG), O-methyl hydroxylamine, nitrous acid, ethyl methane sulphonate (EMS), sodium bisulphite, formic acid, and nucleotide ana
- the mutagenesis is typically performed by incubating the parent cell to be mutagenized in the presence of the mutagenizing agent of choice under suitable conditions, and screening and/or selecting for mutant cells exhibiting reduced or no expression of the gene.
- Modification or inactivation of the polynucleotide may be accomplished by insertion, substitution, or deletion of one or more nucleotides in the gene or a regulatory element required for transcription or translation thereof.
- nucleotides may be inserted or removed so as to result in the introduction of a stop codon, the removal of the start codon, or a change in the open reading frame.
- modification or inactivation may be accomplished by site-directed mutagenesis or PCR generated mutagenesis in accordance with methods known in the art.
- the modification may be performed in vivo, i.e., directly on the cell expressing the polynucleotide to be modified, it is preferred that the modification be performed in vitro as exemplified below.
- An example of a convenient way to eliminate or reduce expression of a polynucleotide is based on techniques of gene replacement, gene deletion, or gene disruption.
- a nucleic acid sequence corresponding to the endogenous polynucleotide is mutagenized in vitro to produce a defective nucleic acid sequence that is then transformed into the parent cell to produce a defective gene.
- the defective nucleic acid sequence replaces the endogenous polynucleotide.
- the defective polynucleotide also encodes a marker that may be used for selection of transformants in which the polynucleotide has been modified or destroyed.
- the polynucleotide is disrupted with a selectable marker such as those described herein.
- the present invention also relates to methods of inhibiting the expression of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity in a cell, comprising administering to the cell or expressing in the cell a double-stranded RNA (dsRNA) molecule, wherein the dsRNA comprises a subsequence of a polynucleotide of the present invention.
- dsRNA double-stranded RNA
- the dsRNA is about 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25 or more duplex nucleotides in length.
- the dsRNA is preferably a small interfering RNA (siRNA) or a micro RNA (miRNA).
- siRNA small interfering RNA
- miRNA micro RNA
- the dsRNA is small interfering RNA for inhibiting transcription.
- the dsRNA is micro RNA for inhibiting translation.
- the present invention also relates to such double-stranded RNA (dsRNA) molecules, comprising a portion of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9 for inhibiting expression of the polypeptide in a cell.
- dsRNA double-stranded RNA
- the dsRNA can enter a cell and cause the degradation of a single-stranded RNA (ssRNA) of similar or identical sequences, including endogenous mRNAs.
- ssRNA single-stranded RNA
- RNAi RNA interference
- the dsRNAs of the present invention can be used in gene-silencing.
- the invention provides methods to selectively degrade RNA using a dsRNAi of the present invention.
- the process may be practiced in vitro, ex vivo, or in vivo.
- the dsRNA molecules can be used to generate a loss-of-function mutation in a cell, an organ or an animal.
- Methods for making and using dsRNA molecules to selectively degrade RNA are well known in the art; see, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,489,127; 6,506,559; 6,511,824; and 6,515,109.
- the present invention further relates to a mutant cell of a parent cell that comprises a disruption or deletion of a polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide or a control sequence thereof or a silenced gene encoding the polypeptide, which results in the mutant cell producing less of the polypeptide or no polypeptide compared to the parent cell.
- the polypeptide-deficient mutant cells are particularly useful as host cells for expression of native and heterologous polypeptides. Therefore, the present invention further relates to methods of producing a native or heterologous polypeptide, comprising: (a) cultivating the mutant cell under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide; and (b) recovering the polypeptide.
- heterologous polypeptides means polypeptides that are not native to the host cell, e.g., a variant of a native protein.
- the host cell may comprise more than one copy of a polynucleotide encoding the native or heterologous polypeptide.
- the methods used for cultivation and purification of the product of interest may be performed by methods known in the art.
- the methods of the present invention for producing an essentially cellulolytic enhancing-free product are of particular interest in the production of eukaryotic polypeptides, in particular fungal proteins such as enzymes.
- the cellulolytic enhancing-deficient cells may also be used to express heterologous proteins of pharmaceutical interest such as hormones, growth factors, receptors, and the like.
- eukaryotic polypeptides includes not only native polypeptides, but also those polypeptides, e.g., enzymes, which have been modified by amino acid substitutions, deletions or additions, or other such modifications to enhance activity, thermostability, pH tolerance and the like.
- the present invention relates to a protein product essentially free from cellulolytic enhancing activity that is produced by a method of the present invention.
- the present invention also relates to a fermentation broth formulation or a cell composition comprising a polypeptide of the present invention.
- the fermentation broth product further comprises additional ingredients used in the fermentation process, such as, for example, cells (including, the host cells containing the gene encoding the polypeptide of the present invention which are used to produce the polypeptide of interest), cell debris, biomass, fermentation media and/or fermentation products.
- the composition is a cell-killed whole broth containing organic acid(s), killed cells and/or cell debris, and culture medium.
- fermentation broth refers to a preparation produced by cellular fermentation that undergoes no or minimal recovery and/or purification.
- fermentation broths are produced when microbial cultures are grown to saturation, incubated under carbon-limiting conditions to allow protein synthesis (e.g., expression of enzymes by host cells) and secretion into cell culture medium.
- the fermentation broth can contain unfractionated or fractionated contents of the fermentation materials derived at the end of the fermentation.
- the fermentation broth is unfractionated and comprises the spent culture medium and cell debris present after the microbial cells (e.g., filamentous fungal cells) are removed, e.g., by centrifugation.
- the fermentation broth contains spent cell culture medium, extracellular enzymes, and viable and/or nonviable microbial cells.
- the fermentation broth formulation and cell compositions comprise a first organic acid component comprising at least one 1-5 carbon organic acid and/or a salt thereof and a second organic acid component comprising at least one 6 or more carbon organic acid and/or a salt thereof.
- the first organic acid component is acetic acid, formic acid, propionic acid, a salt thereof, or a mixture of two or more of the foregoing and the second organic acid component is benzoic acid, cyclohexanecarboxylic acid, 4-methylvaleric acid, phenylacetic acid, a salt thereof, or a mixture of two or more of the foregoing.
- the composition contains an organic acid(s), and optionally further contains killed cells and/or cell debris.
- the killed cells and/or cell debris are removed from a cell-killed whole broth to provide a composition that is free of these components.
- the fermentation broth formulations or cell compostions may further comprise a preservative and/or anti-microbial (e.g., bacteriostatic) agent, including, but not limited to, sorbitol, sodium chloride, potassium sorbate, and others known in the art.
- a preservative and/or anti-microbial agent including, but not limited to, sorbitol, sodium chloride, potassium sorbate, and others known in the art.
- the cell-killed whole broth or composition may contain the unfractionated contents of the fermentation materials derived at the end of the fermentation.
- the cell-killed whole broth or composition contains the spent culture medium and cell debris present after the microbial cells (e.g., filamentous fungal cells) are grown to saturation, incubated under carbon-limiting conditions to allow protein synthesis (e.g., expression of cellulase and/or glucosidase enzyme(s)).
- the cell-killed whole broth or composition contains the spent cell culture medium, extracellular enzymes, and killed filamentous fungal cells.
- the microbial cells present in the cell-killed whole broth or composition can be permeabilized and/or lysed using methods known in the art.
- a whole broth or cell composition as described herein is typically a liquid, but may contain insoluble components, such as killed cells, cell debris, culture media components, and/or insoluble enzyme(s). In some embodiments, insoluble components may be removed to provide a clarified liquid composition.
- the whole broth formulations and cell compositions of the present invention may be produced by a method described in WO 90/15861 or WO 2010/096673.
- compositions of the present invention are given below of preferred uses of the compositions of the present invention.
- dosage of the composition and other conditions under which the composition is used may be determined on the basis of methods known in the art.
- the present invention also relates to compositions comprising a polypeptide of the present invention.
- the compositions are enriched in such a polypeptide.
- the term “enriched” indicates that the cellulolytic enhancing activity of the composition has been increased, e.g., with an enrichment factor of at least 1.1.
- compositions may comprise a polypeptide of the present invention as the major enzymatic component, e.g., a mono-component composition.
- the compositions may comprise multiple enzymatic activities, such as one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an esterase, an expansin, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
- compositions may be prepared in accordance with methods known in the art and may be in the form of a liquid or a dry composition.
- the compositions may be stabilized in accordance with methods known in the art.
- compositions of the present invention are given below of preferred uses of the compositions of the present invention.
- dosage of the composition and other conditions under which the composition is used may be determined on the basis of methods known in the art.
- the present invention is also directed to the following methods for using the polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity, or compositions thereof.
- the present invention also relates to methods for degrading a cellulosic material, comprising: treating the cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention.
- the methods further comprise recovering the degraded or converted cellulosic material. Soluble products of degradation or conversion of the cellulosic material can be separated from insoluble cellulosic material using a method known in the art such as, for example, centrifugation, filtration, or gravity settling.
- the present invention also relates to methods of producing a fermentation product, comprising: (a) saccharifying a cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention; (b) fermenting the saccharified cellulosic material with one or more (e.g., several) fermenting microorganisms to produce the fermentation product; and (c) recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
- the present invention also relates to methods of fermenting a cellulosic material, comprising: fermenting the cellulosic material with one or more (e.g., several) fermenting microorganisms, wherein the cellulosic material is saccharified with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention.
- the fermenting of the cellulosic material produces a fermentation product.
- the methods further comprise recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
- the methods of the present invention can be used to saccharify the cellulosic material to fermentable sugars and to convert the fermentable sugars to many useful fermentation products, e.g., fuel, potable ethanol, and/or platform chemicals (e.g., acids, alcohols, ketones, gases, and the like).
- useful fermentation products e.g., fuel, potable ethanol, and/or platform chemicals (e.g., acids, alcohols, ketones, gases, and the like).
- platform chemicals e.g., acids, alcohols, ketones, gases, and the like.
- the processing of the cellulosic material according to the present invention can be accomplished using methods conventional in the art. Moreover, the methods of the present invention can be implemented using any conventional biomass processing apparatus configured to operate in accordance with the invention.
- Hydrolysis (saccharification) and fermentation, separate or simultaneous include, but are not limited to, separate hydrolysis and fermentation (SHF); simultaneous saccharification and fermentation (SSF); simultaneous saccharification and co-fermentation (SSCF); hybrid hydrolysis and fermentation (HHF); separate hydrolysis and co-fermentation (SHCF); hybrid hydrolysis and co-fermentation (HHCF); and direct microbial conversion (DMC), also sometimes called consolidated bioprocessing (CBP).
- SHF uses separate process steps to first enzymatically hydrolyze the cellulosic material to fermentable sugars, e.g., glucose, cellobiose, and pentose monomers, and then ferment the fermentable sugars to ethanol.
- HHF involves a separate hydrolysis step, and in addition a simultaneous saccharification and hydrolysis step, which can be carried out in the same reactor.
- the steps in an HHF process can be carried out at different temperatures, i.e., high temperature enzymatic saccharification followed by SSF at a lower temperature that the fermentation strain can tolerate.
- DMC combines all three processes (enzyme production, hydrolysis, and fermentation) in one or more (e.g., several) steps where the same organism is used to produce the enzymes for conversion of the cellulosic material to fermentable sugars and to convert the fermentable sugars into a final product (Lynd, L. R., Weimer, P. J., van Zyl, W. H., and Pretorius, I.
- a conventional apparatus can include a fed-batch stirred reactor, a batch stirred reactor, a continuous flow stirred reactor with ultrafiltration, and/or a continuous plug-flow column reactor (Fernanda de Castilhos Corazza, Flávio Faria de Moraes, Gisella Maria Zanin and Ivo Neitzel, 2003, Optimal control in fed-batch reactor for the cellobiose hydrolysis, Acta Scientiarum. Technology 25: 33-38; Gusakov, A. V., and Sinitsyn, A. P., 1985, Kinetics of the enzymatic hydrolysis of cellulose: 1.
- a mathematical model for a batch reactor process Enz. Microb. Technol.
- an attrition reactor (Ryu, S. K., and Lee, J. M., 1983, Bioconversion of waste cellulose by using an attrition bioreactor, Biotechnol. Bioeng. 25: 53-65), or a reactor with intensive stirring induced by an electromagnetic field (Gusakov, A. V., Sinitsyn, A. P., Davydkin, I. Y., Davydkin, V. Y., Protas, O. V., 1996, Enhancement of enzymatic cellulose hydrolysis using a novel type of bioreactor with intensive stirring induced by electromagnetic field, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 56: 141-153).
- Additional reactor types include fluidized bed, upflow blanket, immobilized, and extruder type reactors for hydrolysis and/or fermentation.
- any pretreatment process known in the art can be used to disrupt plant cell wall components of the cellulosic material (Chandra et al., 2007, Substrate pretreatment: The key to effective enzymatic hydrolysis of lignocellulosics?, Adv. Biochem. Engin./Biotechnol. 108: 67-93; Galbe and Zacchi, 2007, Pretreatment of lignocellulosic materials for efficient bioethanol production, Adv. Biochem. Engin./Biotechnol. 108: 41-65; Hendriks and Zeeman, 2009, Pretreatments to enhance the digestibility of lignocellulosic biomass, Bioresource Technol.
- the cellulosic material can also be subjected to particle size reduction, sieving, pre-soaking, wetting, washing, and/or conditioning prior to pretreatment using methods known in the art.
- Conventional pretreatments include, but are not limited to, steam pretreatment (with or without explosion), dilute acid pretreatment, hot water pretreatment, alkaline pretreatment, lime pretreatment, wet oxidation, wet explosion, ammonia fiber explosion, organosolv pretreatment, and biological pretreatment.
- Additional pretreatments include ammonia percolation, ultrasound, electroporation, microwave, supercritical CO 2 , supercritical H 2 O, ozone, ionic liquid, and gamma irradiation pretreatments.
- the cellulosic material can be pretreated before hydrolysis and/or fermentation. Pretreatment is preferably performed prior to the hydrolysis. Alternatively, the pretreatment can be carried out simultaneously with enzyme hydrolysis to release fermentable sugars, such as glucose, xylose, and/or cellobiose. In most cases the pretreatment step itself results in some conversion of biomass to fermentable sugars (even in absence of enzymes).
- the cellulosic material is heated to disrupt the plant cell wall components, including lignin, hemicellulose, and cellulose to make the cellulose and other fractions, e.g., hemicellulose, accessible to enzymes.
- the cellulosic material is passed to or through a reaction vessel where steam is injected to increase the temperature to the required temperature and pressure and is retained therein for the desired reaction time.
- Steam pretreatment is preferably performed at 140-250° C., e.g., 160-200° C. or 170-190° C., where the optimal temperature range depends on addition of a chemical catalyst.
- Residence time for the steam pretreatment is preferably 1-60 minutes, e.g., 1-30 minutes, 1-20 minutes, 3-12 minutes, or 4-10 minutes, where the optimal residence time depends on temperature range and addition of a chemical catalyst.
- Steam pretreatment allows for relatively high solids loadings, so that the cellulosic material is generally only moist during the pretreatment.
- the steam pretreatment is often combined with an explosive discharge of the material after the pretreatment, which is known as steam explosion, that is, rapid flashing to atmospheric pressure and turbulent flow of the material to increase the accessible surface area by fragmentation (Duff and Murray, 1996 , Bioresource Technology 855: 1-33; Galbe and Zacchi, 2002 , Appl. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 59: 618-628; U.S.
- Patent Application No. 20020164730 During steam pretreatment, hemicellulose acetyl groups are cleaved and the resulting acid autocatalyzes partial hydrolysis of the hemicellulose to monosaccharides and oligosaccharides. Lignin is removed to only a limited extent.
- Chemical Pretreatment refers to any chemical pretreatment that promotes the separation and/or release of cellulose, hemicellulose, and/or lignin. Such a pretreatment can convert crystalline cellulose to amorphous cellulose.
- suitable chemical pretreatment processes include, for example, dilute acid pretreatment, lime pretreatment, wet oxidation, ammonia fiber/freeze explosion (AFEX), ammonia percolation (APR), ionic liquid, and organosolv pretreatments.
- a catalyst such as H 2 SO 4 or SO 2 (typically 0.3 to 5% w/w) is often added prior to steam pretreatment, which decreases the time and temperature, increases the recovery, and improves enzymatic hydrolysis (Ballesteros et al., 2006 , Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 129-132: 496-508; Varga et al., 2004 , Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 113-116: 509-523; Sassner et al., 2006 , Enzyme Microb. Technol. 39: 756-762).
- H 2 SO 4 or SO 2 typically 0.3 to 5% w/w
- the cellulosic material is mixed with dilute acid, typically H 2 SO 4 , and water to form a slurry, heated by steam to the desired temperature, and after a residence time flashed to atmospheric pressure.
- dilute acid pretreatment can be performed with a number of reactor designs, e.g., plug-flow reactors, counter-current reactors, or continuous counter-current shrinking bed reactors (Duff and Murray, 1996, supra; Schell et al., 2004 , Bioresource Technol. 91: 179-188; Lee et al., 1999 , Adv. Biochem. Eng. Biotechnol. 65: 93-115).
- alkaline pretreatments include, but are not limited to, sodium hydroxide, lime, wet oxidation, ammonia percolation (APR), and ammonia fiber/freeze explosion (AFEX).
- Lime pretreatment is performed with calcium oxide or calcium hydroxide at temperatures of 85 ⁇ 150° C. and residence times from 1 hour to several days (VVyman et al., 2005 , Bioresource Technol. 96: 1959-1966; Mosier et al., 2005 , Bioresource Technol. 96: 673-686).
- WO 2006/110891, WO 2006/110899, WO 2006/110900, and WO 2006/110901 disclose pretreatment methods using ammonia.
- Wet oxidation is a thermal pretreatment performed typically at 180-200° C. for 5-15 minutes with addition of an oxidative agent such as hydrogen peroxide or over-pressure of oxygen (Schmidt and Thomsen, 1998 , Bioresource Technol. 64: 139-151; Palonen et al., 2004 , Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 117: 1-17; Varga et al., 2004 , Biotechnol. Bioeng. 88: 567-574; Martin et al., 2006 , J. Chem. Technol. Biotechnol. 81: 1669-1677).
- the pretreatment is performed preferably at 1-40% dry matter, e.g., 2-30% dry matter or 5-20% dry matter, and often the initial pH is increased by the addition of alkali such as sodium carbonate.
- a modification of the wet oxidation pretreatment method known as wet explosion (combination of wet oxidation and steam explosion) can handle dry matter up to 30%.
- wet explosion combination of wet oxidation and steam explosion
- the oxidizing agent is introduced during pretreatment after a certain residence time.
- the pretreatment is then ended by flashing to atmospheric pressure (WO 2006/032282).
- Ammonia fiber explosion involves treating the cellulosic material with liquid or gaseous ammonia at moderate temperatures such as 90-150° C. and high pressure such as 17-20 bar for 5-10 minutes, where the dry matter content can be as high as 60% (Gollapalli et al., 2002 , Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 98: 23-35; Chundawat et al., 2007 , Biotechnol. Bioeng. 96: 219-231; Alizadeh et al., 2005 , Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 121: 1133-1141; Teymouri et al., 2005 , Bioresource Technol. 96: 2014-2018).
- cellulose and hemicelluloses remain relatively intact. Lignin-carbohydrate complexes are cleaved.
- Organosolv pretreatment delignifies the cellulosic material by extraction using aqueous ethanol (40-60% ethanol) at 160-200° C. for 30-60 minutes (Pan et al., 2005 , Biotechnol. Bioeng. 90: 473-481; Pan et al., 2006 , Biotechnol. Bioeng. 94: 851-861; Kurabi et al., 2005 , Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 121: 219-230). Sulphuric acid is usually added as a catalyst. In organosolv pretreatment, the majority of hemicellulose and lignin is removed.
- the chemical pretreatment is preferably carried out as a dilute acid treatment, and more preferably as a continuous dilute acid treatment.
- the acid is typically sulfuric acid, but other acids can also be used, such as acetic acid, citric acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, tartaric acid, succinic acid, hydrogen chloride, or mixtures thereof.
- Mild acid treatment is conducted in the pH range of preferably 1-5, e.g., 1-4 or 1-2.5.
- the acid concentration is in the range from preferably 0.01 to 10 wt % acid, e.g., 0.05 to 5 wt % acid or 0.1 to 2 wt % acid.
- the acid is contacted with the cellulosic material and held at a temperature in the range of preferably 140-200° C., e.g., 165-190° C., for periods ranging from 1 to 60 minutes.
- pretreatment takes place in an aqueous slurry.
- the cellulosic material is present during pretreatment in amounts preferably between 10-80 wt %, e.g., 20-70 wt % or 30-60 wt %, such as around 40 wt %.
- the pretreated cellulosic material can be unwashed or washed using any method known in the art, e.g., washed with water.
- mechanical pretreatment or Physical pretreatment refers to any pretreatment that promotes size reduction of particles.
- pretreatment can involve various types of grinding or milling (e.g., dry milling, wet milling, or vibratory ball milling).
- the cellulosic material can be pretreated both physically (mechanically) and chemically. Mechanical or physical pretreatment can be coupled with steaming/steam explosion, hydrothermolysis, dilute or mild acid treatment, high temperature, high pressure treatment, irradiation (e.g., microwave irradiation), or combinations thereof.
- high pressure means pressure in the range of preferably about 100 to about 400 psi, e.g., about 150 to about 250 psi.
- high temperature means temperatures in the range of about 100 to about 300° C., e.g., about 140 to about 200° C.
- mechanical or physical pretreatment is performed in a batch-process using a steam gun hydrolyzer system that uses high pressure and high temperature as defined above, e.g., a Sunds Hydrolyzer available from Sunds Defibrator AB, Sweden.
- the physical and chemical pretreatments can be carried out sequentially or simultaneously, as desired.
- the cellulosic material is subjected to physical (mechanical) or chemical pretreatment, or any combination thereof, to promote the separation and/or release of cellulose, hemicellulose, and/or lignin.
- Biopretreatment refers to any biological pretreatment that promotes the separation and/or release of cellulose, hemicellulose, and/or lignin from the cellulosic material.
- Biological pretreatment techniques can involve applying lignin-solubilizing microorganisms and/or enzymes (see, for example, Hsu, T.-A., 1996, Pretreatment of biomass, in Handbook on Bioethanol: Production and Utilization , Wyman, C. E., ed., Taylor & Francis, Washington, DC, 179-212; Ghosh and Singh, 1993, Physicochemical and biological treatments for enzymatic/microbial conversion of cellulosic biomass, Adv. Appl. Microbiol.
- Saccharification In the hydrolysis step, also known as saccharification, the cellulosic material, e.g., pretreated, is hydrolyzed to break down cellulose and/or hemicellulose to fermentable sugars, such as glucose, cellobiose, xylose, xylulose, arabinose, mannose, galactose, and/or soluble oligosaccharides.
- the hydrolysis is performed enzymatically by an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention.
- the enzymes of the compositions can be added simultaneously or sequentially.
- Enzymatic hydrolysis is preferably carried out in a suitable aqueous environment under conditions that can be readily determined by one skilled in the art.
- hydrolysis is performed under conditions suitable for the activity of the enzyme(s), i.e., optimal for the enzyme(s).
- the hydrolysis can be carried out as a fed batch or continuous process where the cellulosic material is fed gradually to, for example, an enzyme containing hydrolysis solution.
- the saccharification is generally performed in stirred-tank reactors or fermentors under controlled pH, temperature, and mixing conditions. Suitable process time, temperature and pH conditions can readily be determined by one skilled in the art.
- the saccharification can last up to 200 hours, but is typically performed for preferably about 12 to about 120 hours, e.g., about 16 to about 72 hours or about 24 to about 48 hours.
- the temperature is in the range of preferably about 25° C. to about 70° C., e.g., about 30° C. to about 65° C., about 40° C. to about 60° C., or about 50° C. to about 55° C.
- the pH is in the range of preferably about 3 to about 8, e.g., about 3.5 to about 7, about 4 to about 6, or about 5.0 to about 5.5.
- the dry solids content is in the range of preferably about 5 to about 50 wt %, e.g., about 10 to about 40 wt % or about 20 to about 30 wt %.
- the enzyme compositions can comprise any protein useful in degrading the cellulosic material.
- the enzyme composition comprises or further comprises one or more (e.g., several) proteins selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an esterase, an expansin, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
- the cellulase is preferably one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase.
- the hemicellulase is preferably one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an acetylmannan esterase, an acetylxylan esterase, an arabinanase, an arabinofuranosidase, a coumaric acid esterase, a feruloyl esterase, a galactosidase, a glucuronidase, a glucuronoyl esterase, a mannanase, a mannosidase, a xylanase, and a xylosidase.
- the enzyme composition comprises one or more (e.g., several) cellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises or further comprises one or more (e.g., several) hemicellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises one or more (e.g., several) cellulolytic enzymes and one or more (e.g., several) hemicellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group of cellulolytic enzymes and hemicellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase.
- the enzyme composition comprises a beta-glucosidase.
- the enzyme composition comprises a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises a beta-glucosidase and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase and a cellobiohydrolase.
- the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase and a beta-glucosidase.
- the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase and a beta-glucosidase.
- the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a beta-glucosidase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase, a beta-glucosidase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, a beta-glucosidase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- the enzyme composition comprises an acetylmannan esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an acetylxylan esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an arabinanase (e.g., alpha-L-arabinanase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an arabinofuranosidase (e.g., alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a coumaric acid esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a feruloyl esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a galactosidase (e.g., alpha-galactosidase and/or beta-galactosidase).
- arabinanase e.g., alpha-L-arabinanase
- the enzyme composition comprises an arabinofuranosidase (e.g., alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase).
- the enzyme composition comprises
- the enzyme composition comprises a glucuronidase (e.g., alpha-D-glucuronidase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a glucuronoyl esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a mannanase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a mannosidase (e.g., beta-mannosidase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a xylanase. In a preferred aspect, the xylanase is a Family 10 xylanase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a xylosidase (e.g., beta-xylosidase).
- a glucuronidase e.g., alpha-D-glucuronidase
- the enzyme composition comprises a glucuronoyl esterase.
- the enzyme composition comprises a mannanase.
- the enzyme composition comprises a mannosidase (e.g., beta-mannos
- the enzyme composition comprises an esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an expansin. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a laccase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a ligninolytic enzyme. In a preferred aspect, the ligninolytic enzyme is a manganese peroxidase. In another preferred aspect, the ligninolytic enzyme is a lignin peroxidase. In another preferred aspect, the ligninolytic enzyme is a H 2 O 2 -producing enzyme. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a pectinase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a peroxidase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a protease. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a swollenin.
- the enzyme(s) can be added prior to or during saccharification, saccharification and fermentation, or fermentation.
- One or more (e.g., several) components of the enzyme composition may be wild-type proteins, recombinant proteins, or a combination of wild-type proteins and recombinant proteins.
- one or more (e.g., several) components may be native proteins of a cell, which is used as a host cell to express recombinantly one or more (e.g., several) other components of the enzyme composition.
- One or more (e.g., several) components of the enzyme composition may be produced as monocomponents, which are then combined to form the enzyme composition.
- the enzyme composition may be a combination of multicomponent and monocomponent protein preparations.
- the enzymes used in the methods of the present invention may be in any form suitable for use, such as, for example, a fermentation broth formulation or a cell composition, a cell lysate with or without cellular debris, a semi-purified or purified enzyme preparation, or a host cell as a source of the enzymes.
- the enzyme composition may be a dry powder or granulate, a non-dusting granulate, a liquid, a stabilized liquid, or a stabilized protected enzyme.
- Liquid enzyme preparations may, for instance, be stabilized by adding stabilizers such as a sugar, a sugar alcohol or another polyol, and/or lactic acid or another organic acid according to established methods.
- the optimum amounts of the enzymes and polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity depend on several factors including, but not limited to, the mixture of component cellulolytic enzymes and/or hemicellulolytic enzymes, the cellulosic material, the concentration of cellulosic material, the pretreatment(s) of the cellulosic material, temperature, time, pH, and inclusion of fermenting organism (e.g., yeast for Simultaneous Saccharification and Fermentation).
- fermenting organism e.g., yeast for Simultaneous Saccharification and Fermentation
- an effective amount of cellulolytic or hemicellulolytic enzyme to the cellulosic material is about 0.5 to about 50 mg, e.g., about 0.5 to about 40 mg, about 0.5 to about 25 mg, about 0.75 to about 20 mg, about 0.75 to about 15 mg, about 0.5 to about 10 mg, or about 2.5 to about 10 mg per g of the cellulosic material.
- an effective amount of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity to the cellulosic material is about 0.01 to about 50.0 mg, e.g., about 0.01 to about 40 mg, about 0.01 to about 30 mg, about 0.01 to about 20 mg, about 0.01 to about 10 mg, about 0.01 to about 5 mg, about 0.025 to about 1.5 mg, about 0.05 to about 1.25 mg, about 0.075 to about 1.25 mg, about 0.1 to about 1.25 mg, about 0.15 to about 1.25 mg, or about 0.25 to about 1.0 mg per g of the cellulosic material.
- an effective amount of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity to cellulolytic or hemicellulolytic enzyme is about 0.005 to about 1.0 g, e.g., about 0.01 to about 1.0 g, about 0.15 to about 0.75 g, about 0.15 to about 0.5 g, about 0.1 to about 0.5 g, about 0.1 to about 0.25 g, or about 0.05 to about 0.2 g per g of cellulolytic or hemicellulolytic enzyme.
- polypeptides having cellulolytic enzyme activity or hemicellulolytic enzyme activity as well as other proteins/polypeptides useful in the degradation of the cellulosic material e.g., GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity
- polypeptides having enzyme activity can be derived or obtained from any suitable origin, including, bacterial, fungal, yeast, plant, or mammalian origin.
- the term “obtained” also means herein that the enzyme may have been produced recombinantly in a host organism employing methods described herein, wherein the recombinantly produced enzyme is either native or foreign to the host organism or has a modified amino acid sequence, e.g., having one or more (e.g., several) amino acids that are deleted, inserted and/or substituted, i.e., a recombinantly produced enzyme that is a mutant and/or a fragment of a native amino acid sequence or an enzyme produced by nucleic acid shuffling processes known in the art.
- a native enzyme are natural variants and within the meaning of a foreign enzyme are variants obtained recombinantly, such as by site-directed mutagenesis or shuffling.
- a polypeptide having enzyme activity may be a bacterial polypeptide.
- the polypeptide may be a Gram positive bacterial polypeptide such as a Bacillus, Streptococcus, Streptomyces, Staphylococcus, Enterococcus, Lactobacillus, Lactococcus, Clostridium, Geobacillus, Caldicellulosiruptor, Acidothermus, Thermobifidia , or Oceanobacillus polypeptide having enzyme activity, or a Gram negative bacterial polypeptide such as an E. coli, Pseudomonas, Salmonella, Campylobacter, Helicobacter, Flavobacterium, Fusobacterium, Ilyobacter, Neisseria , or Ureaplasma polypeptide having enzyme activity.
- the polypeptide is a Bacillus alkalophilus, Bacillus amyloliquefaciens, Bacillus brevis, Bacillus circulans, Bacillus clausii, Bacillus coagulans, Bacillus firmus, Bacillus lautus, Bacillus lentus, Bacillus licheniformis, Bacillus megaterium, Bacillus pumilus, Bacillus stearothermophilus, Bacillus subtilis , or Bacillus thuringiensis polypeptide having enzyme activity.
- the polypeptide is a Streptococcus equisimilis, Streptococcus pyogenes, Streptococcus uberis , or Streptococcus equi subsp. Zooepidemicus polypeptide having enzyme activity.
- the polypeptide is a Streptomyces achromogenes, Streptomyces avermitilis, Streptomyces coelicolor, Streptomyces griseus , or Streptomyces lividans polypeptide having enzyme activity.
- the polypeptide having enzyme activity may also be a fungal polypeptide, and more preferably a yeast polypeptide such as a Candida, Kluyveromyces, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Schizosaccharomyces , or Yarrowia polypeptide having enzyme activity; or more preferably a filamentous fungal polypeptide such as an Acremonium, Agaricus, Alternaria, Aspergillus, Aureobasidium, Botryosphaeria, Ceriporiopsis, Chaetomidium, Chrysosporium, Claviceps, Cochliobolus, Coprinopsis, Coptotermes, Corynascus, Cryphonectria, Cryptococcus, Diplodia, Exidia, Filibasidium, Fusarium, Gibberella, Holomastigotoides, Humicola, Irpex, Lentinula, Leptospaeria, Magnaporthe, Melanocarpus, Meripilus, Mu
- the polypeptide is a Saccharomyces carlsbergensis, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Saccharomyces diastaticus, Saccharomyces douglasii, Saccharomyces kluyveri, Saccharomyces norbensis , or Saccharomyces oviformis polypeptide having enzyme activity.
- the polypeptide is an Acremonium cellulolyticus, Aspergillus aculeatus, Aspergillus awamori, Aspergillus fumigatus, Aspergillus foetidus, Aspergillus japonicus, Aspergillus nidulans, Aspergillus niger, Aspergillus oryzae, Chrysosporium keratinophilum, Chrysosporium lucknowense, Chrysosporium tropicum, Chrysosporium merdarium, Chrysosporium inops, Chrysosporium pannicola, Chrysosporium queenslandicum, Chrysosporium zonatum, Fusarium bactridioides, Fusarium cerealis, Fusarium crookwellense, Fusarium culmorum, Fusarium graminearum, Fusarium graminum, Fusarium heterosporum, Fusa
- Chemically modified or protein engineered mutants of polypeptides having enzyme activity may also be used.
- One or more (e.g., several) components of the enzyme composition may be a recombinant component, i.e., produced by cloning of a DNA sequence encoding the single component and subsequent cell transformed with the DNA sequence and expressed in a host (see, for example, WO 91/17243 and WO 91/17244).
- the host is preferably a heterologous host (enzyme is foreign to host), but the host may under certain conditions also be a homologous host (enzyme is native to host).
- Monocomponent cellulolytic proteins may also be prepared by purifying such a protein from a fermentation broth.
- the one or more (e.g., several) cellulolytic enzymes comprise a commercial cellulolytic enzyme preparation.
- commercial cellulolytic enzyme preparations suitable for use in the present invention include, for example, CELLIC® CTec (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® CTec2 (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® CTec3 (Novozymes A/S), CELLUCLASTTM (Novozymes A/S), NOVOZYMTM 188 (Novozymes A/S), CELLUZYMETM (Novozymes A/S), CEREFLOTM (Novozymes A/S), and ULTRAFLOTM (Novozymes A/S), ACCELERASETM (Genencor Int.), LAMINEXTM (Genencor Int.), SPEZYMETM CP (Genencor Int.), FILTRASE® NL (DSM); METHAPLUS® S/L 100 (DSM), ROHAMENTTM 7069 W (R), FIL
- the cellulase enzymes are added in amounts effective from about 0.001 to about 5.0 wt % of solids, e.g., about 0.025 to about 4.0 wt % of solids or about 0.005 to about 2.0 wt % of solids.
- bacterial endoglucanases examples include, but are not limited to, an Acidothermus cellulolyticus endoglucanase (WO 91/05039; WO 93/15186; U.S. Pat. No. 5,275,944; WO 96/02551; U.S. Pat. No. 5,536,655, WO 00/70031, WO 05/093050); Thermobifida fusca endoglucanase III (WO 05/093050); and Thermobifida fusca endoglucanase V (WO 05/093050).
- an Acidothermus cellulolyticus endoglucanase WO 91/05039; WO 93/15186; U.S. Pat. No. 5,275,944; WO 96/02551; U.S. Pat. No. 5,536,655, WO 00/70031, WO 05/093050
- fungal endoglucanases examples include, but are not limited to, a Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase I (Penttila et al., 1986 , Gene 45: 253-263, Trichoderma reesei CeI7B endoglucanase I (GENBANKTM accession no. M15665), Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase II (Saloheimo, et al., 1988, Gene 63:11-22), Trichoderma reesei CeI5A endoglucanase II (GENBANKTM accession no.
- Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase III (Okada et al., 1988 , Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 64: 555-563, GENBANKTM accession no. AB003694), Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase V (Saloheimo et al., 1994 , Molecular Microbiology 13: 219-228, GENBANKTM accession no.
- cellobiohydrolases useful in the present invention include, but are not limited to, Aspergillus aculeatus cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2011/059740), Chaetomium thermophilum cellobiohydrolase I, Chaetomium thermophilum cellobiohydrolase II, Humicola insolens cellobiohydrolase I, Myceliophthora thermophila cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2009/042871), Thielavia hyrcanie cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2010/141325), Thielavia terrestris cellobiohydrolase II (CEL6A, WO 2006/074435), Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase I, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase II, and Trichophaea saccata cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2010/057086).
- beta-glucosidases useful in the present invention include, but are not limited to, beta-glucosidases from Aspergillus aculeatus (Kawaguchi et al., 1996 , Gene 173: 287-288), Aspergillus fumigatus (WO 2005/047499), Aspergillus niger (Dan et al., 2000, J. Biol. Chem.
- the beta-glucosidase may be a fusion protein.
- the beta-glucosidase is an Aspergillus oryzae beta-glucosidase variant BG fusion protein (WO 2008/057637) or an Aspergillus oryzae beta-glucosidase fusion protein (WO 2008/057637).
- cellulolytic enzymes that may be used in the present invention are described in WO 98/13465, WO 98/015619, WO 98/015633, WO 99/06574, WO 99/10481, WO 99/025847, WO 99/031255, WO 2002/101078, WO 2003/027306, WO 2003/052054, WO 2003/052055, WO 2003/052056, WO 2003/052057, WO 2003/052118, WO 2004/016760, WO 2004/043980, WO 2004/048592, WO 2005/001065, WO 2005/028636, WO 2005/093050, WO 2005/093073, WO 2006/074005, WO 2006/117432, WO 2007/071818, WO 2007/071820, WO 2008/008070, WO 2008/008793, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,457,046, 5,648,263, and 5,686,593.
- any GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity can be used as a component of the enzyme composition.
- GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity include, but are not limited to, GH61 polypeptides from Thielavia terrestris (WO 2005/074647, WO 2008/148131, and WO 2011/035027), Thermoascus aurantiacus (WO 2005/074656 and WO 2010/065830), Trichoderma reesei (WO 2007/089290), Myceliophthora thermophila (WO 2009/085935, WO 2009/085859, WO 2009/085864, WO 2009/085868), Aspergillus fumigatus (WO 2010/138754), GH61 polypeptides from Penicillium pinophilum (WO 2011/005867), Thermoascus sp. (WO 2011/039319), Penicillium sp. (WO 2011/041397), and Thermoascus crustaceous (WO 2011/041504).
- the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is used in the presence of a soluble activating divalent metal cation according to WO 2008/151043, e.g., manganese sulfate.
- the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is used in the presence of a dioxy compound, a bicylic compound, a heterocyclic compound, a nitrogen-containing compound, a quinone compound, a sulfur-containing compound, or a liquor obtained from a pretreated cellulosic material such as pretreated corn stover (PCS).
- PCS pretreated corn stover
- the dioxy compound may include any suitable compound containing two or more oxygen atoms.
- the dioxy compounds contain a substituted aryl moiety as described herein.
- the dioxy compounds may comprise one or more (e.g., several) hydroxyl and/or hydroxyl derivatives, but also include substituted aryl moieties lacking hydroxyl and hydroxyl derivatives.
- Non-limiting examples of the dioxy compounds include pyrocatechol or catechol; caffeic acid; 3,4-dihydroxybenzoic acid; 4-tert-butyl-5-methoxy-1,2-benzenediol; pyrogallol; gallic acid; methyl-3,4,5-trihydroxybenzoate; 2,3,4-trihydroxybenzophenone; 2,6-dimethoxyphenol; sinapinic acid; 3,5-dihydroxybenzoic acid; 4-chloro-1,2-benzenediol; 4-nitro-1,2-benzenediol; tannic acid; ethyl gallate; methyl glycolate; dihydroxyfumaric acid; 2-butyne-1,4-diol; (croconic acid; 1,3-propanediol; tartaric acid; 2,4-pentanediol; 3-ethyoxy-1,2-propanediol; 2,4,4′-trihydroxybenzophenone; cis-2-butene-1,4-d
- the bicyclic compound may include any suitable substituted fused ring system as described herein.
- the compounds may comprise one or more (e.g., several) additional rings, and are not limited to a specific number of rings unless otherwise stated.
- the bicyclic compound is a flavonoid.
- the bicyclic compound is an optionally substituted isoflavonoid.
- the bicyclic compound is an optionally substituted flavylium ion, such as an optionally substituted anthocyanidin or optionally substituted anthocyanin, or derivative thereof.
- Non-limiting examples of the bicyclic compounds include epicatechin; quercetin; myricetin; taxifolin; kaempferol; morin; acacetin;
- naringenin naringenin
- isorhamnetin apigenin; cyanidin; cyanin; kuromanin; keracyanin; or a salt or solvate thereof.
- the heterocyclic compound may be any suitable compound, such as an optionally substituted aromatic or non-aromatic ring comprising a heteroatom, as described herein.
- the heterocyclic is a compound comprising an optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl moiety or an optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety.
- the optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl moiety or optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety is an optionally substituted 5-membered heterocycloalkyl or an optionally substituted 5-membered heteroaryl moiety.
- the optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl or optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety is an optionally substituted moiety selected from pyrazolyl, furanyl, imidazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, oxazolyl, pyrrolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, thienyl, dihydrothieno-pyrazolyl, thianaphthenyl, carbazolyl, benzimidazolyl, benzothienyl, benzofuranyl, indolyl, quinolinyl, benzotriazolyl, benzothiazolyl, benzooxazolyl, benzimidazolyl, isoquinolinyl, isoindolyl, acridinyl, benzoisazolyl, dimethylhydantoin, pyrazinyl,
- the optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl moiety or optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety is an optionally substituted furanyl.
- the heterocyclic compounds include (1,2-dihydroxyethyl)-3,4-dihydroxyfuran-2(5H)-one; 4-hydroxy-5-methyl-3-furanone; 5-hydroxy-2(5H)-furanone; [1,2-dihydroxyethyl]furan-2,3,4(5H)-trione; ⁇ -hydroxy- ⁇ -butyrolactone; ribonic ⁇ -lactone; aldohexuronicaldohexuronic acid ⁇ -lactone; gluconic acid ⁇ -lactone; 4-hydroxycoumarin; dihydrobenzofuran; 5-(hydroxymethyl)furfural; furoin; 2(5H)-furanone; 5,6-dihydro-2H-pyran-2-one; and 5,6-dihydro-4-hydroxy-6-methyl-2H-pyran-2-one; or
- the nitrogen-containing compound may be any suitable compound with one or more nitrogen atoms.
- the nitrogen-containing compound comprises an amine, imine, hydroxylamine, or nitroxide moiety.
- Non-limiting examples of the nitrogen-containing compounds include acetone oxime; violuric acid; pyridine-2-aldoxime; 2-aminophenol; 1,2-benzenediamine; 2,2,6,6-tetramethyl-1-piperidinyloxy; 5,6,7,8-tetrahydrobiopterin; 6,7-dimethyl-5,6,7,8-tetrahydropterine; and maleamic acid; or a salt or solvate thereof.
- the quinone compound may be any suitable compound comprising a quinone moiety as described herein.
- the quinone compounds include 1,4-benzoquinone; 1,4-naphthoquinone; 2-hydroxy-1,4-naphthoquinone; 2,3-dimethoxy-5-methyl-1,4-benzoquinone or coenzyme Q 0 ; 2,3,5,6-tetramethyl-1,4-benzoquinone or duroquinone; 1,4-dihydroxyanthraquinone; 3-hydroxy-1-methyl-5,6-indolinedione or adrenochrome; 4-tert-butyl-5-methoxy-1,2-benzoquinone; pyrroloquinoline quinone; or a salt or solvate thereof.
- the sulfur-containing compound may be any suitable compound comprising one or more sulfur atoms.
- the sulfur-containing comprises a moiety selected from thionyl, thioether, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfamide, sulfonamide, sulfonic acid, and sulfonic ester.
- Non-limiting examples of the sulfur-containing compounds include ethanethiol; 2-propanethiol; 2-propene-1-thiol; 2-mercaptoethanesulfonic acid; benzenethiol; benzene-1,2-dithiol; cysteine; methionine; glutathione; cystine; or a salt or solvate thereof.
- an effective amount of such a compound described above to cellulosic material as a molar ratio to glucosyl units of cellulose is about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 10, e.g., about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 7.5, about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 5, about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 2.5, about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 1, about 10 ⁇ 5 to about 1, about 10 ⁇ 5 to about 10 ⁇ 1 , about 10 ⁇ 4 to about 10 ⁇ 1 , about 10 ⁇ 3 to about 10 ⁇ 1 , or about 10 ⁇ 3 to about 10 ⁇ 2 .
- an effective amount of such a compound described above is about 0.1 ⁇ M to about 1 M, e.g., about 0.5 ⁇ M to about 0.75 M, about 0.75 ⁇ M to about 0.5 M, about 1 ⁇ M to about 0.25 M, about 1 ⁇ M to about 0.1 M, about 5 ⁇ M to about 50 mM, about 10 ⁇ M to about 25 mM, about 50 ⁇ M to about 25 mM, about 10 ⁇ M to about 10 mM, about 5 ⁇ M to about 5 mM, or about 0.1 mM to about 1 mM.
- liquid means the solution phase, either aqueous, organic, or a combination thereof, arising from treatment of a lignocellulose and/or hemicellulose material in a slurry, or monosaccharides thereof, e.g., xylose, arabinose, mannose, etc., under conditions as described herein, and the soluble contents thereof.
- a liquor for cellulolytic enhancement of a GH61 polypeptide can be produced by treating a lignocellulose or hemicellulose material (or feedstock) by applying heat and/or pressure, optionally in the presence of a catalyst, e.g., acid, optionally in the presence of an organic solvent, and optionally in combination with physical disruption of the material, and then separating the solution from the residual solids.
- a catalyst e.g., acid
- organic solvent optionally in combination with physical disruption of the material
- Such conditions determine the degree of cellulolytic enhancement obtainable through the combination of liquor and a GH61 polypeptide during hydrolysis of a cellulosic substrate by a cellulase preparation.
- the liquor can be separated from the treated material using a method standard in the art, such as filtration, sedimentation, or centrifugation.
- an effective amount of the liquor to cellulose is about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 10 g per g of cellulose, e.g., about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 7.5 g, about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 5 g, about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 2.5 g, about 10 ⁇ 6 to about 1 g, about 10 ⁇ 5 to about 1 g, about 10 ⁇ 5 to about 10 ⁇ 1 g, about 10 ⁇ 4 to about 10 ⁇ 1 g, about 10 ⁇ 3 to about 10 ⁇ 1 g, or about 10 ⁇ 3 to about 10 ⁇ 2 g per g of cellulose.
- the one or more (e.g., several) hemicellulolytic enzymes comprise a commercial hemicellulolytic enzyme preparation.
- commercial hemicellulolytic enzyme preparations suitable for use in the present invention include, for example, SHEARZYMETM (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® HTec (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® HTec2 (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® HTec3 (Novozymes A/S), VISCOZYME® (Novozymes A/S), ULTRAFLO® (Novozymes A/S), PULPZYME® HC (Novozymes A/S), MULTIFECT® Xylanase (Genencor), ACCELLERASE® XY (Genencor), ACCELLERASE® XC (Genencor), ECOPULP® TX-200A (AB Enzymes), HSP 6000 Xylanase (DSM), DEPOLTM
- xylanases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, xylanases from Aspergillus aculeatus (GeneSeqP:AAR63790; WO 94/21785), Aspergillus fumigatus (WO 2006/078256), Penicillium pinophilum (WO 2011/041405), Penicillium sp. (WO 2010/126772), Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 (WO 2009/079210), and Trichophaea saccata GH10 (WO 2011/057083).
- Aspergillus aculeatus GeneSeqP:AAR63790; WO 94/21785
- Aspergillus fumigatus WO 2006/078256
- Penicillium pinophilum WO 2011/041405
- Penicillium sp. WO 2010/126772
- Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 WO 2009/079210
- beta-xylosidases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, beta-xylosidases from Neurospora crassa (SwissProt accession number Q7SOW4), Trichoderma reesei (UniProtKB/TrEMBL accession number Q92458), and Talaromyces emersonii (SwissProt accession number Q8X212).
- acetylxylan esterases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, acetylxylan esterases from Aspergillus aculeatus (WO 2010/108918), Chaetomium globosum (Uniprot accession number Q2GWX4), Chaetomium gracile (GeneSeqP accession number AAB82124), Humicola insolens DSM 1800 (WO 2009/073709), Hypocrea jecorina (WO 2005/001036), Myceliophtera thermophila (WO 2010/014880), Neurospora crassa (UniProt accession number q7s259), Phaeosphaeria nodorum (Uniprot accession number QOUHJ1), and Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 (WO 2009/042846).
- feruloyl esterases form Humicola insolens DSM 1800 (WO 2009/076122), Neosartorya fischeri (UniProt Accession number A1D9T4), Neurospora crassa (UniProt accession number Q9HGR3), Penicillium aurantiogriseum (WO 2009/127729), and Thielavia terrestris (WO 2010/053838 and WO
- alpha-glucuronidases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, alpha-glucuronidases from Aspergillus clavatus (UniProt accession number alcc12), Aspergillus fumigatus (SwissProt accession number Q4VVVV45), Aspergillus niger (Uniprot accession number Q96WX9), Aspergillus terreus (SwissProt accession number Q0CJP9), Humicola insolens (WO 2010/014706), Penicillium aurantiogriseum (WO 2009/068565), Talaromyces emersonii (UniProt accession number Q8X211), and Trichoderma reesei (Uniprot accession number Q99024).
- alpha-glucuronidases from Aspergillus clavatus (UniProt accession number alcc12), Aspergillus fumigatus (
- polypeptides having enzyme activity used in the methods of the present invention may be produced by fermentation of the above-noted microbial strains on a nutrient medium containing suitable carbon and nitrogen sources and inorganic salts, using procedures known in the art (see, e.g., Bennett, J. W. and LaSure, L. (eds.), More Gene Manipulations in Fungi , Academic Press, C A, 1991). Suitable media are available from commercial suppliers or may be prepared according to published compositions (e.g., in catalogues of the American Type Culture Collection). Temperature ranges and other conditions suitable for growth and enzyme production are known in the art (see, e.g., Bailey, J. E., and Ollis, D. F., Biochemical Engineering Fundamentals, McGraw-Hill Book Company, NY, 1986).
- the fermentation can be any method of cultivation of a cell resulting in the expression or isolation of an enzyme or protein. Fermentation may, therefore, be understood as comprising shake flask cultivation, or small- or large-scale fermentation (including continuous, batch, fed-batch, or solid state fermentations) in laboratory or industrial fermentors performed in a suitable medium and under conditions allowing the enzyme to be expressed or isolated.
- the resulting enzymes produced by the methods described above may be recovered from the fermentation medium and purified by conventional procedures.
- the fermentable sugars obtained from the hydrolyzed cellulosic material can be fermented by one or more (e.g., several) fermenting microorganisms capable of fermenting the sugars directly or indirectly into a desired fermentation product.
- Fermentation or “fermentation process” refers to any fermentation process or any process comprising a fermentation step. Fermentation processes also include fermentation processes used in the consumable alcohol industry (e.g., beer and wine), dairy industry (e.g., fermented dairy products), leather industry, and tobacco industry. The fermentation conditions depend on the desired fermentation product and fermenting organism and can easily be determined by one skilled in the art.
- sugars released from the cellulosic material as a result of the pretreatment and enzymatic hydrolysis steps, are fermented to a product, e.g., ethanol, by a fermenting organism, such as yeast.
- Hydrolysis (saccharification) and fermentation can be separate or simultaneous, as described herein.
- Any suitable hydrolyzed cellulosic material can be used in the fermentation step in practicing the present invention.
- the material is generally selected based on the desired fermentation product, i.e., the substance to be obtained from the fermentation, and the process employed, as is well known in the art.
- fermentation medium is understood herein to refer to a medium before the fermenting microorganism(s) is(are) added, such as, a medium resulting from a saccharification process, as well as a medium used in a simultaneous saccharification and fermentation process (SSF).
- SSF simultaneous saccharification and fermentation process
- “Fermenting microorganism” refers to any microorganism, including bacterial and fungal organisms, suitable for use in a desired fermentation process to produce a fermentation product.
- the fermenting organism can be hexose and/or pentose fermenting organisms, or a combination thereof. Both hexose and pentose fermenting organisms are well known in the art.
- Suitable fermenting microorganisms are able to ferment, i.e., convert, sugars, such as glucose, xylose, xylulose, arabinose, maltose, mannose, galactose, and/or oligosaccharides, directly or indirectly into the desired fermentation product. Examples of bacterial and fungal fermenting organisms producing ethanol are described by Lin et al., 2006 , Appl. MicrobioL Biotechnol. 69: 627-642.
- yeast examples include bacterial and fungal organisms, such as yeast.
- Preferred yeast includes strains of Candida, Kluyveromyces , and Saccharomyces , e.g., Candida sonorensis, Kluyveromyces marxianus , and Saccharomyces cerevisiae.
- Examples of fermenting organisms that can ferment pentose sugars in their native state include bacterial and fungal organisms, such as some yeast.
- Preferred xylose fermenting yeast include strains of Candida , preferably C. sheatae or C. sonorensis ; and strains of Pichia , preferably P. stipitis , such as P. stipitis CBS 5773.
- Preferred pentose fermenting yeast include strains of Pachysolen , preferably P. tannophilus .
- Organisms not capable of fermenting pentose sugars, such as xylose and arabinose may be genetically modified to do so by methods known in the art.
- Other fermenting organisms include strains of Bacillus , such as Bacillus coagulans; Candida , such as C. sonorensis, C. methanosorbosa, C. diddensiae, C. parapsilosis, C. naedodendra, C. blankii, C. entomophilia, C. brassicae, C. pseudotropicalis, C. boidinii, C. utilis , and C. scehatae; Clostridium , such as C. acetobutylicum, C. thermocellum , and C. phytofermentans; E. coli , especially E.
- Geobacillus sp. Hansenula , such as Hansenula anomala
- Klebsiella such as K. oxytoca
- Kluyveromyces such as K. marxianus, K. lactis, K. thermotolerans , and K. fragilis
- Schizosaccharomyces such as S. pombe
- Thermoanaerobacter such as Thermoanaerobacter saccharolyticum
- Zymomonas such as Zymomonas mobilis.
- the yeast is a Bretannomyces . In a more preferred aspect, the yeast is Bretannomyces clausenii . In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Candida . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida sonorensis . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida boidinii . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida blankii. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida brassicae . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida diddensii . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida entomophiliia . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida pseudotropicalis . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida scehatae.
- the yeast is Candida utilis . In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Clavispora . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Clavispora lusitaniae . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Clavispora opuntiae . In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Kluyveromyces . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Kluyveromyces fragilis . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Kluyveromyces marxianus . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Kluyveromyces thermotolerans . In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Pachysolen . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Pachysolen tannophilus .
- the yeast is a Pichia . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is a Pichia stipitis . In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Saccharomyces spp. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Saccharomyces cerevisiae . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Saccharomyces distaticus . In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Saccharomyces uvarum.
- the bacterium is a Bacillus . In a more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Bacillus coagulans . In another preferred aspect, the bacterium is a Clostridium . In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Clostridium acetobutylicum . In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Clostridium phytofermentans . In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Clostridium thermocellum . In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Geobacillus sp. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is a Thermoanaerobacter . In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Thermoanaerobacter saccharolyticum . In another preferred aspect, the bacterium is a Zymomonas . In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Zymomonas mobilis.
- yeast suitable for ethanol production include, e.g., BIOFERMTM AFT and XR (NABC—North American Bioproducts Corporation, GA, USA), ETHANOL REDTM yeast (Fermentis/Lesaffre, USA), FALITM (Fleischmann's Yeast, USA), FERMIOLTM (DSM Specialties), GERT STRANDTM (Gert Strand AB, Sweden), and SUPERSTARTTM and THERMOSACCTM fresh yeast (Ethanol Technology, WI, USA).
- BIOFERMTM AFT and XR NABC—North American Bioproducts Corporation, GA, USA
- ETHANOL REDTM yeast Fermentis/Lesaffre, USA
- FALITM Feleischmann's Yeast, USA
- FERMIOLTM DSM Specialties
- GERT STRANDTM Gert Strand AB, Sweden
- SUPERSTARTTM and THERMOSACCTM fresh yeast Ethanol Technology, WI, USA.
- the fermenting microorganism has been genetically modified to provide the ability to ferment pentose sugars, such as xylose utilizing, arabinose utilizing, and xylose and arabinose co-utilizing microorganisms.
- the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Candida sonorensis .
- the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Escherichia coli .
- the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Klebsiella oxytoca .
- the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Kluyveromyces marxianus .
- the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Saccharomyces cerevisiae .
- the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Zymomonas mobilis.
- the fermenting microorganism is typically added to the degraded cellulosic material or hydrolysate and the fermentation is performed for about 8 to about 96 hours, e.g., about 24 to about 60 hours.
- the temperature is typically between about 26° C. to about 60° C., e.g., about 32° C. or 50° C., and about pH 3 to about pH 8, e.g., pH 4-5, 6, or 7.
- the yeast and/or another microorganism are applied to the degraded cellulosic material and the fermentation is performed for about 12 to about 96 hours, such as typically 24-60 hours.
- the temperature is preferably between about 20° C. to about 60° C., e.g., about 25° C. to about 50° C., about 32° C. to about 50° C., or about 32° C. to about 50° C.
- the pH is generally from about pH 3 to about pH 7, e.g., about pH 4 to about pH 7.
- some fermenting organisms, e.g., bacteria have higher fermentation temperature optima.
- Yeast or another microorganism is preferably applied in amounts of approximately 10 5 to 10 12 , preferably from approximately 10 7 to 10 10 , especially approximately 2 ⁇ 10 8 viable cell count per ml of fermentation broth. Further guidance in respect of using yeast for fermentation can be found in, e.g., “The Alcohol Textbook” (Editors K. Jacques, T. P. Lyons and D. R. Kelsall, Nottingham University Press, United Kingdom 1999), which is hereby incorporated by reference.
- a fermentation stimulator can be used in combination with any of the processes described herein to further improve the fermentation process, and in particular, the performance of the fermenting microorganism, such as, rate enhancement and ethanol yield.
- a “fermentation stimulator” refers to stimulators for growth of the fermenting microorganisms, in particular, yeast.
- Preferred fermentation stimulators for growth include vitamins and minerals. Examples of vitamins include multivitamins, biotin, pantothenate, nicotinic acid, meso-inositol, thiamine, pyridoxine, para-aminobenzoic acid, folic acid, riboflavin, and Vitamins A, B, C, D, and E.
- minerals include minerals and mineral salts that can supply nutrients comprising P, K, Mg, S, Ca, Fe, Zn, Mn, and Cu.
- a fermentation product can be any substance derived from the fermentation.
- the fermentation product can be, without limitation, an alcohol (e.g., arabinitol, n-butanol, isobutanol, ethanol, glycerol, methanol, ethylene glycol, 1,3-propanediol [propylene glycol], butanediol, glycerin, sorbitol, and xylitol); an alkane (e.g., pentane, hexane, heptane, octane, nonane, decane, undecane, and dodecane), a cycloalkane (e.g., cyclopentane, cyclohexane, cycloheptane, and cyclooctane), an alkene (e.g.
- an alcohol e.g., arabinitol, n-butanol, isobutanol
- pentene, hexene, heptene, and octene an amino acid (e.g., aspartic acid, glutamic acid, glycine, lysine, serine, and threonine); a gas (e.g., methane, hydrogen (H 2 ), carbon dioxide (CO 2 ), and carbon monoxide (CO)); isoprene; a ketone (e.g., acetone); an organic acid (e.g., acetic acid, acetonic acid, adipic acid, ascorbic acid, citric acid, 2,5-diketo-D-gluconic acid, formic acid, fumaric acid, glucaric acid, gluconic acid, glucuronic acid, glutaric acid, 3-hydroxypropionic acid, itaconic acid, lactic acid, malic acid, malonic acid, oxalic acid, oxaloacetic acid, propionic acid, succinic acid, and xylonic
- the fermentation product is an alcohol.
- the term “alcohol” encompasses a substance that contains one or more hydroxyl moieties.
- the alcohol is n-butanol.
- the alcohol is isobutanol.
- the alcohol is ethanol.
- the alcohol is methanol.
- the alcohol is arabinitol.
- the alcohol is butanediol.
- the alcohol is ethylene glycol.
- the alcohol is glycerin.
- the alcohol is glycerol.
- the alcohol is 1,3-propanediol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is sorbitol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is xylitol. See, for example, Gong, C. S., Cao, N. J., Du, J., and Tsao, G. T., 1999, Ethanol production from renewable resources, in Advances in Biochemical Engineering/Biotechnology , Scheper, T., ed., Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg, Germany, 65: 207-241; Silveira, M. M., and Jonas, R., 2002, The biotechnological production of sorbitol, Appl. Microbiol. Biotechnol.
- the fermentation product is an alkane.
- the alkane can be an unbranched or a branched alkane.
- the alkane is pentane.
- the alkane is hexane.
- the alkane is heptane.
- the alkane is octane.
- the alkane is nonane.
- the alkane is decane.
- the alkane is undecane.
- the alkane is dodecane.
- the fermentation product is a cycloalkane.
- the cycloalkane is cyclopentane.
- the cycloalkane is cyclohexane.
- the cycloalkane is cycloheptane.
- the cycloalkane is cyclooctane.
- the fermentation product is an alkene.
- the alkene can be an unbranched or a branched alkene.
- the alkene is pentene.
- the alkene is hexene.
- the alkene is heptene.
- the alkene is octene.
- the fermentation product is an amino acid.
- the organic acid is aspartic acid.
- the amino acid is glutamic acid.
- the amino acid is glycine.
- the amino acid is lysine.
- the amino acid is serine.
- the amino acid is threonine. See, for example, Richard, A., and Margaritis, A., 2004, Empirical modeling of batch fermentation kinetics for poly(glutamic acid) production and other microbial biopolymers, Biotechnology and Bioengineering 87 (4): 501-515.
- the fermentation product is a gas.
- the gas is methane.
- the gas is H 2 .
- the gas is CO 2 .
- the gas is CO. See, for example, Kataoka, N., A. Miya, and K. Kiriyama, 1997, Studies on hydrogen production by continuous culture system of hydrogen-producing anaerobic bacteria, Water Science and Technology 36 (6-7): 41-47; and Gunaseelan V. N. in Biomass and Bioenergy, Vol. 13 (1-2), pp. 83-114, 1997, Anaerobic digestion of biomass for methane production: A review.
- the fermentation product is isoprene.
- the fermentation product is a ketone.
- ketone encompasses a substance that contains one or more ketone moieties.
- the ketone is acetone. See, for example, Qureshi and Blaschek, 2003, supra.
- the fermentation product is an organic acid.
- the organic acid is acetic acid.
- the organic acid is acetonic acid.
- the organic acid is adipic acid.
- the organic acid is ascorbic acid.
- the organic acid is citric acid.
- the organic acid is 2,5-diketo-D-gluconic acid.
- the organic acid is formic acid.
- the organic acid is fumaric acid.
- the organic acid is glucaric acid.
- the organic acid is gluconic acid.
- the organic acid is glucuronic acid.
- the organic acid is glutaric acid. In another preferred aspect, the organic acid is 3-hydroxypropionic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is itaconic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is lactic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is malic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is malonic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is oxalic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is propionic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is succinic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is xylonic acid. See, for example, Chen, R., and Lee, Y. Y., 1997, Membrane-mediated extractive fermentation for lactic acid production from cellulosic biomass, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 63-65: 435-448.
- the fermentation product is polyketide
- the fermentation product(s) can be optionally recovered from the fermentation medium using any method known in the art including, but not limited to, chromatography, electrophoretic procedures, differential solubility, distillation, or extraction.
- alcohol is separated from the fermented cellulosic material and purified by conventional methods of distillation. Ethanol with a purity of up to about 96 vol. % can be obtained, which can be used as, for example, fuel ethanol, drinking ethanol, i.e., potable neutral spirits, or industrial ethanol.
- the present invention also relates to an isolated polynucleotide encoding a signal peptide comprising or consisting of amino acids 1 to 20 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 1 to 17 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 1 to 23 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 1 to 16 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 1 to 19 of SEQ ID NO: 10.
- the polynucleotides may further comprise a gene encoding a protein, which is operably linked to the signal peptide.
- the protein is preferably foreign to the signal peptide.
- the polynucleotide for the signal peptide is nucleotides 1 to 60 of SEQ ID NO: 1, nucleotides 1 to 51 of SEQ ID NO: 3, nucleotides 1 to 69 of SEQ ID NO: 5, nucleotides 1 to 48 of SEQ ID NO: 7, or nucleotides 1 to 57 of SEQ ID NO: 9.
- the present invention also relates to nucleic acid constructs, expression vectors and recombinant host cells comprising such polynucleotides.
- the present invention also relates to methods of producing a protein, comprising: (a) cultivating a recombinant host cell comprising such polynucleotide; and (b) recovering the protein
- the protein may be native or heterologous to a host cell.
- the term “protein” is not meant herein to refer to a specific length of the encoded product and, therefore, encompasses peptides, oligopeptides, and polypeptides.
- the term “protein” also encompasses two or more polypeptides combined to form the encoded product.
- the proteins also include hybrid polypeptides and fused polypeptides.
- the protein is a hormone, enzyme, receptor or portion thereof, antibody or portion thereof, or reporter.
- the protein may be a hydrolase, isomerase, ligase, lyase, oxidoreductase, or transferase, e.g., an alpha-galactosidase, alpha-glucosidase, aminopeptidase, amylase, beta-galactosidase, beta-glucosidase, beta-xylosidase, carbohydrase, carboxypeptidase, catalase, cellobiohydrolase, cellulase, chitinase, cutinase, cyclodextrin glycosyltransferase, deoxyribonuclease, endoglucanase, esterase, glucoamylase, invertase, laccase, lipase, mannosidase, mutanase, oxidas
- the gene may be obtained from any prokaryotic, eukaryotic, or other source.
- PDA plates were composed of 39 grams of potato dextrose agar and deionized water to 1 liter.
- YG agar plates were composed of 5.0 g of yeast extract, 10.0 g of glucose, 20.0 g of agar, and deionized water to 1 liter.
- YP medium was composed of 10 g of yeast extract, 20 g of Bactopeptone, and deionized water to 1 liter.
- YPG medium was composed of 2% peptone, 1% yeast extract, and 2% glucose in deionized water.
- LB medium was composed of 10 g of tryptone, 5 g of yeast extract, 5 g of sodium chloride, and deionized water to 1 liter.
- LB plates were composed of LB medium and 15 g of Bacto agar per liter of LB medium.
- NNCYP-PCS medium was composed of 5.0 g of NaNO 3 , 3.0 g of NH 4 CI, 2.0 g of MES, 2.5 g of citric acid, 0.2 g of CaCl 2 2H 2 O, 1.0 g of Bacto Peptone, 5.0 g of yeast extract, 0.2 g of MgSO 4 7H 2 O, 4.0 g of K 2 HPO 4 , 1.0 ml of COVE trace elements solution, 2.5 g of glucose, 25.0 g of pretreated corn stover (PCS), and deionized water to 1 liter.
- PCS pretreated corn stover
- COVE trace elements solution was composed of 0.04 g of Na 2 B 4 O 7 .10H 2 O, 0.4 g of CuSO 4 .5H 2 O, 1.2 g of FeSO 4 .7H 2 O, 0.7 g of MnSO 4 . H 2 O, 0.8 g of Na 2 MoO 2 .2H 2 O, 10 g of ZnSO 4 .7H 2 O, and deionized water to 1 liter.
- Aurantiporus alborubescens strain NN008024 was isolated from a soil from Yunnan, China by directly plating the soil sample onto a PDA plate followed by incubation at 37° C. for 5 days. The strain was then purified by transferring the mycelia onto an YG agar plate and identified as Aurantiporus alborubescens based on both morphological and molecular characterization (ITS sequencing).
- the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned as described below. Genomic DNA from Aurantiporus alborubescens strain NN008024 was isolated using a FASTDNA® SPIN Kit for Soil (MP Biomedicals, Solon, Ohio, USA) using a modification of the manufacturer's instructions. Briefly, the Kit was used with a FASTPREP®-24 Homogenization System (MP Biomedicals, Solon, Ohio, USA). A. alborubescens was grown in 5 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose for 48 hours at 30° C. Two ml of fungal material from the cultures were harvested by centrifugation at 14,000 ⁇ g for 2 minutes.
- the supernatant was removed and the pellet resuspended in 500 ⁇ l of deionized water.
- the suspension was transferred to a Lysing Matrix E tube (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) and 790 ⁇ l of sodium phosphate buffer and 100 ⁇ l of MT buffer (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) were added to the tube.
- the sample was then secured in a FASTPREPTM System (MP Biomedicals, Solon, Ohio, USA) and processed for 60 seconds at a speed of 5.5 m/second.
- the sample was then centrifuged at 14,000 ⁇ g for two minutes and the supernatant transferred to an EPPENDORF® tube.
- a 250 ⁇ l volume of PPS reagent from the FASTDNA® SPIN Kit was added and then the sample was mixed gently by inversion. The sample was again centrifuged at 14,000 ⁇ g for 5 minutes. The supernatant was transferred to a 15 ml FALCON® 2059 tube.
- One ml of Binding Matrix suspension (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) was added and then mixed by inversion for two minutes. The sample was placed in a stationary tube rack and the Binding Matrix was allowed to settle for 3 minutes. Then 500 ⁇ l of the supernatant were removed and discarded and the remaining sample was resuspended in the Binding Matrix.
- This sample was then transferred to a SPINTM filter (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) and centrifuged at 14,000 ⁇ g for 1 minute.
- the catch tube was emptied and the remaining matrix suspension added to the SPINTM filter.
- the sample was again centrifuged at 14,000 ⁇ g for 1 minute.
- a 500 ⁇ l volume of SEWS-M solution (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) was added to the SPINTM filter and the sample was centrifuged at the same speed for 1 minute.
- the catch tube was emptied and the SPINTM filter replaced in the catch tube.
- the unit was centrifuged at 14,000 ⁇ g for 2 minutes to dry the matrix of residual SEWS-M wash solution.
- the SPINTM filter was placed in a fresh catch tube and allowed to air dry for 5 minutes at room temperature.
- the matrix was gently resuspended in 100 ⁇ l of DES (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) with a pipet tip. The unit was centrifuged at 14,000 ⁇ g for 1 minute. The concentration of the DNA harvested from the catch tube was determined at 260 nm.
- DES FASTDNA® SPIN Kit
- the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned using the primers shown below.
- the PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon through the termination codon.
- the primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the Eco RI-Not I cloning site of plasmid pXYG1051 (WO 2005/080559).
- Primer Aua2-RI (SEQ ID NO: 11) 5′-GCG GAATTC AAC ATGCGAACCATCGCCA -3′
- Primer Aua2-NotI (SEQ ID NO: 12) 5′-ATAT GCGGCCGC A TAAGCAACTCCCTCAGAG -3′
- Bold letters represent A. alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence.
- the underlined sequence contains the Eco RI restriction site on the forward primer (Aua2-RI) and the Not I restriction site on the reverse primer (Aua2-NotI).
- the PCR reaction (50 ⁇ l) was composed of 25 ⁇ l of 2 ⁇ IPROOFTM HF Master Mix (Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc., Hercules, Calif., USA), 1 ⁇ l of primer Aua2-RI (100 ⁇ M), 1 ⁇ l of primer Aua2-NotI (100 ⁇ M), 1 ⁇ l of A. alborubescens genomic DNA (200 ng/ ⁇ l), and 22 ⁇ l of deionized water.
- the IPROOFTM HF Master Mix contains buffer, dNTPs, and a thermostable DNA polymerase blend.
- the PCR reaction was incubated in a DYAD® Dual-Block Thermal Cycler (MJ Research, Waltham, Mass., USA) programmed for 1 cycle at 98° C. for 60 seconds; 30 cycles each at 98° C. for 10 seconds, 50° C. for 30 seconds, and 72° C. for 60 seconds; and 1 cycle at 72° C. for 10 minutes. Samples were cooled to 10° C. before removal and further processing.
- a DYAD® Dual-Block Thermal Cycler MJ Research, Waltham, Mass., USA
- PCR reaction Five ⁇ l of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using 40 mM Tris base-20 mM sodium acetate-1 mM disodium EDTA (TAE) buffer where an approximately 1.1 kb product band was observed.
- TAE disodium EDTA
- the remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit (GE Healthcare, Buckinghamshire, UK) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- the methodology for cloning the A. alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence into a suitable expression vector and transformation of the vector into Aspergillus oryzae and selection of Aspergillus transformants producing the GH61 polypeptide is described in Example 2 of WO 2005/080559. Briefly, the purified PCR product was ligated into the Aspergillus expression vector pXYG1051 (WO 2005/080559), which is a derivative of pMSTr46 (WO 2003/070956) modified as described in WO 2005/080559. Plasmid pXYG1051 was digested with Eco RI-Not I.
- the 1.1 kb gene fragment and the digested vector were ligated together in a reaction (10.2 ⁇ l) composed of 1 ⁇ l of Eco RI-Not I digested pXYG1051 (10 ng/ ⁇ l of 10 mM Tris, 1 mM EDTA pH 7.5 [TE]), 8 ⁇ l of the Aua2 PCR fragment (30 ng/ ⁇ l), 1 ⁇ l of 10 ⁇ T4 DNA ligase buffer (Promega Corp., Madison, Wis., USA), and 0.2 ⁇ l of T4 DNA ligase (Promega Corp., Madison, Wis., USA). The reaction was incubated overnight at 16° C.
- a 1 ⁇ l volume of the ligation reaction mixture was transformed into ONE SHOT® TOP10 Chemically Competent E. coli cells (50 ⁇ l; Invitrogen, Carlsbad, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- the transformation was plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 100 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml and the plates were incubated overnight at 37° C. Six colonies were chosen from several hundred that grew under selection and inoculated into 2 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml in FALCON® tubes.
- Plasmid DNA was isolated using a QIAprep Spin Miniprep Kit (Qiagen GmBH, Hilden Germany) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- the plasmid DNA was digested with Eco RI and Hind III and the digests analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using 90 mM Tris-borate and 1 mM EDTA (TBE) buffer, which indicated that all six clones contained an insert of the correct size of 1.5 kb.
- the clones were then sequenced using an ABI 3730 XL Genetic Analyzer (Applied Biosystems, Foster City, Calif., USA).
- One error free clone designated E. coli NP001127-5 comprising the A. alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide genomic DNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 was selected.
- E. coli NP001127-5 was cultivated in 50 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated and purified using a Plasmid Midi Kit (Qiagen GmBH, Hilden Germany) according to the manufacturer's instructions. A quantity of 1.6 ⁇ g of Aua2 GH61 plasmid DNA was used to transform Aspergillus oryzae JaL355 (WO 2001/98484) protoplasts prepared according to the method of EP0238023 B1, (pages 14-15) for A. oryzae MT3568 protoplasts. Transformants were re-isolated twice under selective and non-inducing conditions on COVE minimal plates (Cove, 1966 , Biochim.
- A. oryzae EXP3192 One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing the Aau2 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis, was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP3192.
- A. oryzae EXP3192 was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
- a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art (GENEART AG, Regensburg, Germany) or DNA 2.0 (DNA2.0, Menlo Park, Calif., USA).
- the synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector.
- a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 1.
- the gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae .
- the GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 2.
- the genomic DNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 1 and SEQ ID NO: 2, respectively.
- the genomic DNA sequence contains 8 introns of 55 bp (nucleotides 120 to 174), 57 bp (nucleotides 232 to 288), 52 bp (nucleotides 437 to 488), 56 bp (nucleotides 555 to 610), 48 bp (nucleotides 782 to 829), 123 bp (nucleotides 933 to 1055), 55 bp (nucleotides 1151 to 1205), and 53 bp (nucleotides 1393 to 1445).
- the genomic DNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 322 amino acids.
- the % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 55.6%.
- Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997 , Protein Engineering 10: 1-6), a signal peptide of 20 residues was predicted.
- the SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010 , Biochemistry 49: 3305, and Quinlan et al., 2011 , Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 108: 15079).
- the predicted mature protein contains 302 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 31 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 6.64.
- the protein contains a carbohydrate binding module of the CBM1 type at the C terminus (amino acids 288 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2).
- the alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 76.83% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Moniliophthora perniciosa (SWI SSP ROT E2 LXA6).
- Culture broth prepared as described in Example 1 was concentrated approximately 20-fold using an Amicon ultrafiltration device (Millipore, Bedford, Mass., USA, 10 kDa polyethersulfone membrane, 40 psi, 4° C.). Protein concentration was determined using a BCA Protein Assay (BCA Protein Assay Kit; Thermo Fisher Scientific, Waltham, Mass., USA). Corn stover was pretreated and prepared as an assay substrate as described in WO 2005/074647 to generate pretreated corn stover (PCS). The base cellulase mixture used to assay enhancing activity was prepared from Trichoderma reesei strain SMA135 (WO 2008/057637).
- FIG. 1 The result of adding increasing amounts of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2GH61 polypeptide to the base cellulase mix are shown in FIG. 1 .
- the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned from a cDNA library using the primers shown below for cloning into plasmid pDau109 (WO 2005/042735).
- the PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon until the termination codon.
- the primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the Hind III-Bam HI cloning site of pDau109.
- Primer F-Aua1 (SEQ ID NO: 13) 5′-ACACAACTGG GGATCC ACC ATGAAGGCTATCTTGGCTATTT -3′
- Primer R-Aua1 (SEQ ID NO: 14) 5′-AGATCTCGAG AAGCTT A ACCACGCCACACAGCAGG -3′
- Bold letters represent A. alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence.
- the underlined sequence contains the Bam HI restriction site on the forward primer (F-Aua1) and the Hind III restriction site on the reverse primer (R-Aua1).
- a fragment can be produced that can be restricted with Bam HI and Hind III to produce another fragment that can be cloned directionally into a suitable vector with the same restriction sites. Additionally, the unrestricted fragment can be used for recombinational cloning into pDau109 using an IN-FUSIONTM PCR Cloning Kit (Clontech Laboratories, Inc., Mountain View, Calif., USA).
- a cDNA library was generated from A. alborubescens strain NN008024 according to the following protocol.
- A. alborubesens was inoculated into 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks containing 100 ml of NNCYP+PCS medium and incubated at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm.
- the fungal mycelia were harvested by filtration through MIRACLOTH® (Calbiochem, San Diego, Calif., USA) before being frozen in liquid nitrogen.
- the mycelia were then pulverized into a powder by milling the frozen mycelia together with an equal volume of dry ice in a KRUPS® KM 75 coffee grinder (Krups, Shelton, Conn., USA) precooled with liquid nitrogen.
- the powder was transferred into a liquid nitrogen prechilled mortar and pestle (previously baked at 250° C. for 12 hours) and ground to a fine powder with a small amount of baked quartz sand (baked at 250° C. for 12 hours).
- the powdered mycelial material was kept at ⁇ 80° C. until use.
- Total RNA was extracted according to a modified TRIZOL® method adapted for total RNA extraction for fungi.
- the samples were centrifuged at 12,000 ⁇ g for 10 minutes at room temperature and the top phase was then decanted to a new tube in which an equal volume of phenol-chloroform mix (Sigma Chemical, Co., St. Louis, Mo., USA) was added. The samples were centrifuged at 12,000 ⁇ g for 10 minutes. The top phase was transferred to a new tube and an equal volume of chloroform-isoamyl alcohol (24:1 v/v) was added. The samples were again centrifuged at 12,000 ⁇ g for 10 minutes.
- phenol-chloroform mix Sigma Chemical, Co., St. Louis, Mo., USA
- RNA pellets were resuspended in 300 ⁇ l of diethylpyrocarbonate (DEPC)-treated water.
- DEPC diethylpyrocarbonate
- RNA samples were heated at 65° C. for 10 minutes to aid in resuspension.
- the six dissolved RNA samples were all pooled into one tube and then ethanol precipitated. Briefly, 1/10 volume of RNase-free 3 M sodium acetate pH 5.2 was added followed by 2 volumes of RNase-free 96% ethanol. The sample was mixed and left to precipitate overnight at ⁇ 20 C. The sample was then centrifuged at 20,000 ⁇ g for 30 minutes at 4° C. The supernatant was removed and the pellet washed with 250 ⁇ l of RNase-free 70% ethanol. The supernatant was carefully removed and the pellet allowed to air dry. The RNA pellet was then resuspended in 300 ⁇ l of DEPC-treated water and stored at ⁇ 80° C. until use.
- PolyA enriched RNA was made from the total RNA and isolated using an mTRAPTM Maxi mRNA Purification Kit (ActiveMotif Inc., Carlsbad, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- the cDNA library was constructed with a SMARTTM cDNA Library Construction Kit (Clontech Laboratories, Inc., Mountain View, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- the cDNA was size selected with a molecular weight cut-off of 500 base pairs by agarose gel electrophoresis.
- the plasmid pMHas10 (SEQ ID NO: 11) was used instead of the phage vector supplied with the Kit.
- Plasmid pMHas10 was prepared by restricting 5 ⁇ g of the plasmid with Sfi I and isolating the plasmid from the stuffer insert by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer.
- Plasmid DNA was isolated from a pool of 50,000 colonies, scraped from LB plates supplemented with 50 ⁇ g of kanamycin per ml. Plasmid DNA from the pooled bacteria was used for preparation of a plasmid library using the JETSTAR® 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol (GenoMed GmbH, Löhne, Germany).
- the cDNA library was diluted to 100 ng/ ⁇ l in MilliQ water and used as template for a PCR reaction using the Aua1 primers.
- the conditions were identical to those used for producing the PCR fragment in Example 1 except that primer F-Aua1 and primer R-Aua1 were used.
- PCR product Five ⁇ l of the PCR product were analyzed by 1% agarose electrophoresis using TAE buffer, which showed the presence of a single band with the predicted size of 740 bp.
- the remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit.
- An IN-FUSIONTM PCR Cloning Kit was used for cloning the fragments into plasmid pDau109. Two ⁇ g of pDau109 was digested with Bam HI and Hind III and the digested plasmid was run on a 1% agarose gel using TBE buffer in order to remove the stuffer fragment from the restricted plasmid.
- the bands were visualized by the addition of SYBR® Safe DNA gel stain (Invitrogen Inc., Carlsbad, Calif., USA) into the agarose gel and use of a 470 nm wavelength transilluminator.
- the band corresponding to the restricted plasmid was excised from the gel and purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit.
- the plasmid was eluted into 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 and its concentration adjusted to 20 ng/ ⁇ l.
- the 750 bp PCR fragment (50 ng) was cloned into plasmid pDau109 (20 ng) digested with Bam HI and Hind III.
- the reaction was transformed into FUSION-BLUETM E. coli cells (Clontech Laboratories, Inc., Mountain View, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's protocol and plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 50 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml. After incubation overnight at 37° C., colonies were observed growing under selection on the LB ampicillin plates.
- Ten colonies transformed with the Aau1 GH61 construct were cultivated in LB medium supplemented with 50 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml and plasmid was isolated using a JETQUICKTM Plasmid Purification Spin Kit (GenoMed GmbH, Löhne, Germany) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- Isolated plasmids were sequenced with vector primers in order to determine a representative plasmid expression clone that was free of PCR errors.
- One error free Aau1 GH61 clone comprising SEQ ID NO: 3 was selected for further work.
- Plasmid DNA was then isolated using a JETQUICKTM 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol (GenoMed GmbH, LOhne, Germany). Transformation of the selected plasmid into Aspergillus oryzae JaL355 was performed as described in Example 1.
- oryzae EXP3380 A. oryzae EXP 3380 strain was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
- a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0.
- the synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector.
- a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 3.
- the gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described in Example 1 and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae .
- the GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 4.
- the cDNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the A. alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 3 and SEQ ID NO: 4, respectively.
- the cDNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 234 amino acids.
- the % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 56%.
- Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 17 residues was predicted.
- the SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra).
- the predicted mature protein contains 217 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 23 kDa and an isoelectric point of 5.97.
- the alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the A. alborubescens Aua1 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 62.09% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Schizophyllum commune H4-8 (SWISSPROT D8QHH2).
- Two synthetic oligonucleotide primers shown below were designed to PCR amplify the Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70 GH61 gene from a cDNA library prepared according to WO 2010/088387.
- the PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon until the termination codon.
- the primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the cloning site for Hind III-Bam HI digested pDau109.
- Primer F-Tsa1 (SEQ ID NO: 15) 5′-ACACAACTGG GGATCC ACC ATGACGCCCCTGAAACTCC -3′
- Primer R-Tsa1 (SEQ ID NO: 16) 5′-AGATCTCGAG AAGCTT A CTTACCGGTCCAAACCGGT -3′
- Bold letters represent Trichophaea saccata Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence. Restriction sites are underlined. The remaining sequence is homologous to the insertion sites of pDau109.
- the PCR reaction (40 ⁇ l) was composed of 20 ⁇ l of 2 ⁇ IPROOFTM HF Master Mix, 1 ⁇ l of primer F-Tsa1 (100 ⁇ M), 1 ⁇ l of primer R-Tsa1 (100 ⁇ M), 1 ⁇ l of cDNA (100 ng/ ⁇ l), and 17 ⁇ l of deionized water.
- the PCR reaction was incubated in a DYAD® Dual-Block Thermal Cycler programmed for 1 cycle at 98° C. for 60 seconds; 30 cycles each at 98° C. for 10 seconds, 55° C. for 10 seconds, and 72° C. for 60 seconds; and 1 cycle at 72° C. for 10 minutes. Samples were cooled to 10° C. before removal and further processing.
- PCR reaction Five ⁇ l of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 750 bp product band was observed. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- Plasmid pDau109 (2 ⁇ g) was digested with the restriction enzymes Bam HI and Hind III and the digested plasmid was run on a 1% agarose gel using TBE buffer in order to remove the stuffer fragment from the restricted plasmid.
- the bands were visualized by the addition of SYBR® Safe DNA gel stain into the agarose gel and use of a 470 nm wavelength transilluminator.
- the band corresponding to the restricted plasmid was excised and purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit.
- the plasmid was eluted into 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 and its concentration adjusted to 20 ng/ ⁇ l.
- An IN-FUSIONTM PCR Cloning Kit was used to clone the 750 bp PCR fragment (50 ng) into pDau109 digested with Bam HI and Hind III (20 ng).
- the IN-FUSIONTM reaction was transformed into FUSION-BLUETM E. coli cells according to the manufacturer's protocol and plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 50 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml. After incubation overnight at 37° C., colonies were observed growing under selection on the LB ampicillin plates. Ten transformants were selected at random and cultivated in LB medium supplemented with 50 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a JETQUICKTM Plasmid Purification Spin Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- Isolated plasmids were sequenced with vector primers in order to determine a representative plasmid expression clone that was free of PCR errors.
- One error-free Tsa1 GH61 clone was selected.
- Plasmid DNA was then isolated using the JETSTAR® 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol.
- the purified plasmid DNA was transformed into Aspergillus oryzae Bech2 according to the method described in WO 2005/042735, pages 34-35 .
- Aspergillus transformants were grown and then analyzed for production of Tsa1 GH61 protein by SDS-PAGE analysis according to Example 1.
- A. oryzae EXP3315 was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
- a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0.
- the synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector.
- a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 5.
- the gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae .
- the GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 6.
- the cDNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70 Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 5 and SEQ ID NO: 6, respectively.
- the cDNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 233 amino acids.
- the G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 59%.
- Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 23 residues was predicted.
- the SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra).
- the predicted mature protein contains 210 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 23 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 5.08.
- the alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa1 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 57.21% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Aspergillus terreus (SWISSPROT Q0CJQ7).
- the Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70 Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned using the cDNA library obtained according to Example 7 and the primers shown below for cloning into pDau109.
- the PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon through the termination codon.
- the primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the Hind III-Bam HI cloning site of pDau109.
- Primer F-Tsa2 (SEQ ID NO: 17) 5′-ACACAACTGG GGATCC ACC ATGAAATGCCTTCTCTCCCT -3′
- Primer R-Tsa2 (SEQ ID NO: 18) 5′-AGATCTCGAG AAGCTT A GCATGTAAACGGCCTTGGG -3′
- Bold letters represent T. saccata Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence. Restriction site are underlined. The remaining sequence is homologous to the insertion sites of pDau109.
- the PCR reaction (40 ⁇ l) was composed of 20 ⁇ l of 2 ⁇ IPROOFTM HF Master Mix, 1 ⁇ l of primer F-Tsa2 (100 ⁇ M), 1 ⁇ l of primer R-Tsa2 (100 ⁇ M), 1 ⁇ l of cDNA (100 ng/ ⁇ l), and 17 ⁇ l of deionized water.
- the PCR reaction was incubated in a DYAD® Dual-Block Thermal Cycler programmed for 1 cycle at 98° C. for 60 seconds; 30 cycles each at 98° C. for 10 seconds, 55° C. for 10 seconds, and 72° C. for 60 seconds; and 1 cycle at 72° C. for 10 minutes. Samples were cooled to 10° C. before removal and further processing.
- PCR reaction Five ⁇ l of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 735 bp product band was observed. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- An IN-FUSIONTM PCR Cloning Kit was used for cloning the 735 bp PCR fragment into the vector pDau109 prepared as described in Example 4.
- the IN-FUSIONTM cloning was performed according to the manufacturer's instructions and Example 4 for pDau109 and the Tsa2 insert.
- the IN-FUSIONTM reaction was then transformed into FUSION-BLUETM E. coli cells according to the manufacturer's protocol and plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 50 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml. After incubation overnight at 37° C., colonies were observed growing under selection. Ten transformants were selected at random and cultivated in LB medium supplemented with 50 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a JETQUICKTM Plasmid Purification Spin Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- Isolated plasmids were sequenced with vector primers in order to determine a representative plasmid expression clone that was free of PCR errors. One error-free Tsa2 GH61 clone was selected. Plasmid DNA was then isolated using the JETSTAR® 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol. The purified plasmid DNA was transformed into Aspergillus oryzae Bech2 according to the method described in WO 2005/042735, pages 34-35. The transformants were grown and their culture broths analyzed as described in Example 1. For transformants producing recombinant protein, a protein band of 23 kDa was observed.
- A. oryzae EXP3316 One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing acceptable levels of the Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis, was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP3316.
- A. oryzae EXP3316 was fermented as described in Example 7 to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
- a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0.
- the synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector.
- a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 7.
- the gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae .
- the GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 8.
- the cDNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 7 and SEQ ID NO: 8, respectively.
- the cDNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 237 amino acids.
- the % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 54%.
- Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 16 residues was predicted.
- the SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra).
- the predicted mature protein contains 221 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 24 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 6.2.
- the alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa2 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 56.62% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Moniliophthora perniciosa FA553 (SWISSPROT E2LQM6) and Coprinopsis cinerea (SWISSPROT_A8NRC9).
- Penicillium thomii was isolated from a Crocus bulb in Denmark by Prof. Jen Frisvad at the Danish Technical University (DTU) and preserved under the accession number IBT 10776 at the IBT Culture Collection of Fungi, Danish Technical University, Denmark.
- Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 core fragment was cloned by PCR using the degenerate primers shown below, which were designed to amplify a conserved core region of the GH61 polypeptide gene utilizing the Codehop procedure (Rose et al., 1998 , Nucleic Acids Res. 26: 1628-1635). Genomic DNA was isolated from Penicillium thomii according to the method in Example 1.
- Primer GH61CHS3 (SEQ ID NO: 19) 5′-ACCGTCGACAAGACCCAGCTCGAGTTYTTYAARAT-3′
- Primer GH61A_76_a (SEQ ID NO: 20) 5′-GGCGCCGTGGAGGGCDATGATYTCRTGNC-3′
- the PCR reaction (15 ⁇ l) was composed of 7.5 ⁇ l of Extensor Hi-Fidelity Master Mix (ABgene, Epsom, United Kingdom), 0.5 ⁇ l of P. thomii genomic DNA (100 ng), 0.5 ⁇ l of primer GH61CHS3 (10 mM), 0.5 ⁇ l of primer GH61A_76_a (10 mM), and 6.0 ⁇ l of deionized water.
- the PCR reaction was incubated in a DNA Engine Cycler (MJ Research, Waltham, Mass., USA) programmed for:
- Step 1 at 94° C. for 2 minutes
- Step 2 at 94° C. for 15 seconds
- Step 3 at 68° C. for 30 seconds; the temperature was decreased by 1° C. per cycle.
- Step 4 at 68° C. for 1 minutes and 45 seconds;
- Steps 2-4 were repeated for 9 cycles;
- Step 6 at 94° C. for 2 minutes
- Step 7 at 94° C. for 15 seconds
- Step 8 at 58° C. for 30 seconds
- Step 9 at 68° C. for 1 minute and 45 seconds;
- Step 10 repeat
- Step 11 at 68° C. for 7 minutes.
- PCR reaction Five ⁇ l of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 200 bp product band was observed. The band was excised from the gel, purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions, and sequenced using appropriately diluted PCR primers for Sanger sequencing.
- the core fragment sequence was used to design DNA primers shown below for primer walking using a DNA Walking SpeedUpTM Kit I (Seegene Inc., Rockville, Md., USA).
- Primer PtzTCPD1 (SEQ ID NO: 21) 5′-TGATCAGCGATACCACCGAGC-3′
- Primer Pt-TSP1D (SEQ ID NO: 22) 5′-CAATAGCCGTACTGTCACCGTCC-3′
- Primer Pt-TSP2D (SEQ ID NO: 23) 5′-CAGGGTGGTTTGATCAGCGATACCAC-3′
- the amplification was performed according to the Kit's protocol, except that the Extensor Hi Fidelity PCR Master Mix was used.
- the first round of PCR with the above primers resulted in three PCR bands each of about 3 kb in size.
- the PCR bands were sequenced with the PTSP1D primer.
- the resulting sequence was assembled onto the existing previous 500 bp DNA fragment using the SeqMan sequence assembly program of the DNAStar v6.1 software suite (DNA Star Inc., Madison, Wis., USA). The resulting 744 bp fragment was used to design three new DNA walking primers shown below.
- Primer Pt-TSP1U (SEQ ID NO: 24) 5′-GGACGGTGACAGTACGGCTATTG-3′
- Primer PtzTCP2u (SEQ ID NO: 25) 5′-CGATGAGGTTGTCAGTTGCCCAGG-3′
- Primer Pt-TSP2U (SEQ ID NO: 26) 5′-GTGGTATCGCTGATCAAACCACCCTG-3′
- the PCR reaction was composed of 4 ⁇ l of P. thomii genomic DNA (50 ng/ ⁇ l), 1 ⁇ l of DNA Walking primer (DW-ACP 1, 2, 3, or 4), 1 ⁇ l of primer Pt-TSP1U (100 mM), 25 ⁇ l of 2 ⁇ REDDYMIXTM (AB Gene, ABgene, Epsom, United Kingdom), which includes, buffer, dNTPs, and DNA polymerase, (AB Gene, ABgene, Epsom, United Kingdom), and 18 ⁇ l of deionized water.
- DNA cycling conditions and the two subsequent PCR steps were performed according to the protocol described for the DNA Walking SpeedUpTM Kit I with the following primers:
- PCR fragments were cloned into a TA cloning vector using a pGEM®-T Vector System I (Promega Corp., Madison, Wis., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions. Ligated products were transformed into ONE SHOT® TOP10 Chemically Competent E. coli cells and E. coli colonies were selected based on blue white selection as detailed in the pGEM®-T Vector System I instructions. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a JETQUICKTM Plasmid Purification Spin Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions and the pGEM plasmids were sequenced using vector primers also detailed in the pGEM®-T Vector System I instructions.
- the PCR generated fragment containing the GH61 polypeptide coding sequence is 1455 bp (including stop codon) and contains no introns.
- Primer F-P33YA (SEQ ID NO: 29) 5′-GCG GAATTC ACC ATGTCTCTGTCTAAGATTTCTGGA -3′
- Primer R-P33YA (SEQ ID NO: 30) 5′-ATAT GCGGCCGCC TTCTAGTTGATGGTAATATCACGAGC -3′
- Bold letters represent Pt1 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence.
- the underlined sequence contains the Eco RI restriction site on the forward PCR primer (F-P33YA) and the Not I restriction site on the reverse primer (R-P33YA).
- PCR reaction Five ⁇ l of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 1.4 kb product band was observed. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions. The purified PCR fragment was then digested with Eco RI and Not I and again purified using an ILLUSTRATM GFXTM PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit with a final elution volume of 50 ⁇ l of 10 mM Tris pH 8.0.
- the purified and Eco RI-Not I digested 1.4 kb PCR product was ligated into the Aspergillus expression vector pXYG1051 digested with Eco RI-Not I.
- the ligation (10.2 ⁇ l) was composed of 1 ⁇ l of Eco RI-Not I digested pXYG1051 (10 ng/ ⁇ l of TE), 8 ⁇ l of the Pt1 PCR fragment (approximately 50 ng/ ⁇ l), 1 ⁇ l of 10 ⁇ T4 DNA ligase buffer, and 0.2 ⁇ l of T4 DNA ligase. The reaction was incubated overnight at 16° C.
- a 1 ⁇ l volume of the ligation reaction mixture was transformed into ONE SHOT® TOP10 Chemically Competent E. coli cells (50 ⁇ l) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- the transformation was plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 100 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml and the plates were incubated overnight at 37° C. Six colonies were chosen that grew under selection and inoculated into 2 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml in FALCON® tubes. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a QIAprep Spin Miniprep Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
- the plasmid DNA was digested with Eco RI and Hind III and the digests analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TBE buffer, which indicated that all six clones contained an insert of the correct size (1450 bp).
- the clones were then sequenced with an ABI 3730 XL Genetic Analyzer.
- One error-free clone comprising the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 polypeptide genomic DNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9 was selected.
- the E. coli clone was cultivated in 50 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 ⁇ g of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated and purified using a Plasmid Midi Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions. A quantity of 1.6 ⁇ g of Pt1 GH61 ⁇ lasmid DNA was used to transform Aspergillus oryzae JaL355 (WO 2001/98484) according to the protocol described in Example 1. Eighteen transformants were selected for further characterization by SDS-PAGE analysis of the culture broths as described in Example 1. Several transformant culture fluids contained a protein band of 65 kDa. An explanation of the larger than predicted size of 45 kDa is probably the result of glycosylation.
- A. oryzae EXP03119 One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing Pt11 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis, was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP03119.
- A. oryzae EXP03119 was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
- a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0.
- the synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector.
- a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 9.
- the gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae .
- the GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 10.
- the genomic DNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 9 and SEQ ID NO: 10, respectively.
- the genomic DNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 484 amino acids.
- the % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 53.4%.
- Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 19 residues was predicted.
- the SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra).
- the predicted mature protein contains 465 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 48 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 4.4.
- the GH61 core catalytic domain is amino acids 20 to 247 of SEQ ID NO
- the alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61A mature polypeptide shares 65.2% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Neosartorya fischeri (SWISSPROT A1D2G7).
- An isolated polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity selected from the group consisting of: (a) a polypeptide having at least 60% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6 or SEQ ID NO: 8; at least 65% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4; at least 70% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10; or at least 80% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2; (b) a polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under medium-high conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (i
- polypeptide of paragraph 1 having at least 60%, at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6 or SEQ ID NO: 8; at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4; at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 95%, at
- polypeptide of paragraph 1 or 2 which is encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under medium-high, high, or very high stringency conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (iii) the full-length complement of (i) or (ii).
- polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-3 which is encoded by a polynucleotide having at least 60%, at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 5 or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%,
- polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-4 comprising or consisting of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
- polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-4 comprising or consisting of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
- polypeptide of paragraph 6 wherein the mature polypeptide is amino acids 21 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 18 to 234 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 24 to 233 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 17 to 237 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 20 to 484 of SEQ ID NO: 10.
- polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-4 which is a fragment of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10, wherein the fragment has cellulolytic enhancing activity.
- composition comprising the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9.
- a nucleic acid construct or expression vector comprising the polynucleotide of paragraph 11 operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the production of the polypeptide in an expression host.
- a recombinant host cell comprising the polynucleotide of paragraph 11 operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the production of the polypeptide.
- a method of producing the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9, comprising cultivating a cell, which in its wild-type form produces the polypeptide, under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
- a method of producing a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprising cultivating the host cell of paragraph 13 under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
- a method of producing a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprising cultivating the transgenic plant or plant cell of paragraph 18 under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
- a method of producing a mutant of a parent cell comprising inactivating a polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9, which results in the mutant producing less of the polypeptide than the parent cell.
- mutant cell of paragraph 22 further comprising a gene encoding a native or heterologous protein.
- a method of producing a protein comprising cultivating the mutant cell of paragraph 22 or 23 under conditions conducive for production of the protein.
- dsRNA double-stranded inhibitory RNA
- dsRNA double-stranded inhibitory RNA
- a method of inhibiting the expression of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity in a cell comprising administering to the cell or expressing in the cell the double-stranded inhibitory RNA (dsRNA) molecule, wherein the dsRNA of paragraph 26 or 27.
- dsRNA double-stranded inhibitory RNA
- a method of producing a protein comprising cultivating the cell of paragraph 29 or 30 under conditions conducive for production of the protein.
- a nucleic acid construct or expression vector comprising a gene encoding a protein operably linked to the polynucleotide of paragraph 33, wherein the gene is foreign to the polynucleotide encoding the signal peptide.
- a recombinant host cell comprising a gene encoding a protein operably linked to the polynucleotide of paragraph 33, wherein the gene is foreign to the polynucleotide encoding the signal peptide.
- a method of producing a protein comprising cultivating a recombinant host cell comprising a gene encoding a protein operably linked to the polynucleotide of paragraph 33, wherein the gene is foreign to the polynucleotide encoding the signal peptide, under conditions conducive for production of the protein.
- a method for degrading or converting a cellulosic material comprising: treating the cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of the polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of any of paragraphs 1-9.
- the enzyme composition comprises one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an expansin, an esterase, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
- cellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase.
- the hemicellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a xylanase, an acetyxylan esterase, a feruloyl esterase, an arabinofuranosidase, a xylosidase, and a glucuronidase.
- a method for producing a fermentation product comprising: (a) saccharifying a cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of the polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of any of paragraphs 1-9; (b) fermenting the saccharified cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms to produce the fermentation product; and (c) recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
- the enzyme composition comprises one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an expansin, an esterase, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
- cellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase.
- hemicellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a xylanase, an acetyxylan esterase, a feruloyl esterase, an arabinofuranosidase, a xylosidase, and a glucuronidase.
- a method of fermenting a cellulosic material comprising: fermenting the cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms, wherein the cellulosic material is saccharified with an enzyme composition in the presence of the polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of any of paragraphs 1-9.
- the enzyme composition comprises one or more enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an expansin, an esterase, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
- cellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase.
- hemicellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a xylanase, an acetyxylan esterase, a feruloyl esterase, an arabinofuranosidase, a xylosidase, and a glucuronidase.
- a whole broth formulation or cell culture composition comprising the polypeptide of any of claims 1 - 9 .
Landscapes
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
- Zoology (AREA)
- Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
- Biotechnology (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Biochemistry (AREA)
- Molecular Biology (AREA)
- Microbiology (AREA)
- Biomedical Technology (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
- General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Biophysics (AREA)
- Nutrition Science (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Cell Biology (AREA)
- Plant Pathology (AREA)
- Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
- Mycology (AREA)
- Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
- Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
- Micro-Organisms Or Cultivation Processes Thereof (AREA)
- Enzymes And Modification Thereof (AREA)
- Preparation Of Compounds By Using Micro-Organisms (AREA)
Abstract
The present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and isolated polynucleotides encoding the polypeptides. The invention also relates to nucleic acid constructs, vectors, and host cells comprising the polynucleotides as well as methods of producing and using the polypeptides.
Description
This application is a divisional application of U.S. application Ser. No. 14/004,141 filed Mar. 9, 2012, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,409,958, which is a 35 U.S.C. §371 national application of PCT/US2012/028483 filed Mar. 9, 2012, which claims priority or the benefit under 35 U.S.C. §119 of U.S. Provisional Application Ser. No. 61/451,413, filed Mar. 10, 2011, the contents of which are fully incorporated herein by reference.
This invention was made with Government support under Cooperative Agreement DE-FC36-08G018080 awarded by the Department of Energy. The government has certain rights in this invention.
This application contains a Sequence Listing in computer readable form, which is incorporated herein by reference.
Field of the Invention
The present invention relates to polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding the polypeptides. The invention also relates to nucleic acid constructs, vectors, and host cells comprising the polynucleotides as well as methods of producing and using the polypeptides.
Description of the Related Art
Cellulose is a polymer of the simple sugar glucose covalently linked by beta-1,4-bonds. Many microorganisms produce enzymes that hydrolyze beta-linked glucans. These enzymes include endoglucanases, cellobiohydrolases, and beta-glucosidases.
Endoglucanases digest the cellulose polymer at random locations, opening it to attack by cellobiohydrolases. Cellobiohydrolases sequentially release molecules of cellobiose from the ends of the cellulose polymer. Cellobiose is a water-soluble beta-1,4-linked dimer of glucose. Beta-glucosidases hydrolyze cellobiose to glucose.
The conversion of lignocellulosic feedstocks into ethanol has the advantages of the ready availability of large amounts of feedstock, the desirability of avoiding burning or land filling the materials, and the cleanliness of the ethanol fuel. Wood, agricultural residues, herbaceous crops, and municipal solid wastes have been considered as feedstocks for ethanol production. These materials primarily consist of cellulose, hemicellulose, and lignin. Once the lignocellulose is converted to fermentable sugars, e.g., glucose, the fermentable sugars are easily fermented by yeast into ethanol.
WO 2005/074647, WO 2008/148131, and WO 2011/035027 disclose isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thielavia terrestris. WO 2005/074656 and WO 2010/065830 disclose isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thermoascus aurantiacus. WO 2007/089290 discloses an isolated GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotide thereof from Trichoderma reesei. WO 2009/085935, WO 2009/085859, WO 2009/085864, and WO 2009/085868 disclose isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Myceliophthora thermophila. WO 2010/138754 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Aspergillus fumigatus. WO 2011/005867 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Penicillium pinophilum. WO 2011/039319 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thermoascus sp. WO 2011/041397 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Penicillium sp. WO 2011/041504 discloses isolated GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides thereof from Thermoascus crustaceus. WO 2008/151043 discloses methods of increasing the activity of a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity by adding a soluble activating divalent metal cation to a composition comprising the polypeptide.
The present invention provides GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding the polypeptides.
The present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity selected from the group consisting of:
(a) a polypeptide having at least 60% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6 or SEQ ID NO: 8, at least 65% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4, at least 70% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10, or at least 80% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2;
(b) a polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under medium-high, high, or very high stringency conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (iii) the full-length complement of (i) or (ii);
(c) a polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide having at least 60% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 5 or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 65% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 70% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9; or at least 80% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof;
(d) a variant of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 comprising a substitution, deletion, and/or insertion at one or more (e.g., several) positions; and
(e) a fragment of the polypeptide of (a), (b), (c), or (d) that has cellulolytic enhancing activity.
The present invention also relates to isolated polynucleotides encoding the polypeptides of the present invention; nucleic acid constructs; recombinant expression vectors; recombinant host cells comprising the polynucleotides; and methods of producing the polypeptides.
The present invention also relates to methods for degrading or converting a cellulosic material, comprising: treating the cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide of the present invention.
The present invention also relates to methods for producing a fermentation product, comprising: (a) saccharifying a cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide of the present invention; (b) fermenting the saccharified cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms to produce the fermentation product; and (c) recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
The present invention also relates to methods of fermenting a cellulosic material, comprising: fermenting the cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms, wherein the cellulosic material is saccharified with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide of the present invention.
The present invention also relates to a polynucleotide encoding a signal peptide comprising or consisting of amino acids 1 to 20 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 1 to 17 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 1 to 23 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 1 to 16 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 1 to 19 of SEQ ID NO: 10, which is operably linked to a gene encoding a protein; nucleic acid constructs, expression vectors, and recombinant host cells comprising the polynucleotides; and methods of producing a protein.
Acetylxylan esterase: The term “acetylxylan esterase” means a carboxylesterase (EC 3.1.1.72) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of acetyl groups from polymeric xylan, acetylated xylose, acetylated glucose, alpha-napthyl acetate, and p-nitrophenyl acetate. For purposes of the present invention, acetylxylan esterase activity is determined using 0.5 mM p-nitrophenylacetate as substrate in 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5.0 containing 0.01% TWEEN™ 20 (polyoxyethylene sorbitan monolaurate). One unit of acetylxylan esterase is defined as the amount of enzyme capable of releasing 1 μmole of p-nitrophenolate anion per minute at pH 5, 25° C.
Allelic variant: The term “allelic variant” means any of two or more alternative forms of a gene occupying the same chromosomal locus. Allelic variation arises naturally through mutation, and may result in polymorphism within populations. Gene mutations can be silent (no change in the encoded polypeptide) or may encode polypeptides having altered amino acid sequences. An allelic variant of a polypeptide is a polypeptide encoded by an allelic variant of a gene.
Alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase: The term “alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase” means an alpha-L-arabinofuranoside arabinofuranohydrolase (EC 3.2.1.55) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of terminal non-reducing alpha-L-arabinofuranoside residues in alpha-L-arabinosides. The enzyme acts on alpha-L-arabinofuranosides, alpha-L-arabinans containing (1,3)- and/or (1,5)-linkages, arabinoxylans, and arabinogalactans. Alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase is also known as arabinosidase, alpha-arabinosidase, alpha-L-arabinosidase, alpha-arabinofuranosidase, polysaccharide alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase, alpha-L-arabinofuranoside hydrolase, L-arabinosidase, or alpha-L-arabinanase. For purposes of the present invention, alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase activity is determined using 5 mg of medium viscosity wheat arabinoxylan (Megazyme International Ireland, Ltd., Bray, Co. Wicklow, Ireland) per ml of 100 mM sodium acetate pH 5 in a total volume of 200 μl for 30 minutes at 40° C. followed by arabinose analysis by AMINEX® HPX-87H column chromatography (Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc., Hercules, Calif., USA).
Alpha-glucuronidase: The term “alpha-glucuronidase” means an alpha-D-glucosiduronate glucuronohydrolase (EC 3.2.1.139) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of an alpha-D-glucuronoside to D-glucuronate and an alcohol. For purposes of the present invention, alpha-glucuronidase activity is determined according to de Vries, 1998, J. Bacteriol. 180: 243-249. One unit of alpha-glucuronidase equals the amount of enzyme capable of releasing 1 μmole of glucuronic or 4-O-methylglucuronic acid per minute at pH 5, 40° C.
Beta-glucosidase: The term “beta-glucosidase” means a beta-D-glucoside glucohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.21) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of terminal non-reducing beta-D-glucose residues with the release of beta-D-glucose. For purposes of the present invention, beta-glucosidase activity is determined using p-nitrophenyl-beta-D-glucopyranoside as substrate according to the procedure of Venturi et al., 2002, Extracellular beta-D-glucosidase from Chaetomium thermophilum var. coprophilum: production, purification and some biochemical properties, J. Basic Microbiol. 42: 55-66. One unit of beta-glucosidase is defined as 1.0 μmole of p-nitrophenolate anion produced per minute at 25° C., pH 4.8 from 1 mM p-nitrophenyl-beta-D-glucopyranoside as substrate in 50 mM sodium citrate containing 0.01% TWEEN® 20.
Beta-xylosidase: The term “beta-xylosidase” means a beta-D-xyloside xylohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.37) that catalyzes the exo-hydrolysis of short beta (1→4)-xylool igosaccharides, to remove successive D-xylose residues from non-reducing termini. For purposes of the present invention, one unit of beta-xylosidase is defined as 1.0 μmole of p-nitrophenolate anion produced per minute at 40° C., pH 5 from 1 mM p-nitrophenyl-beta-D-xyloside as substrate in 100 mM sodium citrate containing 0.01% TWEEN® 20.
Catalytic domain: The term “catalytic domain” means the portion of an enzyme containing the catalytic machinery of the enzyme.
Cellobiohydrolase: The term “cellobiohydrolase” means a 1,4-beta-D-glucan cellobiohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.91 and E.C. 3.2.1.176) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of 1,4-beta-D-glucosidic linkages in cellulose, cellooligosaccharides, or any beta-1,4-linked glucose containing polymer, releasing cellobiose from the reducing or non-reducing ends of the chain (Teeri, 1997, Crystalline cellulose degradation: New insight into the function of cellobiohydrolases, Trends in Biotechnology 15: 160-167; Teeri et al., 1998, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolases: why so efficient on crystalline cellulose?, Biochem. Soc. Trans. 26: 173-178). Cellobiohydrolase activity is determined according to the procedures described by Lever et al., 1972, Anal. Biochem. 47: 273-279; van Tilbeurgh et al., 1982, FEBS Letters, 149: 152-156; van Tilbeurgh and Claeyssens, 1985, FEBS Letters, 187: 283-288; and Tomme et al., 1988, Eur. J. Biochem. 170: 575-581. In the present invention, the Tomme et al. method can be used to determine cellobiohydrolase activity.
Cellulolytic enzyme or cellulase: The term “cellulolytic enzyme” or “cellulase” means one or more (e.g., several) enzymes that hydrolyze a cellulosic material. Such enzymes include endoglucanase(s), cellobiohydrolase(s), beta-glucosidase(s), or combinations thereof. The two basic approaches for measuring cellulolytic activity include: (1) measuring the total cellulolytic activity, and (2) measuring the individual cellulolytic activities (endoglucanases, cellobiohydrolases, and beta-glucosidases) as reviewed in Zhang et al., Outlook for cellulase improvement: Screening and selection strategies, 2006, Biotechnology Advances 24: 452-481. Total cellulolytic activity is usually measured using insoluble substrates, including Whatman N21 filter paper, microcrystalline cellulose, bacterial cellulose, algal cellulose, cotton, pretreated lignocellulose, etc. The most common total cellulolytic activity assay is the filter paper assay using Whatman N21 filter paper as the substrate. The assay was established by the International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry (IUPAC) (Ghose, 1987, Measurement of cellulase activities, Pure Appl. Chem. 59: 257-68).
For purposes of the present invention, cellulolytic enzyme activity is determined by measuring the increase in hydrolysis of a cellulosic material by cellulolytic enzyme(s) under the following conditions: 1-50 mg of cellulolytic enzyme protein/g of cellulose in PCS (or other pretreated cellulosic material) for 3-7 days at a suitable temperature, e.g., 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., compared to a control hydrolysis without addition of cellulolytic enzyme protein. Typical conditions are 1 ml reactions, washed or unwashed PCS, 5% insoluble solids, 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5, 1 mM MnSO4, 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., 72 hours, sugar analysis by AMINEX® HPX-87H column (Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc., Hercules, Calif., USA).
Cellulose binding domain: The term “cellulose binding domain” means the portion of an enzyme that mediates binding of the enzyme to amorphous regions of a cellulose substrate. The cellulose binding domain (CBD) is found either at the N-terminal or at the C-terminal extremity of an enzyme.
Cellulosic material: The term “cellulosic material” means any material containing cellulose. The predominant polysaccharide in the primary cell wall of biomass is cellulose, the second most abundant is hemicellulose, and the third is pectin. The secondary cell wall, produced after the cell has stopped growing, also contains polysaccharides and is strengthened by polymeric lignin covalently cross-linked to hemicellulose. Cellulose is a homopolymer of anhydrocellobiose and thus a linear beta-(1-4)-D-glucan, while hemicelluloses include a variety of compounds, such as xylans, xyloglucans, arabinoxylans, and mannans in complex branched structures with a spectrum of substituents. Although generally polymorphous, cellulose is found in plant tissue primarily as an insoluble crystalline matrix of parallel glucan chains. Hemicelluloses usually hydrogen bond to cellulose, as well as to other hemicelluloses, which help stabilize the cell wall matrix.
Cellulose is generally found, for example, in the stems, leaves, hulls, husks, and cobs of plants or leaves, branches, and wood of trees. The cellulosic material can be, but is not limited to, agricultural residue, herbaceous material (including energy crops), municipal solid waste, pulp and paper mill residue, waste paper, and wood (including forestry residue) (see, for example, Wiselogel et al., 1995, in Handbook on Bioethanol (Charles E. Wyman, editor), pp. 105-118, Taylor & Francis, Washington D.C.; Wyman, 1994, Bioresource Technology 50: 3-16; Lynd, 1990, Applied Biochemistry and Biotechnology 24/25: 695-719; Mosier et al., 1999, Recent Progress in Bioconversion of Lignocellulosics, in Advances in Biochemical Engineering/Biotechnology, T. Scheper, managing editor, Volume 65, pp. 23-40, Springer-Verlag, New York). It is understood herein that the cellulose may be in the form of lignocellulose, a plant cell wall material containing lignin, cellulose, and hemicellulose in a mixed matrix. In a preferred aspect, the cellulosic material is any biomass material. In another preferred aspect, the cellulosic material is lignocellulose, which comprises cellulose, hemicelluloses, and lignin.
In one aspect, the cellulosic material is agricultural residue. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is herbaceous material (including energy crops). In another aspect, the cellulosic material is municipal solid waste. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is pulp and paper mill residue. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is waste paper. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is wood (including forestry residue).
In another aspect, the cellulosic material is arundo. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is bagasse. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is bamboo. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is corn cob. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is corn fiber. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is corn stover. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is miscanthus. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is orange peel. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is rice straw. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is switchgrass. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is wheat straw.
In another aspect, the cellulosic material is aspen. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is eucalyptus. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is fir. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is pine. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is poplar. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is spruce. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is willow. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is algal cellulose. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is bacterial cellulose. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is cotton linter. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is filter paper. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is microcrystalline cellulose. In another aspect, the cellulosic material is phosphoric-acid treated cellulose.
In another aspect, the cellulosic material is an aquatic biomass. As used herein the term “aquatic biomass” means biomass produced in an aquatic environment by a photosynthesis process. The aquatic biomass can be algae, emergent plants, floating-leaf plants, or submerged plants.
The cellulosic material may be used as is or may be subjected to pretreatment, using conventional methods known in the art, as described herein. In a preferred aspect, the cellulosic material is pretreated.
cDNA: The term “cDNA” means a DNA molecule that can be prepared by reverse transcription from a mature, spliced, mRNA molecule obtained from a eukaryotic or prokaryotic cell. cDNA lacks intron sequences that may be present in the corresponding genomic DNA. The initial, primary RNA transcript is a precursor to mRNA that is processed through a series of steps, including splicing, before appearing as mature spliced mRNA.
Coding sequence: The term “coding sequence” means a polynucleotide, which directly specifies the amino acid sequence of a polypeptide. The boundaries of the coding sequence are generally determined by an open reading frame, which begins with a start codon such as ATG, GTG, or TTG and ends with a stop codon such as TAA, TAG, or TGA.
The coding sequence may be a genomic DNA, cDNA, synthetic DNA, or a combination thereof.
Control sequences: The term “control sequences” means nucleic acid sequences necessary for expression of a polynucleotide encoding a mature polypeptide of the present invention. Each control sequence may be native (i.e., from the same gene) or foreign (i.e., from a different gene) to the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide or native or foreign to each other. Such control sequences include, but are not limited to, a leader, polyadenylation sequence, propeptide sequence, promoter, signal peptide sequence, and transcription terminator. At a minimum, the control sequences include a promoter, and transcriptional and translational stop signals. The control sequences may be provided with linkers for the purpose of introducing specific restriction sites facilitating ligation of the control sequences with the coding region of the polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide.
Endoglucanase: The term “endoglucanase” means an endo-1,4-(1,3;1,4)-beta-D-glucan 4-glucanohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.4) that catalyzes endohydrolysis of 1,4-beta-D-glycosidic linkages in cellulose, cellulose derivatives (such as carboxymethyl cellulose and hydroxyethyl cellulose), lichenin, beta-1,4 bonds in mixed beta-1,3 glucans such as cereal beta-D-glucans or xyloglucans, and other plant material containing cellulosic components. Endoglucanase activity can be determined by measuring reduction in substrate viscosity or increase in reducing ends determined by a reducing sugar assay (Zhang et al., 2006, Biotechnology Advances 24: 452-481). For purposes of the present invention, endoglucanase activity is determined using carboxymethyl cellulose (CMC) as substrate according to the procedure of Ghose, 1987, Pure and Appl. Chem. 59: 257-268, at pH 5, 40° C.
Expression: The term “expression” includes any step involved in the production of a polypeptide including, but not limited to, transcription, post-transcriptional modification, translation, post-translational modification, and secretion.
Expression vector: The term “expression vector” means a linear or circular DNA molecule that comprises a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide and is operably linked to control sequences that provide for its expression.
Family 61 glycoside hydrolase: The term “Family 61 glycoside hydrolase” or “Family GH61” or “GH61” means a polypeptide falling into the glycoside hydrolase Family 61 according to Henrissat B., 1991, A classification of glycosyl hydrolases based on amino-acid sequence similarities, Biochem. J. 280: 309-316, and Henrissat B., and Bairoch A., 1996, Updating the sequence-based classification of glycosyl hydrolases, Biochem. J. 316: 695-696. The enzymes in this family were originally classified as a glycoside hydrolase family based on measurement of very weak endo-1,4-beta-D-glucanase activity in one family member. The structure and mode of action of these enzymes are non-canonical and they cannot be considered as bona fide glycosidases. However, they are kept in the CAZy classification on the basis of their capacity to enhance the breakdown of lignocellulose when used in conjunction with a cellulase or a mixture of cellulases.
Feruloyl esterase: The term “feruloyl esterase” means a 4-hydroxy-3-methoxycinnamoyl-sugar hydrolase (EC 3.1.1.73) that catalyzes the hydrolysis of 4-hydroxy-3-methoxycinnamoyl (feruloyl) groups from esterified sugar, which is usually arabinose in natural biomass substrates, to produce ferulate (4-hydroxy-3-methoxycinnamate). Feruloyl esterase is also known as ferulic acid esterase, hydroxycinnamoyl esterase, FAE-III, cinnamoyl ester hydrolase, FAEA, cinnAE, FAE-I, or FAE-II. For purposes of the present invention, feruloyl esterase activity is determined using 0.5 mM p-nitrophenylferulate as substrate in 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5.0. One unit of feruloyl esterase equals the amount of enzyme capable of releasing 1 μmole of p-nitrophenolate anion per minute at pH 5, 25° C.
Fragment: The term “fragment” means a polypeptide or a domain thereof having one or more (e.g., several) amino acids absent from the amino and/or carboxyl terminus of a mature polypeptide or a domain thereof; wherein the fragment has cellulolytic enhancing activity or cellulose binding activity. In one aspect, a fragment contains at least 255 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 270 amino acid residues or at least 285 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2. In another aspect, a fragment contains at least at least 185 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 195 amino acid residues or at least 205 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4. In another aspect, a fragment contains at least 180 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 190 amino acid residues or at least 200 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6. In another aspect, a fragment contains at least 190 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 200 amino acid residues or at least 210 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 8. In another aspect, a fragment contains at least 385 amino acid residues, e.g., at least 410 amino acid residues or at least 435 amino acid residues of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10.
Hemicellulolytic enzyme or hemicellulase: The term “hemicellulolytic enzyme” or “hemicellulase” means one or more (e.g., several) enzymes that hydrolyze a hemicellulosic material. See, for example, Shallom, D. and Shoham, Y. Microbial hemicellulases. Current Opinion In Microbiology, 2003, 6(3): 219-228). Hemicellulases are key components in the degradation of plant biomass. Examples of hemicellulases include, but are not limited to, an acetylmannan esterase, an acetylxylan esterase, an arabinanase, an arabinofuranosidase, a coumaric acid esterase, a feruloyl esterase, a galactosidase, a glucuronidase, a glucuronoyl esterase, a mannanase, a mannosidase, a xylanase, and a xylosidase. The substrates of these enzymes, the hemicelluloses, are a heterogeneous group of branched and linear polysaccharides that are bound via hydrogen bonds to the cellulose microfibrils in the plant cell wall, crosslinking them into a robust network. Hemicelluloses are also covalently attached to lignin, forming together with cellulose a highly complex structure. The variable structure and organization of hemicelluloses require the concerted action of many enzymes for its complete degradation. The catalytic modules of hemicellulases are either glycoside hydrolases (GHs) that hydrolyze glycosidic bonds, or carbohydrate esterases (CEs), which hydrolyze ester linkages of acetate or ferulic acid side groups. These catalytic modules, based on homology of their primary sequence, can be assigned into GH and CE families. Some families, with an overall similar fold, can be further grouped into clans, marked alphabetically (e.g., GH-A). A most informative and updated classification of these and other carbohydrate active enzymes is available in the Carbohydrate-Active Enzymes (CAZy) database. Hemicellulolytic enzyme activities can be measured according to Ghose and Bisaria, 1987, Pure & Appl. Chem. 59: 1739-1752, at a suitable temperature, e.g., 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., and pH, e.g., 5.0 or 5.5.
High stringency conditions: The term “high stringency conditions” means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 65° C.
Host cell: The term “host cell” means any cell type that is susceptible to transformation, transfection, transduction, or the like with a nucleic acid construct or expression vector comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention. The term “host cell” encompasses any progeny of a parent cell that is not identical to the parent cell due to mutations that occur during replication.
Isolated: The term “isolated” means a substance in a form or environment that does not occur in nature. Non-limiting examples of isolated substances include (1) any non-naturally occurring substance, (2) any substance including, but not limited to, any enzyme, variant, nucleic acid, protein, peptide or cofactor, that is at least partially removed from one or more or all of the naturally occurring constituents with which it is associated in nature; (3) any substance modified by the hand of man relative to that substance found in nature; or (4) any substance modified by increasing the amount of the substance relative to other components with which it is naturally associated (e.g., recombinant production in a host cell; multiple copies of a gene encoding the substance; and use of a stronger promoter than the promoter naturally associated with the gene encoding the substance).
Low stringency conditions: The term “low stringency conditions” means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 25% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 50° C.
Mature polypeptide: The term “mature polypeptide” means a polypeptide in its final form following translation and any post-translational modifications, such as N-terminal processing, C-terminal truncation, glycosylation, phosphorylation, etc. In one aspect, the mature polypeptide is amino acids 21 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2 based on the SignalP program (Nielsen et al., 1997, Protein Engineering 10: 1-6) that predicts amino acids 1 to 20 of SEQ ID NO: 2 are a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide is amino acids 18 to 234 of SEQ ID NO: 4 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 17 of SEQ ID NO: 4 are a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide is amino acids 24 to 233 of SEQ ID NO: 6 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 23 of SEQ ID NO: 6 are a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide is amino acids 17 to 237 of SEQ ID NO: 8 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 16 of SEQ ID NO: 8 are a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide is amino acids 20 to 484 of SEQ ID NO: 10 based on the SignalP program that predicts amino acids 1 to 19 of SEQ ID NO: 10 are a signal peptide. It is known in the art that a host cell may produce a mixture of two of more different mature polypeptides (i.e., with a different C-terminal and/or N-terminal amino acid) expressed by the same polynucleotide.
Mature polypeptide coding sequence: The term “mature polypeptide coding sequence” means a polynucleotide that encodes a mature polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In one aspect, the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 61 to 966 of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra) that predicts nucleotides 1 to 60 of SEQ ID NO: 1 encode a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 52 to 702 of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 51 of SEQ ID NO: 3 encode a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 70 to 699 of SEQ ID NO: 5 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 69 of SEQ ID NO: 5 encode a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 49 to 711 of SEQ ID NO: 7 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 48 of SEQ ID NO: 7 encode a signal peptide. In another aspect, the mature polypeptide coding sequence is nucleotides 58 to 1452 of SEQ ID NO: 9 based on the SignalP program that predicts nucleotides 1 to 57 of SEQ ID NO: 9 encode a signal peptide.
Medium stringency conditions: The term “medium stringency conditions” means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 35% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 55° C.
Medium-high stringency conditions: The term “medium-high stringency conditions” means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 35% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 60° C.
Nucleic acid construct: The term “nucleic acid construct” means a nucleic acid molecule, either single- or double-stranded, which is isolated from a naturally occurring gene or is modified to contain segments of nucleic acids in a manner that would not otherwise exist in nature or which is synthetic, which comprises one or more control sequences.
Operably linked: The term “operably linked” means a configuration in which a control sequence is placed at an appropriate position relative to the coding sequence of a polynucleotide such that the control sequence directs expression of the coding sequence.
Polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity: The term “polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity” means a GH61 polypeptide that catalyzes the enhancement of the hydrolysis of a cellulosic material by enzyme having cellulolytic activity. For purposes of the present invention, cellulolytic enhancing activity is determined by measuring the increase in reducing sugars or the increase of the total of cellobiose and glucose from the hydrolysis of a cellulosic material by cellulolytic enzyme under the following conditions: 1-50 mg of total protein/g of cellulose in PCS, wherein total protein is comprised of 50-99.5% w/w cellulolytic enzyme protein and 0.5-50% w/w protein of a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity for 1-7 days at a suitable temperature, e.g., 50° C., 55° C., or 60° C., and pH, e.g., 5.0 or 5.5, compared to a control hydrolysis with equal total protein loading without cellulolytic enhancing activity (1-50 mg of cellulolytic protein/g of cellulose in PCS). In a preferred aspect, a mixture of CELLUCLAST® 1.5 L (Novozymes A/S, Bagsvrd, Denmark) in the presence of 2-3% of total protein weight Aspergillus oryzae beta-glucosidase (recombinantly produced in Aspergillus oryzae according to WO 02/095014) or 2-3% of total protein weight Aspergillus fumigatus beta-glucosidase (recombinantly produced in Aspergillus oryzae as described in WO 2002/095014) of cellulase protein loading is used as the source of the cellulolytic activity.
The GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity enhance the hydrolysis of a cellulosic material catalyzed by enzyme having cellulolytic activity by reducing the amount of cellulolytic enzyme required to reach the same degree of hydrolysis preferably at least 1.01-fold, e.g., at least 1.05-fold, at least 1.10-fold, at least 1.25-fold, at least 1.5-fold, at least 2-fold, at least 3-fold, at least 4-fold, at least 5-fold, at least 10-fold, or at least 20-fold.
The polypeptides of the present invention have at least 20%, e.g., at least 40%, at least 50%, at least 60%, at least 70%, at least 80%, at least 90%, at least 95%, and at least 100% of the cellulolytic enhancing activity of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
Pretreated corn stover: The term “PCS” or “Pretreated Corn Stover” means a cellulosic material derived from corn stover by treatment with heat and dilute sulfuric acid, alkaline pretreatment, or neutral pretreatment.
Sequence identity: The relatedness between two amino acid sequences or between two nucleotide sequences is described by the parameter “sequence identity”.
For purposes of the present invention, the sequence identity between two amino acid sequences is determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, J. Mol. Biol. 48: 443-453) as implemented in the Needle program of the EMBOSS package (EMBOSS: The European Molecular Biology Open Software Suite, Rice et al., 2000, Trends Genet. 16: 276-277), preferably version 5.0.0 or later. The parameters used are gap open penalty of 10, gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EBLOSUM62 (EMBOSS version of BLOSUM62) substitution matrix. The output of Needle labeled “longest identity” (obtained using the—nobrief option) is used as the percent identity and is calculated as follows:
(Identical Residues×100)/(Length of Alignment−Total Number of Gaps in Alignment)
(Identical Residues×100)/(Length of Alignment−Total Number of Gaps in Alignment)
For purposes of the present invention, the sequence identity between two deoxyribonucleotide sequences is determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, supra) as implemented in the Needle program of the EMBOSS package (EMBOSS: The European Molecular Biology Open Software Suite, Rice et al., 2000, supra), preferably version 5.0.0 or later. The parameters used are gap open penalty of 10, gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EDNAFULL (EMBOSS version of NCBI NUC4.4) substitution matrix. The output of Needle labeled “longest identity” (obtained using the—nobrief option) is used as the percent identity and is calculated as follows:
(Identical Deoxyribonucleotides×100)/(Length of Alignment−Total Number of Gaps in Alignment)
(Identical Deoxyribonucleotides×100)/(Length of Alignment−Total Number of Gaps in Alignment)
Subsequence: The term “subsequence” means a polynucleotide having one or more (e.g., several) nucleotides absent from the 5′ and/or 3′ end of a mature polypeptide coding sequence; wherein the subsequence encodes a fragment having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In one aspect, a subsequence contains at least 765 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 810 or at least nucleotides 855 of SEQ ID NO: 1; or the cDNA sequence thereof. In another aspect, a subsequence contains at least 555 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 585 or at least nucleotides 615 of SEQ ID NO: 3; or the genomic DNA sequence thereof. In another aspect, a subsequence contains at least 540 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 570 or at least nucleotides 600 of SEQ ID NO: 5; or the genomic DNA sequence thereof. In another aspect, a subsequence contains at least 570 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 600 or at least nucleotides 630 of SEQ ID NO: 7; or the genomic DNA sequence thereof. In another aspect, a subsequence contains at least 1155 nucleotides, e.g., at least nucleotides 1230 or at least nucleotides 1305 of SEQ ID NO: 9.
Variant: The term “variant” means a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprising an alteration, i.e., a substitution, insertion, and/or deletion, at one or more (e.g., several) positions. A substitution means replacement of the amino acid occupying a position with a different amino acid; a deletion means removal of the amino acid occupying a position; and an insertion means adding an amino acid adjacent to and immediately following the amino acid occupying a position.
Very high stringency conditions: The term “very high stringency conditions” means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 70° C.
Very low stringency conditions: The term “very low stringency conditions” means for probes of at least 100 nucleotides in length, prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 25% formamide, following standard Southern blotting procedures for 12 to 24 hours. The carrier material is finally washed three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 45° C.
Xylan degrading activity or xylanolytic activity: The term “xylan degrading activity” or “xylanolytic activity” means a biological activity that hydrolyzes xylan-containing material. The two basic approaches for measuring xylanolytic activity include: (1) measuring the total xylanolytic activity, and (2) measuring the individual xylanolytic activities (e.g., endoxylanases, beta-xylosidases, arabinofuranosidases, alpha-glucuronidases, acetylxylan esterases, feruloyl esterases, and alpha-glucuronyl esterases). Recent progress in assays of xylanolytic enzymes was summarized in several publications including Biely and Puchard, Recent progress in the assays of xylanolytic enzymes, 2006, Journal of the Science of Food and Agriculture 86(11): 1636-1647; Spanikova and Biely, 2006, Glucuronoyl esterase—Novel carbohydrate esterase produced by Schizophyllum commune, FEBS Letters 580(19): 4597-4601; Herrmann, Vrsanska, Jurickova, Hirsch, Biely, and Kubicek, 1997, The beta-D-xylosidase of Trichoderma reesei is a multifunctional beta-D-xylan xylohydrolase, Biochemical Journal 321: 375-381.
Total xylan degrading activity can be measured by determining the reducing sugars formed from various types of xylan, including, for example, oat spelt, beechwood, and larchwood xylans, or by photometric determination of dyed xylan fragments released from various covalently dyed xylans. The most common total xylanolytic activity assay is based on production of reducing sugars from polymeric 4-O-methyl glucuronoxylan as described in Bailey, Biely, Poutanen, 1992, Interlaboratory testing of methods for assay of xylanase activity, Journal of Biotechnology 23(3): 257-270. Xylanase activity can also be determined with 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 0.01% TRITON® X-100 (4-(1,1,3,3-tetramethylbutyl)phenyl-polyethylene glycol) and 200 mM sodium phosphate buffer pH 6 at 37° C. One unit of xylanase activity is defined as 1.0 μmole of azurine produced per minute at 37° C., pH 6 from 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 200 mM sodium phosphate pH 6 buffer.
For purposes of the present invention, xylan degrading activity is determined by measuring the increase in hydrolysis of birchwood xylan (Sigma Chemical Co., Inc., St. Louis, Mo., USA) by xylan-degrading enzyme(s) under the following typical conditions: 1 ml reactions, 5 mg/ml substrate (total solids), 5 mg of xylanolytic protein/g of substrate, 50 mM sodium acetate pH 5, 50° C., 24 hours, sugar analysis using p-hydroxybenzoic acid hydrazide (PHBAH) assay as described by Lever, 1972, A new reaction for colorimetric determination of carbohydrates, Anal. Biochem 47: 273-279.
Xylanase: The term “xylanase” means a 1,4-beta-D-xylan-xylohydrolase (E.C. 3.2.1.8) that catalyzes the endohydrolysis of 1,4-beta-D-xylosidic linkages in xylans. For purposes of the present invention, xylanase activity is determined with 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 0.01% TRITON® X-100 and 200 mM sodium phosphate buffer pH 6 at 37° C. One unit of xylanase activity is defined as 1.0 μmole of azurine produced per minute at 37° C., pH 6 from 0.2% AZCL-arabinoxylan as substrate in 200 mM sodium phosphate pH 6 buffer.
Polypeptides Having Cellulolytic Enhancing Activity
In an embodiment, the present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having a sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6 or SEQ ID NO: 8 of at least 60%, e.g., at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4 of at least 65%, e.g., at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10 of at least 70%, e.g., at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; or the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2 of at least 80%, e.g., at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; which have cellulolytic enhancing activity. In one aspect, the polypeptides differ by up to 10 amino acids, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10, from the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
A polypeptide of the present invention preferably comprises or consists of the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 or an allelic variant thereof; or is a fragment thereof having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the polypeptide comprises or consists of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10. In another preferred aspect, the polypeptide comprises or consists of amino acids 21 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 18 to 234 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 24 to 233 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 17 to 237 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 20 to 484 of SEQ ID NO: 10.
In another embodiment, the present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity that are encoded by polynucleotides that hybridize under very low stringency conditions, low stringency conditions, medium stringency conditions, medium-high stringency conditions, high stringency conditions, or very high stringency conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (iii) the full-length complement of (i) or (ii) (Sambrook et al., 1989, Molecular Cloning, A Laboratory Manual, 2d edition, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y.)
The polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, or a subsequence thereof, as well as the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10, or a fragment thereof, may be used to design nucleic acid probes to identify and clone DNA encoding polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity from strains of different genera or species according to methods well known in the art. In particular, such probes can be used for hybridization with the genomic DNA or cDNA of a cell of interest, following standard Southern blotting procedures, in order to identify and isolate the corresponding gene therein. Such probes can be considerably shorter than the entire sequence, but should be at least 15, e.g., at least 25, at least 35, or at least 70 nucleotides in length. Preferably, the nucleic acid probe is at least 100 nucleotides in length, e.g., at least 200 nucleotides, at least 300 nucleotides, at least 400 nucleotides, at least 500 nucleotides, at least 600 nucleotides, at least 700 nucleotides, at least 800 nucleotides, or at least 900 nucleotides in length. Both DNA and RNA probes can be used. The probes are typically labeled for detecting the corresponding gene (for example, with 32P, 3H, 35S, biotin, or avidin). Such probes are encompassed by the present invention.
A genomic DNA or cDNA library prepared from such other strains may be screened for DNA that hybridizes with the probes described above and encodes a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. Genomic or other DNA from such other strains may be separated by agarose or polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis, or other separation techniques. DNA from the libraries or the separated DNA may be transferred to and immobilized on nitrocellulose or other suitable carrier material. In order to identify a clone or DNA that hybridizes with SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9 or a subsequence thereof, the carrier material is preferably used in a Southern blot.
For purposes of the present invention, hybridization indicates that the polynucleotide hybridizes to a labeled nucleic acid probe corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9; the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9; the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1; or a full-length complement thereof; or a subsequence thereof; under very low to very high stringency conditions. Molecules to which the nucleic acid probe hybridizes under these conditions can be detected using, for example, X-ray film or any other detection means known in the art.
In one aspect, the nucleic acid probe is a polynucleotide that encodes the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10; the mature polypeptide thereof; or a fragment thereof. In another aspect, the nucleic acid probe is SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof, SEQ ID NO: 9, or SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof.
In another embodiment, the present invention relates to isolated polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity encoded by polynucleotides having a sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 5 or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof, of at least 60%, e.g., at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof, of at least 65%, e.g., at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9 of at least 70%, e.g., at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%; or the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof of at least 80%, e.g., at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100%.
In another embodiment, the present invention relates to variants of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 comprising a substitution, deletion, and/or insertion at one or more (e.g., several) positions. In an embodiment, the number of amino acid substitutions, deletions and/or insertions introduced into the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 is up to 10, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. The amino acid changes may be of a minor nature, that is conservative amino acid substitutions or insertions that do not significantly affect the folding and/or activity of the protein; small deletions, typically of 1-30 amino acids; small amino- or carboxyl-terminal extensions, such as an amino-terminal methionine residue; a small linker peptide of up to 20-25 residues; or a small extension that facilitates purification by changing net charge or another function, such as a poly-histidine tract, an antigenic epitope or a binding domain.
Examples of conservative substitutions are within the groups of basic amino acids (arginine, lysine and histidine), acidic amino acids (glutamic acid and aspartic acid), polar amino acids (glutamine and asparagine), hydrophobic amino acids (leucine, isoleucine and valine), aromatic amino acids (phenylalanine, tryptophan and tyrosine), and small amino acids (glycine, alanine, serine, threonine and methionine). Amino acid substitutions that do not generally alter specific activity are known in the art and are described, for example, by H. Neurath and R. L. Hill, 1979, In, The Proteins, Academic Press, New York. Common substitutions are Ala/Ser, Val/Ile, Asp/Glu, Thr/Ser, Ala/Gly, Ala/Thr, Ser/Asn, Ala/Val, Ser/Gly, Tyr/Phe, Ala/Pro, Lys/Arg, Asp/Asn, Leu/Ile, Leu/Val, Ala/Glu, and Asp/Gly.
Alternatively, the amino acid changes are of such a nature that the physico-chemical properties of the polypeptides are altered. For example, amino acid changes may improve the thermal stability of the polypeptide, alter the substrate specificity, change the pH optimum, and the like.
Essential amino acids in a polypeptide can be identified according to procedures known in the art, such as site-directed mutagenesis or alanine-scanning mutagenesis (Cunningham and Wells, 1989, Science 244: 1081-1085). In the latter technique, single alanine mutations are introduced at every residue in the molecule, and the resultant mutant molecules are tested for cellulolytic enhancing activity to identify amino acid residues that are critical to the activity of the molecule. See also, Hilton et al., 1996, J. Biol. Chem. 271: 4699-4708. The active site of the enzyme or other biological interaction can also be determined by physical analysis of structure, as determined by such techniques as nuclear magnetic resonance, crystallography, electron diffraction, or photoaffinity labeling, in conjunction with mutation of putative contact site amino acids. See, for example, de Vos et al., 1992, Science 255: 306-312; Smith et al., 1992, J. Mol. Biol. 224: 899-904; Wlodaver et al., 1992, FEBS Lett. 309: 59-64. The identity of essential amino acids can also be inferred from an alignment with a related polypeptide.
Single or multiple amino acid substitutions, deletions, and/or insertions can be made and tested using known methods of mutagenesis, recombination, and/or shuffling, followed by a relevant screening procedure, such as those disclosed by Reidhaar-Olson and Sauer, 1988, Science 241: 53-57; Bowie and Sauer, 1989, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 86: 2152-2156; WO 95/17413; or WO 95/22625. Other methods that can be used include error-prone PCR, phage display (e.g., Lowman et al., 1991, Biochemistry 30: 10832-10837; U.S. Pat. No. 5,223,409; WO 92/06204), and region-directed mutagenesis (Derbyshire et al., 1986, Gene 46: 145; Ner et al., 1988, DNA 7: 127).
Mutagenesis/shuffling methods can be combined with high-throughput, automated screening methods to detect activity of cloned, mutagenized polypeptides expressed by host cells (Ness et al., 1999, Nature Biotechnology 17: 893-896). Mutagenized DNA molecules that encode active polypeptides can be recovered from the host cells and rapidly sequenced using standard methods in the art. These methods allow the rapid determination of the importance of individual amino acid residues in a polypeptide.
The polypeptide may be a hybrid polypeptide in which a region of one polypeptide is fused at the N-terminus or the C-terminus of a region of another polypeptide.
The polypeptide may be a fusion polypeptide or cleavable fusion polypeptide in which another polypeptide is fused at the N-terminus or the C-terminus of the polypeptide of the present invention. A fusion polypeptide is produced by fusing a polynucleotide encoding another polypeptide to a polynucleotide of the present invention. Techniques for producing fusion polypeptides are known in the art, and include ligating the coding sequences encoding the polypeptides so that they are in frame and that expression of the fusion polypeptide is under control of the same promoter(s) and terminator. Fusion polypeptides may also be constructed using intein technology in which fusion polypeptides are created post-translationally (Cooper et al., 1993, EMBO J. 12: 2575-2583; Dawson et al., 1994, Science 266: 776-779).
A fusion polypeptide can further comprise a cleavage site between the two polypeptides. Upon secretion of the fusion protein, the site is cleaved releasing the two polypeptides. Examples of cleavage sites include, but are not limited to, the sites disclosed in Martin et al., 2003, J. Ind. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 3: 568-576; Svetina et al., 2000, J. Biotechnol. 76: 245-251; Rasmussen-Wilson et al., 1997, Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 63: 3488-3493; Ward et al., 1995, Biotechnology 13: 498-503; and Contreras et al., 1991, Biotechnology 9: 378-381; Eaton et al., 1986, Biochemistry 25: 505-512; Collins-Racie et al., 1995, Biotechnology 13: 982-987; Carter et al., 1989, Proteins: Structure, Function, and Genetics 6: 240-248; and Stevens, 2003, Drug Discovery World 4: 35-48.
Sources of Polypeptides Having Cellulolytic Enhancing Activity
A polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention may be obtained from microorganisms of any genus. For purposes of the present invention, the term “obtained from” as used herein in connection with a given source shall mean that the polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide is produced by the source or by a strain in which the polynucleotide from the source has been inserted. In one aspect, the polypeptide obtained from a given source is secreted extracellularly.
The polypeptide may be a fungal polypeptide. For example, the polypeptide may be a yeast polypeptide such as a Candida, Kluyveromyces, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Schizosaccharomyces, or Yarrowia polypeptide; or a filamentous fungal polypeptide such as an Acremonium, Agaricus, Alternaria, Aspergillus, Aureobasidium, Botryosphaeria, Ceriporiopsis, Chaetomidium, Chrysosporium, Claviceps, Cochliobolus, Coprinopsis, Coptotermes, Corynascus, Cryphonectria, Cryptococcus, Diplodia, Exidia, Filibasidium, Fusarium, Gibberella, Holomastigotoides, Humicola, Irpex, Lentinula, Leptospaeria, Magnaporthe, Melanocarpus, Meripilus, Mucor, Myceliophthora, Neocallimastix, Neurospora, Paecilomyces, Penicillium, Phanerochaete, Piromyces, Poitrasia, Pseudoplectania, Pseudotrichonympha, Rhizomucor, Schizophyllum, Scytalidium, Talaromyces, Thermoascus, Thielavia, Tolypocladium, Trichoderma, Trichophaea, Verticillium, Volvariella, or Xylaria polypeptide.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is a Saccharomyces carlsbergensis, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Saccharomyces diastaticus, Saccharomyces douglasii, Saccharomyces kluyveri, Saccharomyces norbensis, or Saccharomyces oviformis polypeptide.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is an Acremonium cellulolyticus, Aspergillus aculeatus, Aspergillus awamori, Aspergillus foetidus, Aspergillus fumigatus, Aspergillus japonicus, Aspergillus nidulans, Aspergillus niger, Aspergillus oryzae, Chrysosporium inops, Chrysosporium keratinophilum, Chrysosporium lucknowense, Chrysosporium merdarium, Chrysosporium pannicola, Chrysosporium queenslandicum, Chrysosporium tropicum, Chrysosporium zonatum, Fusarium bactridioides, Fusarium cerealis, Fusarium crookwellense, Fusarium culmorum, Fusarium graminearum, Fusarium graminum, Fusarium heterosporum, Fusarium negundi, Fusarium oxysporum, Fusarium reticulatum, Fusarium roseum, Fusarium sambucinum, Fusarium sarcochroum, Fusarium sporotrichioides, Fusarium sulphureum, Fusarium torulosum, Fusarium trichothecioides, Fusarium venenatum, Humicola grisea, Humicola insolens, Humicola lanuginosa, Irpex lacteus, Mucor miehei, Myceliophthora thermophila, Neurospora crassa, Penicillium funiculosum, Penicillium purpurogenum, Phanerochaete chrysosporium, Thielavia achromatica, Thielavia albomyces, Thielavia albopilosa, Thielavia australeinsis, Thielavia fimeti, Thielavia microspora, Thielavia ovispora, Thielavia peruviana, Thielavia setosa, Thielavia spededonium, Thielavia subthermophila, Thielavia terrestris, Trichoderma harzianum, Trichoderma koningii, Trichoderma longibrachiatum, Trichoderma reesei, or Trichoderma viride polypeptide.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is an Aurantiporus alborubescens polypeptide, e.g., a polypeptide obtained from Aurantiporus alborubescens NN008024.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is an Trichophaea saccata polypeptide, e.g., a polypeptide obtained from Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is a Penicillium thomii polypeptide, e.g., a polypeptide obtained from Penicillium thomii IBT 10776.
It will be understood that for the aforementioned species the invention encompasses both the perfect and imperfect states, and other taxonomic equivalents, e.g., anamorphs, regardless of the species name by which they are known. Those skilled in the art will readily recognize the identity of appropriate equivalents.
Strains of these species are readily accessible to the public in a number of culture collections, such as the American Type Culture Collection (ATCC), Deutsche Sammlung von Mikroorganismen and Zellkulturen GmbH (DSMZ), Centraalbureau Voor Schimmelcultures (CBS), and Agricultural Research Service Patent Culture Collection, Northern Regional Research Center (NRRL).
The polypeptide may be identified and obtained from other sources including microorganisms isolated from nature (e.g., soil, composts, water, etc.) or DNA samples obtained directly from natural materials (e.g., soil, composts, water, etc.) using the above-mentioned probes. Techniques for isolating microorganisms and DNA directly from natural habitats are well known in the art. A polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide may then be obtained by similarly screening a genomic DNA or cDNA library of another microorganism or mixed DNA sample. Once a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide has been detected with the probe(s), the polynucleotide can be isolated or cloned by utilizing techniques that are known to those of ordinary skill in the art (see, e.g., Sambrook et al., 1989, supra).
Polynucleotides
The present invention also relates to isolated polynucleotides encoding polypeptides of the present invention, as described herein.
The techniques used to isolate or clone a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide are known in the art and include isolation from genomic DNA or cDNA, or a combination thereof. The cloning of the polynucleotides from genomic DNA can be effected, e.g., by using the well known polymerase chain reaction (PCR) or antibody screening of expression libraries to detect cloned DNA fragments with shared structural features. See, e.g., Innis et al., 1990, PCR: A Guide to Methods and Application, Academic Press, New York. Other nucleic acid amplification procedures such as ligase chain reaction (LCR), ligation activated transcription (LAT) and polynucleotide-based amplification (NASBA) may be used. The polynucleotides may be cloned from a strain of Aurantiporus, Trichophaea, or Penicillium, or a related organism and thus, for example, may be an allelic or species variant of the polypeptide encoding region of the polynucleotide.
Modification of a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide of the present invention may be necessary for synthesizing polypeptides substantially similar to the polypeptide. The term “substantially similar” to the polypeptide refers to non-naturally occurring forms of the polypeptide. These polypeptides may differ in some engineered way from the polypeptide isolated from its native source, e.g., variants that differ in specific activity, thermostability, pH optimum, or the like. The variants may be constructed on the basis of the polynucleotide presented as the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof, SEQ ID NO: 9, or SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA thereof, e.g., a subsequence thereof, and/or by introduction of nucleotide substitutions that do not result in a change in the amino acid sequence of the polypeptide, but which correspond to the codon usage of the host organism intended for production of the enzyme, or by introduction of nucleotide substitutions that may give rise to a different amino acid sequence. For a general description of nucleotide substitution, see, e.g., Ford et al., 1991, Protein Expression and Purification 2: 95-107.
Nucleic Acid Constructs
The present invention also relates to nucleic acid constructs comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the expression of the coding sequence in a suitable host cell under conditions compatible with the control sequences.
The polynucleotide may be manipulated in a variety of ways to provide for expression of the polypeptide. Manipulation of the polynucleotide prior to its insertion into a vector may be desirable or necessary depending on the expression vector. The techniques for modifying polynucleotides utilizing recombinant DNA methods are well known in the art.
The control sequence may be a promoter, a polynucleotide that is recognized by a host cell for expression of a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide of the present invention. The promoter contains transcriptional control sequences that mediate the expression of the polypeptide. The promoter may be any polynucleotide that shows transcriptional activity in the host cell including mutant, truncated, and hybrid promoters, and may be obtained from genes encoding extracellular or intracellular polypeptides either homologous or heterologous to the host cell.
Examples of suitable promoters for directing transcription of the nucleic acid constructs of the present invention in a bacterial host cell are the promoters obtained from the Bacillus amyloliquefaciens alpha-amylase gene (amyQ), Bacillus licheniformis alpha-amylase gene (amyL), Bacillus licheniformis penicillinase gene (penP), Bacillus stearothermophilus maltogenic amylase gene (amyM), Bacillus subtilis levansucrase gene (sacB), Bacillus subtilis xylA and xylB genes, Bacillus thuringiensis cryIIIA gene (Agaisse and Lereclus, 1994, Molecular Microbiology 13: 97-107), E. coli lac operon, E. coli trc promoter (Egon et al., 1988, Gene 69: 301-315), Streptomyces coelicolor agarase gene (dagA), and prokaryotic beta-lactamase gene (Villa-Kamaroff et al., 1978, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 75: 3727-3731), as well as the tac promoter (DeBoer et al., 1983, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 80: 21-25). Further promoters are described in “Useful proteins from recombinant bacteria” in Gilbert et al., 1980, Scientific American 242: 74-94; and in Sambrook et al., 1989, supra. Examples of tandem promoters are disclosed in WO 99/43835.
Examples of suitable promoters for directing transcription of the nucleic acid constructs of the present invention in a filamentous fungal host cell are promoters obtained from the genes for Aspergillus nidulans acetamidase, Aspergillus niger neutral alpha-amylase, Aspergillus niger acid stable alpha-amylase, Aspergillus niger or Aspergillus awamori glucoamylase (glaA), Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, Aspergillus oryzae alkaline protease, Aspergillus oryzae triose phosphate isomerase, Fusarium oxysporum trypsin-like protease (WO 96/00787), Fusarium venenatum amyloglucosidase (WO 00/56900), Fusarium venenatum Dania (WO 00/56900), Fusarium venenatum Quinn (WO 00/56900), Rhizomucor miehei lipase, Rhizomucor miehei aspartic proteinase, Trichoderma reesei beta-glucosidase, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase I, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase II, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase I, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase II, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase III, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase V, Trichoderma reesei xylanase I, Trichoderma reesei xylanase II, Trichoderma reesei xylanase III, Trichoderma reesei beta-xylosidase, and Trichoderma reesei translation elongation factor, as well as the NA2-tpi promoter (a modified promoter from an Aspergillus neutral alpha-amylase gene in which the untranslated leader has been replaced by an untranslated leader from an Aspergillus triose phosphate isomerase gene; non-limiting examples include modified promoters from an Aspergillus niger neutral alpha-amylase gene in which the untranslated leader has been replaced by an untranslated leader from an Aspergillus nidulans or Aspergillus oryzae triose phosphate isomerase gene); and mutant, truncated, and hybrid promoters thereof. Other promoters are described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,011,147.
In a yeast host, useful promoters are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase (ENO-1), Saccharomyces cerevisiae galactokinase (GAL1), Saccharomyces cerevisiae alcohol dehydrogenase/glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase (ADH1, ADH2/GAP), Saccharomyces cerevisiae triose phosphate isomerase (TPI), Saccharomyces cerevisiae metallothionein (CUP1), and Saccharomyces cerevisiae 3-phosphoglycerate kinase. Other useful promoters for yeast host cells are described by Romanos et al., 1992, Yeast 8: 423-488.
The control sequence may also be a transcription terminator, which is recognized by a host cell to terminate transcription. The terminator is operably linked to the 3′-terminus of the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide. Any terminator that is functional in the host cell may be used in the present invention.
Preferred terminators for bacterial host cells are obtained from the genes for Bacillus clausii alkaline protease (aprH), Bacillus licheniformis alpha-amylase (amyL), and Escherichia coli ribosomal RNA (rrnB).
Preferred terminators for filamentous fungal host cells are obtained from the genes for Aspergillus nidulans acetamidase, Aspergillus nidulans anthranilate synthase, Aspergillus niger glucoamylase, Aspergillus niger alpha-glucosidase, Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, Fusarium oxysporum trypsin-like protease, Trichoderma reesei beta-glucosidase, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase I, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase II, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase I, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase II, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase Ill, Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase V, Trichoderma reesei xylanase I, Trichoderma reesei xylanase II, Trichoderma reesei xylanase III, Trichoderma reesei beta-xylosidase, and Trichoderma reesei translation elongation factor.
Preferred terminators for yeast host cells are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase, Saccharomyces cerevisiae cytochrome C (CYC1), and Saccharomyces cerevisiae glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase. Other useful terminators for yeast host cells are described by Romanos et al., 1992, supra.
The control sequence may also be an mRNA stabilizer region downstream of a promoter and upstream of the coding sequence of a gene which increases expression of the gene.
Examples of suitable mRNA stabilizer regions are obtained from a Bacillus thuringiensis cryIIIA gene (WO 94/25612) and a Bacillus subtilis SP82 gene (Hue et al., 1995, Journal of Bacteriology 177: 3465-3471).
The control sequence may also be a leader, a nontranslated region of an mRNA that is important for translation by the host cell. The leader is operably linked to the 5′-terminus of the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide. Any leader that is functional in the host cell may be used.
Preferred leaders for filamentous fungal host cells are obtained from the genes for Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase and Aspergillus nidulans triose phosphate isomerase.
Suitable leaders for yeast host cells are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae enolase (ENO-1), Saccharomyces cerevisiae 3-phosphoglycerate kinase, Saccharomyces cerevisiae alpha-factor, and Saccharomyces cerevisiae alcohol dehydrogenase/glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase (ADH2/GAP).
The control sequence may also be a polyadenylation sequence, a sequence operably linked to the 3′-terminus of the polynucleotide and, when transcribed, is recognized by the host cell as a signal to add polyadenosine residues to transcribed mRNA. Any polyadenylation sequence that is functional in the host cell may be used.
Preferred polyadenylation sequences for filamentous fungal host cells are obtained from the genes for Aspergillus nidulans anthranilate synthase, Aspergillus niger glucoamylase, Aspergillus niger alpha-glucosidase Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, and Fusarium oxysporum trypsin-like protease.
Useful polyadenylation sequences for yeast host cells are described by Guo and Sherman, 1995, Mol. Cellular Biol. 15: 5983-5990.
The control sequence may also be a signal peptide coding region that encodes a signal peptide linked to the N-terminus of a polypeptide and directs the polypeptide into the cell's secretory pathway. The 5′-end of the coding sequence of the polynucleotide may inherently contain a signal peptide coding sequence naturally linked in translation reading frame with the segment of the coding sequence that encodes the polypeptide. Alternatively, the 5′-end of the coding sequence may contain a signal peptide coding sequence that is foreign to the coding sequence. A foreign signal peptide coding sequence may be required where the coding sequence does not naturally contain a signal peptide coding sequence. Alternatively, a foreign signal peptide coding sequence may simply replace the natural signal peptide coding sequence in order to enhance secretion of the polypeptide. However, any signal peptide coding sequence that directs the expressed polypeptide into the secretory pathway of a host cell may be used.
Effective signal peptide coding sequences for bacterial host cells are the signal peptide coding sequences obtained from the genes for Bacillus NCIB 11837 maltogenic amylase, Bacillus licheniformis subtilisin, Bacillus licheniformis beta-lactamase, Bacillus stearothermophilus alpha-amylase, Bacillus stearothermophilus neutral proteases (nprT, nprS, nprM), and Bacillus subtilis prsA. Further signal peptides are described by Simonen and Palva, 1993, Microbiological Reviews 57: 109-137.
Effective signal peptide coding sequences for filamentous fungal host cells are the signal peptide coding sequences obtained from the genes for Aspergillus niger neutral amylase, Aspergillus niger glucoamylase, Aspergillus oryzae TAKA amylase, Humicola insolens cellulase, Humicola insolens endoglucanase V, Humicola lanuginosa lipase, and Rhizomucor miehei aspartic proteinase.
Useful signal peptides for yeast host cells are obtained from the genes for Saccharomyces cerevisiae alpha-factor and Saccharomyces cerevisiae invertase. Other useful signal peptide coding sequences are described by Romanos et al., 1992, supra.
The control sequence may also be a propeptide coding sequence that encodes a propeptide positioned at the N-terminus of a polypeptide. The resultant polypeptide is known as a proenzyme or propolypeptide (or a zymogen in some cases). A propolypeptide is generally inactive and can be converted to an active polypeptide by catalytic or autocatalytic cleavage of the propeptide from the propolypeptide. The propeptide coding sequence may be obtained from the genes for Bacillus subtilis alkaline protease (aprE), Bacillus subtilis neutral protease (nprT), Myceliophthora thermophila laccase (WO 95/33836), Rhizomucor miehei aspartic proteinase, and Saccharomyces cerevisiae alpha-factor.
Where both signal peptide and propeptide sequences are present, the propeptide sequence is positioned next to the N-terminus of a polypeptide and the signal peptide sequence is positioned next to the N-terminus of the propeptide sequence.
It may also be desirable to add regulatory sequences that regulate expression of the polypeptide relative to the growth of the host cell. Examples of regulatory sequences are those that cause expression of the gene to be turned on or off in response to a chemical or physical stimulus, including the presence of a regulatory compound. Regulatory sequences in prokaryotic systems include the lac, tac, and trp operator systems. In yeast, the ADH2 system or GAL1 system may be used. In filamentous fungi, the Aspergillus niger glucoamylase promoter, Aspergillus oryzae TAKA alpha-amylase promoter, and Aspergillus oryzae glucoamylase promoter, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase I promoter, and Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase II promoter may be used. Other examples of regulatory sequences are those that allow for gene amplification. In eukaryotic systems, these regulatory sequences include the dihydrofolate reductase gene that is amplified in the presence of methotrexate, and the metallothionein genes that are amplified with heavy metals. In these cases, the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide would be operably linked to the regulatory sequence.
Expression Vectors
The present invention also relates to recombinant expression vectors comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention, a promoter, and transcriptional and translational stop signals. The various nucleotide and control sequences may be joined together to produce a recombinant expression vector that may include one or more convenient restriction sites to allow for insertion or substitution of the polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide at such sites. Alternatively, the polynucleotide may be expressed by inserting the polynucleotide or a nucleic acid construct comprising the polynucleotide into an appropriate vector for expression. In creating the expression vector, the coding sequence is located in the vector so that the coding sequence is operably linked with the appropriate control sequences for expression.
The recombinant expression vector may be any vector (e.g., a plasmid or virus) that can be conveniently subjected to recombinant DNA procedures and can bring about expression of the polynucleotide. The choice of the vector will typically depend on the compatibility of the vector with the host cell into which the vector is to be introduced. The vector may be a linear or closed circular plasmid.
The vector may be an autonomously replicating vector, i.e., a vector that exists as an extrachromosomal entity, the replication of which is independent of chromosomal replication, e.g., a plasmid, an extrachromosomal element, a minichromosome, or an artificial chromosome. The vector may contain any means for assuring self-replication. Alternatively, the vector may be one that, when introduced into the host cell, is integrated into the genome and replicated together with the chromosome(s) into which it has been integrated. Furthermore, a single vector or plasmid or two or more vectors or plasmids that together contain the total DNA to be introduced into the genome of the host cell, or a transposon, may be used.
The vector preferably contains one or more selectable markers that permit easy selection of transformed, transfected, transduced, or the like cells. A selectable marker is a gene the product of which provides for biocide or viral resistance, resistance to heavy metals, prototrophy to auxotrophs, and the like.
Examples of bacterial selectable markers are Bacillus licheniformis or Bacillus subtilis dal genes, or markers that confer antibiotic resistance such as ampicillin, chloramphenicol, kanamycin, neomycin, spectinomycin, or tetracycline resistance. Suitable markers for yeast host cells include, but are not limited to, ADE2, HIS3, LEU2, LYS2, MET3, TRP1, and URA3. Selectable markers for use in a filamentous fungal host cell include, but are not limited to, adeA (phosphoribosylam inoimidazole-succinocarboxam ide synthase), adeB (phosphoribosyl-aminoimidazole synthase), amdS (acetamidase), argB (ornithine carbamoyltransferase), bar (phosphinothricin acetyltransferase), hph (hygromycin phosphotransferase), niaD (nitrate reductase), pyrG (orotidine-5′-phosphate decarboxylase), sC (sulfate adenyltransferase), and trpC (anthranilate synthase), as well as equivalents thereof. Preferred for use in an Aspergillus cell are Aspergillus nidulans or Aspergillus oryzae amdS and pyrG genes and a Streptomyces hygroscopicus bar gene. Preferred for use in a Trichoderma cell are adeA, adeB, amdS, hph, and pyrG genes.
The selectable marker may be a dual selectable marker system as described in WO 2010/039889. In one aspect, the dual selectable marker is a hph-tk dual selectable marker system.
The vector preferably contains an element(s) that permits integration of the vector into the host cell's genome or autonomous replication of the vector in the cell independent of the genome.
For integration into the host cell genome, the vector may rely on the polynucleotide's sequence encoding the polypeptide or any other element of the vector for integration into the genome by homologous or non-homologous recombination. Alternatively, the vector may contain additional polynucleotides for directing integration by homologous recombination into the genome of the host cell at a precise location(s) in the chromosome(s). To increase the likelihood of integration at a precise location, the integrational elements should contain a sufficient number of nucleic acids, such as 100 to 10,000 base pairs, 400 to 10,000 base pairs, and 800 to 10,000 base pairs, which have a high degree of sequence identity to the corresponding target sequence to enhance the probability of homologous recombination. The integrational elements may be any sequence that is homologous with the target sequence in the genome of the host cell. Furthermore, the integrational elements may be non-encoding or encoding polynucleotides. On the other hand, the vector may be integrated into the genome of the host cell by non-homologous recombination.
For autonomous replication, the vector may further comprise an origin of replication enabling the vector to replicate autonomously in the host cell in question. The origin of replication may be any plasmid replicator mediating autonomous replication that functions in a cell. The term “origin of replication” or “plasmid replicator” means a polynucleotide that enables a plasmid or vector to replicate in vivo.
Examples of bacterial origins of replication are the origins of replication of plasmids pBR322, pUC19, pACYC177, and pACYC184 permitting replication in E. coli, and pUB110, pE194, pTA1060, and pAMβ1 permitting replication in Bacillus.
Examples of origins of replication for use in a yeast host cell are the 2 micron origin of replication, ARS1, ARS4, the combination of ARS1 and CEN3, and the combination of ARS4 and CEN6.
Examples of origins of replication useful in a filamentous fungal cell are AMA1 and ANSI (Gems et al., 1991, Gene 98: 61-67; Cullen et al., 1987, Nucleic Acids Res. 15: 9163-9175; WO 00/24883). Isolation of the AMA1 gene and construction of plasmids or vectors comprising the gene can be accomplished according to the methods disclosed in WO 00/24883.
More than one copy of a polynucleotide of the present invention may be inserted into a host cell to increase production of a polypeptide. An increase in the copy number of the polynucleotide can be obtained by integrating at least one additional copy of the sequence into the host cell genome or by including an amplifiable selectable marker gene with the polynucleotide where cells containing amplified copies of the selectable marker gene, and thereby additional copies of the polynucleotide, can be selected for by cultivating the cells in the presence of the appropriate selectable agent.
The procedures used to ligate the elements described above to construct the recombinant expression vectors of the present invention are well known to one skilled in the art (see, e.g., Sambrook et al., 1989, supra).
Host Cells
The present invention also relates to recombinant host cells, comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the production of a polypeptide of the present invention. A construct or vector comprising a polynucleotide is introduced into a host cell so that the construct or vector is maintained as a chromosomal integrant or as a self-replicating extra-chromosomal vector as described earlier. The term “host cell” encompasses any progeny of a parent cell that is not identical to the parent cell due to mutations that occur during replication. The choice of a host cell will to a large extent depend upon the gene encoding the polypeptide and its source.
The host cell may be any cell useful in the recombinant production of a polypeptide of the present invention, e.g., a prokaryote or a eukaryote.
The prokaryotic host cell may be any Gram-positive or Gram-negative bacterium. Gram-positive bacteria include, but are not limited to, Bacillus, Clostridium, Enterococcus, Geobacillus, Lactobacillus, Lactococcus, Oceanobacillus, Staphylococcus, Streptococcus, and Streptomyces. Gram-negative bacteria include, but are not limited to, Campylobacter, E. coli, Flavobacterium, Fusobacterium, Helicobacter, Ilyobacter, Neisseria, Pseudomonas, Salmonella, and Ureaplasma.
The bacterial host cell may be any Bacillus cell including, but not limited to, Bacillus alkalophilus, Bacillus amyloliquefaciens, Bacillus brevis, Bacillus circulans, Bacillus clausii, Bacillus coagulans, Bacillus firmus, Bacillus lautus, Bacillus lentus, Bacillus licheniformis, Bacillus megaterium, Bacillus pumilus, Bacillus stearothermophilus, Bacillus subtilis, and Bacillus thuringiensis cells.
The bacterial host cell may also be any Streptococcus cell including, but not limited to, Streptococcus equisimilis, Streptococcus pyogenes, Streptococcus uberis, and Streptococcus equi subsp. Zooepidemicus cells.
The bacterial host cell may also be any Streptomyces cell including, but not limited to, Streptomyces achromogenes, Streptomyces avermitilis, Streptomyces coelicolor, Streptomyces griseus, and Streptomyces lividans cells.
The introduction of DNA into a Bacillus cell may be effected by protoplast transformation (see, e.g., Chang and Cohen, 1979, Mol. Gen. Genet. 168: 111-115), competent cell transformation (see, e.g., Young and Spizizen, 1961, J. Bacteriol. 81: 823-829, or Dubnau and Davidoff-Abelson, 1971, J. Mol. Biol. 56: 209-221), electroporation (see, e.g., Shigekawa and Dower, 1988, Biotechniques 6: 742-751), or conjugation (see, e.g., Koehler and Thorne, 1987, J. Bacteriol. 169: 5271-5278). The introduction of DNA into an E. coli cell may be effected by protoplast transformation (see, e.g., Hanahan, 1983, J. Mol. Biol. 166: 557-580) or electroporation (see, e.g., Dower et al., 1988, Nucleic Acids Res. 16: 6127-6145). The introduction of DNA into a Streptomyces cell may be effected by protoplast transformation, electroporation (see, e.g., Gong et al., 2004, Folia Microbiol. (Praha) 49: 399-405), conjugation (see, e.g., Mazodier et al., 1989, J. Bacteriol. 171: 3583-3585), or transduction (see, e.g., Burke et al., 2001, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 98: 6289-6294). The introduction of DNA into a Pseudomonas cell may be effected by electroporation (see, e.g., Choi et al., 2006, J. Microbiol. Methods 64: 391-397) or conjugation (see, e.g., Pinedo and Smets, 2005, Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 71: 51-57). The introduction of DNA into a Streptococcus cell may be effected by natural competence (see, e.g., Perry and Kuramitsu, 1981, Infect Immun. 32: 1295-1297), protoplast transformation (see, e.g., Catt and Jollick, 1991, Microbios 68: 189-207), electroporation (see, e.g., Buckley et al., 1999, Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 65: 3800-3804), or conjugation (see, e.g., Clewell, 1981, Microbiol. Rev. 45: 409-436). However, any method known in the art for introducing DNA into a host cell can be used.
The host cell may also be a eukaryote, such as a mammalian, insect, plant, or fungal cell.
The host cell may be a fungal cell. “Fungi” as used herein includes the phyla Ascomycota, Basidiomycota, Chytridiomycota, and Zygomycota as well as the Oomycota and all mitosporic fungi (as defined by Hawksworth et al., In, Ainsworth and Bisby's Dictionary of The Fungi, 8th edition, 1995, CAB International, University Press, Cambridge, UK).
The fungal host cell may be a yeast cell. “Yeast” as used herein includes ascosporogenous yeast (Endomycetales), basidiosporogenous yeast, and yeast belonging to the Fungi Imperfecti (Blastomycetes). Since the classification of yeast may change in the future, for the purposes of this invention, yeast shall be defined as described in Biology and Activities of Yeast (Skinner, Passmore, and Davenport, editors, Soc. App. Bacteriol. Symposium Series No. 9, 1980).
The yeast host cell may be a Candida, Hansenula, Kluyveromyces, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Schizosaccharomyces, or Yarrowia cell, such as a Kluyveromyces lactis, Saccharomyces carlsbergensis, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Saccharomyces diastaticus, Saccharomyces douglasii, Saccharomyces kluyveri, Saccharomyces norbensis, Saccharomyces oviformis, or Yarrowia lipolytica cell.
The fungal host cell may be a filamentous fungal cell. “Filamentous fungi” include all filamentous forms of the subdivision Eumycota and Oomycota (as defined by Hawksworth et al., 1995, supra). The filamentous fungi are generally characterized by a mycelial wall composed of chitin, cellulose, glucan, chitosan, mannan, and other complex polysaccharides. Vegetative growth is by hyphal elongation and carbon catabolism is obligately aerobic. In contrast, vegetative growth by yeasts such as Saccharomyces cerevisiae is by budding of a unicellular thallus and carbon catabolism may be fermentative.
The filamentous fungal host cell may be an Acremonium, Aspergillus, Aureobasidium, Bjerkandera, Ceriporiopsis, Chrysosporium, Coprinus, Coriolus, Cryptococcus, Filibasidium, Fusarium, Humicola, Magnaporthe, Mucor, Myceliophthora, Neocallimastix, Neurospora, Paecilomyces, Penicillium, Phanerochaete, Phiebia, Piromyces, Pleurotus, Schizophyllum, Talaromyces, Thermoascus, Thielavia, Tolypocladium, Trametes, or Trichoderma cell.
For example, the filamentous fungal host cell may be an Aspergillus awamori, Aspergillus foetidus, Aspergillus fumigatus, Aspergillus japonicus, Aspergillus nidulans, Aspergillus niger, Aspergillus oryzae, Bjerkandera adusta, Ceriporiopsis aneirina, Ceriporiopsis caregiea, Ceriporiopsis gilvescens, Ceriporiopsis pannocinta, Ceriporiopsis rivulosa, Ceriporiopsis subrufa, Ceriporiopsis subvermispora, Chrysosporium inops, Chrysosporium keratinophilum, Chrysosporium lucknowense, Chrysosporium merdarium, Chrysosporium pannicola, Chrysosporium queenslandicum, Chrysosporium tropicum, Chrysosporium zonatum, Coprinus cinereus, Coriolus hirsutus, Fusarium bactridioides, Fusarium cerealis, Fusarium crookwellense, Fusarium culmorum, Fusarium graminearum, Fusarium graminum, Fusarium heterosporum, Fusarium negundi, Fusarium oxysporum, Fusarium reticulatum, Fusarium roseum, Fusarium sambucinum, Fusarium sarcochroum, Fusarium sporotrichioides, Fusarium suiphureum, Fusarium torulosum, Fusarium trichothecioides, Fusarium venenatum, Humicola insolens, Humicola lanuginosa, Mucor miehei, Myceliophthora thermophila, Neurospora crassa, Penicillium purpurogenum, Phanerochaete chrysosporium, Phiebia radiata, Pleurotus eryngii, Thielavia terrestris, Trametes villosa, Trametes versicolor, Trichoderma harzianum, Trichoderma koningii, Trichoderma longibrachiatum, Trichoderma reesei, or Trichoderma viride cell.
Fungal cells may be transformed by a process involving protoplast formation, transformation of the protoplasts, and regeneration of the cell wall in a manner known per se. Suitable procedures for transformation of Aspergillus and Trichoderma host cells are described in EP 238023, Yelton et al., 1984, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 81: 1470-1474, and Christensen et al., 1988, Bio/Technology 6: 1419-1422. Suitable methods for transforming Fusarium species are described by Malardier et al., 1989, Gene 78: 147-156, and WO 96/00787. Yeast may be transformed using the procedures described by Becker and Guarente, In Abelson, J. N. and Simon, M. I., editors, Guide to Yeast Genetics and Molecular Biology, Methods in Enzymology, Volume 194, pp 182-187, Academic Press, Inc., New York; Ito et al., 1983, J. Bacteriol. 153: 163; and Hinnen et al., 1978, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 75: 1920.
Methods of Production
The present invention also relates to methods of producing a polypeptide of the present invention, comprising: (a) cultivating a cell, which in its wild-type form produces the polypeptide, under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide; and optionally (b) recovering the polypeptide. In one aspect, the cell is an Aurantiporus cell. In another aspect, the cell is an Aurantiporus alborubescens cell. In another aspect, the cell is Aurantiporus alborubescens strain NN00802. In another aspect, the cell is a Trichophaea cell. In another aspect, the cell is a Trichophaea saccata cell. In another aspect, the cell is Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70. In another aspect, the cell is a Penicillium cell. In another aspect, the cell is a Penicillium thomii cell. In another aspect, the cell is Penicillium thomii IBT 10776.
The present invention also relates to methods of producing a polypeptide of the present invention, comprising: (a) cultivating a recombinant host cell of the present invention under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide; and optionally (b) recovering the polypeptide.
The host cells are cultivated in a nutrient medium suitable for production of the polypeptide using methods known in the art. For example, the cells may be cultivated by shake flask cultivation, or small-scale or large-scale fermentation (including continuous, batch, fed-batch, or solid state fermentations) in laboratory or industrial fermentors in a suitable medium and under conditions allowing the polypeptide to be expressed and/or isolated. The cultivation takes place in a suitable nutrient medium comprising carbon and nitrogen sources and inorganic salts, using procedures known in the art. Suitable media are available from commercial suppliers or may be prepared according to published compositions (e.g., in catalogues of the American Type Culture Collection). If the polypeptide is secreted into the nutrient medium, the polypeptide can be recovered directly from the medium. If the polypeptide is not secreted, it can be recovered from cell lysates.
The polypeptide may be detected using methods known in the art that are specific for the polypeptides. These detection methods include, but are not limited to, use of specific antibodies, formation of an enzyme product, or disappearance of an enzyme substrate. For example, an enzyme assay may be used to determine the activity of the polypeptide.
The polypeptide may be recovered using methods known in the art. For example, the polypeptide may be recovered from the nutrient medium by conventional procedures including, but not limited to, collection, centrifugation, filtration, extraction, spray-drying, evaporation, or precipitation. In one aspect, a fermentation broth comprising the polypeptide is recovered.
The polypeptide may be purified by a variety of procedures known in the art including, but not limited to, chromatography (e.g., ion exchange, affinity, hydrophobic, chromatofocusing, and size exclusion), electrophoretic procedures (e.g., preparative isoelectric focusing), differential solubility (e.g., ammonium sulfate precipitation), SDS-PAGE, or extraction (see, e.g., Protein Purification, Janson and Ryden, editors, VCH Publishers, New York, 1989) to obtain substantially pure polypeptides.
In an alternative aspect, the polypeptide is not recovered, but rather a host cell of the present invention expressing the polypeptide is used as a source of the polypeptide.
Plants
The present invention also relates to isolated plants, e.g., a transgenic plant, plant part, or plant cell, comprising a polynucleotide of the present invention so as to express and produce a polypeptide or domain in recoverable quantities. The polypeptide or domain may be recovered from the plant or plant part. Alternatively, the plant or plant part containing the polypeptide or domain may be used as such for improving the quality of a food or feed, e.g., improving nutritional value, palatability, and rheological properties, or to destroy an antinutritive factor.
The transgenic plant can be dicotyledonous (a dicot) or monocotyledonous (a monocot). Examples of monocot plants are grasses, such as meadow grass (blue grass, Poa), forage grass such as Festuca, Lolium, temperate grass, such as Agrostis, and cereals, e.g., wheat, oats, rye, barley, rice, sorghum, and maize (corn).
Examples of dicot plants are tobacco, legumes, such as lupins, potato, sugar beet, pea, bean and soybean, and cruciferous plants (family Brassicaceae), such as cauliflower, rape seed, and the closely related model organism Arabidopsis thaliana.
Examples of plant parts are stem, callus, leaves, root, fruits, seeds, and tubers as well as the individual tissues comprising these parts, e.g., epidermis, mesophyll, parenchyme, vascular tissues, meristems. Specific plant cell compartments, such as chloroplasts, apoplasts, mitochondria, vacuoles, peroxisomes and cytoplasm are also considered to be a plant part. Furthermore, any plant cell, whatever the tissue origin, is considered to be a plant part. Likewise, plant parts such as specific tissues and cells isolated to facilitate the utilization of the invention are also considered plant parts, e.g., embryos, endosperms, aleurone and seed coats.
Also included within the scope of the present invention are the progeny of such plants, plant parts, and plant cells.
The transgenic plant or plant cell expressing the polypeptide or domain may be constructed in accordance with methods known in the art. In short, the plant or plant cell is constructed by incorporating one or more expression constructs encoding the polypeptide or domain into the plant host genome or chloroplast genome and propagating the resulting modified plant or plant cell into a transgenic plant or plant cell.
The expression construct is conveniently a nucleic acid construct that comprises a polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide or domain operably linked with appropriate regulatory sequences required for expression of the polynucleotide in the plant or plant part of choice. Furthermore, the expression construct may comprise a selectable marker useful for identifying plant cells into which the expression construct has been integrated and DNA sequences necessary for introduction of the construct into the plant in question (the latter depends on the DNA introduction method to be used).
The choice of regulatory sequences, such as promoter and terminator sequences and optionally signal or transit sequences, is determined, for example, on the basis of when, where, and how the polypeptide or domain is desired to be expressed. For instance, the expression of the gene encoding a polypeptide or domain may be constitutive or inducible, or may be developmental, stage or tissue specific, and the gene product may be targeted to a specific tissue or plant part such as seeds or leaves. Regulatory sequences are, for example, described by Tague et al., 1988, Plant Physiology 86: 506.
For constitutive expression, the 35S-CaMV, the maize ubiquitin 1, or the rice actin 1 promoter may be used (Franck et al., 1980, Cell 21: 285-294; Christensen et al., 1992, Plant Mol. Biol. 18: 675-689; Zhang et al., 1991, Plant Cell 3: 1155-1165). Organ-specific promoters may be, for example, a promoter from storage sink tissues such as seeds, potato tubers, and fruits (Edwards and Coruzzi, 1990, Ann. Rev. Genet. 24: 275-303), or from metabolic sink tissues such as meristems (Ito et al., 1994, Plant Mol. Biol. 24: 863-878), a seed specific promoter such as the glutelin, prolamin, globulin, or albumin promoter from rice (Wu et al., 1998, Plant Cell Physiol. 39: 885-889), a Vicia faba promoter from the legumin B4 and the unknown seed protein gene from Vicia faba (Conrad et al., 1998, J. Plant Physiol. 152: 708-711), a promoter from a seed oil body protein (Chen et al., 1998, Plant Cell Physiol. 39: 935-941), the storage protein napA promoter from Brassica napus, or any other seed specific promoter known in the art, e.g., as described in WO 91/14772. Furthermore, the promoter may be a leaf specific promoter such as the rbcs promoter from rice or tomato (Kyozuka et al., 1993, Plant Physiol. 102: 991-1000), the chlorella virus adenine methyltransferase gene promoter (Mitra and Higgins, 1994, Plant Mol. Biol. 26: 85-93), the aldP gene promoter from rice (Kagaya et al., 1995, Mol. Gen. Genet. 248: 668-674), or a wound inducible promoter such as the potato pin2 promoter (Xu et al., 1993, Plant Mol. Biol. 22: 573-588). Likewise, the promoter may be induced by abiotic treatments such as temperature, drought, or alterations in salinity or induced by exogenously applied substances that activate the promoter, e.g., ethanol, oestrogens, plant hormones such as ethylene, abscisic acid, and gibberellic acid, and heavy metals.
A promoter enhancer element may also be used to achieve higher expression of a polypeptide or domain in the plant. For instance, the promoter enhancer element may be an intron that is placed between the promoter and the polynucleotide encoding a polypeptide or domain. For instance, Xu et al., 1993, supra, disclose the use of the first intron of the rice actin 1 gene to enhance expression.
The selectable marker gene and any other parts of the expression construct may be chosen from those available in the art.
The nucleic acid construct is incorporated into the plant genome according to conventional techniques known in the art, including Agrobacterium-mediated transformation, virus-mediated transformation, microinjection, particle bombardment, biolistic transformation, and electroporation (Gasser et al., 1990, Science 244: 1293; Potrykus, 1990, Bio/Technology 8: 535; Shimamoto et al., 1989, Nature 338: 274).
Agrobacterium tumefaciens-mediated gene transfer is a method for generating transgenic dicots (for a review, see Hooykas and Schilperoort, 1992, Plant Mol. Biol. 19: 15-38) and for transforming monocots, although other transformation methods may be used for these plants. A method for generating transgenic monocots is particle bombardment (microscopic gold or tungsten particles coated with the transforming DNA) of embryonic calli or developing embryos (Christou, 1992, Plant J. 2: 275-281; Shimamoto, 1994, Curr. Opin. Biotechnol. 5: 158-162; Vasil et al., 1992, Bio/Technology 10: 667-674). An alternative method for transformation of monocots is based on protoplast transformation as described by Omirulleh et al., 1993, Plant Mol. Biol. 21: 415-428. Additional transformation methods include those described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,395,966 and 7,151,204 (both of which are herein incorporated by reference in their entirety).
Following transformation, the transformants having incorporated the expression construct are selected and regenerated into whole plants according to methods well known in the art. Often the transformation procedure is designed for the selective elimination of selection genes either during regeneration or in the following generations by using, for example, co-transformation with two separate T-DNA constructs or site specific excision of the selection gene by a specific recombinase.
In addition to direct transformation of a particular plant genotype with a construct of the present invention, transgenic plants may be made by crossing a plant having the construct to a second plant lacking the construct. For example, a construct encoding a polypeptide or domain can be introduced into a particular plant variety by crossing, without the need for ever directly transforming a plant of that given variety. Therefore, the present invention encompasses not only a plant directly regenerated from cells which have been transformed in accordance with the present invention, but also the progeny of such plants. As used herein, progeny may refer to the offspring of any generation of a parent plant prepared in accordance with the present invention. Such progeny may include a DNA construct prepared in accordance with the present invention. Crossing results in the introduction of a transgene into a plant line by cross pollinating a starting line with a donor plant line. Non-limiting examples of such steps are described in U.S. Pat. No. 7,151,204.
Plants may be generated through a process of backcross conversion. For example, plants include plants referred to as a backcross converted genotype, line, inbred, or hybrid.
Genetic markers may be used to assist in the introgression of one or more transgenes of the invention from one genetic background into another. Marker assisted selection offers advantages relative to conventional breeding in that it can be used to avoid errors caused by phenotypic variations. Further, genetic markers may provide data regarding the relative degree of elite germplasm in the individual progeny of a particular cross. For example, when a plant with a desired trait which otherwise has a non-agronomically desirable genetic background is crossed to an elite parent, genetic markers may be used to select progeny which not only possess the trait of interest, but also have a relatively large proportion of the desired germplasm. In this way, the number of generations required to introgress one or more traits into a particular genetic background is minimized.
The present invention also relates to methods of producing a polypeptide of the present invention comprising: (a) cultivating a transgenic plant or a plant cell comprising a polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide or domain; and (b) recovering the polypeptide.
Removal or Reduction of Cellulolytic Enhancing Activity
The present invention also relates to methods of producing a mutant of a parent cell, which comprises disrupting or deleting a polynucleotide, or a portion thereof, encoding a polypeptide of the present invention, which results in the mutant cell producing less of the polypeptide than the parent cell when cultivated under the same conditions.
The mutant cell may be constructed by reducing or eliminating expression of the polynucleotide using methods well known in the art, for example, insertions, disruptions, replacements, or deletions. In a preferred aspect, the polynucleotide is inactivated. The polynucleotide to be modified or inactivated may be, for example, the coding region or a part thereof essential for activity, or a regulatory element required for expression of the coding region. An example of such a regulatory or control sequence may be a promoter sequence or a functional part thereof, i.e., a part that is sufficient for affecting expression of the polynucleotide. Other control sequences for possible modification include, but are not limited to, a leader, polyadenylation sequence, propeptide sequence, signal peptide sequence, transcription terminator, and transcriptional activator.
Modification or inactivation of the polynucleotide may be performed by subjecting the parent cell to mutagenesis and selecting for mutant cells in which expression of the polynucleotide has been reduced or eliminated. The mutagenesis, which may be specific or random, may be performed, for example, by use of a suitable physical or chemical mutagenizing agent, by use of a suitable oligonucleotide, or by subjecting the DNA sequence to PCR generated mutagenesis. Furthermore, the mutagenesis may be performed by use of any combination of these mutagenizing agents.
Examples of a physical or chemical mutagenizing agent suitable for the present purpose include ultraviolet (UV) irradiation, hydroxylamine, N-methyl-N′-nitro-N-nitrosoguanidine (MNNG), O-methyl hydroxylamine, nitrous acid, ethyl methane sulphonate (EMS), sodium bisulphite, formic acid, and nucleotide analogues.
When such agents are used, the mutagenesis is typically performed by incubating the parent cell to be mutagenized in the presence of the mutagenizing agent of choice under suitable conditions, and screening and/or selecting for mutant cells exhibiting reduced or no expression of the gene.
Modification or inactivation of the polynucleotide may be accomplished by insertion, substitution, or deletion of one or more nucleotides in the gene or a regulatory element required for transcription or translation thereof. For example, nucleotides may be inserted or removed so as to result in the introduction of a stop codon, the removal of the start codon, or a change in the open reading frame. Such modification or inactivation may be accomplished by site-directed mutagenesis or PCR generated mutagenesis in accordance with methods known in the art. Although, in principle, the modification may be performed in vivo, i.e., directly on the cell expressing the polynucleotide to be modified, it is preferred that the modification be performed in vitro as exemplified below.
An example of a convenient way to eliminate or reduce expression of a polynucleotide is based on techniques of gene replacement, gene deletion, or gene disruption. For example, in the gene disruption method, a nucleic acid sequence corresponding to the endogenous polynucleotide is mutagenized in vitro to produce a defective nucleic acid sequence that is then transformed into the parent cell to produce a defective gene. By homologous recombination, the defective nucleic acid sequence replaces the endogenous polynucleotide. It may be desirable that the defective polynucleotide also encodes a marker that may be used for selection of transformants in which the polynucleotide has been modified or destroyed. In an aspect, the polynucleotide is disrupted with a selectable marker such as those described herein.
The present invention also relates to methods of inhibiting the expression of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity in a cell, comprising administering to the cell or expressing in the cell a double-stranded RNA (dsRNA) molecule, wherein the dsRNA comprises a subsequence of a polynucleotide of the present invention. In a preferred aspect, the dsRNA is about 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25 or more duplex nucleotides in length.
The dsRNA is preferably a small interfering RNA (siRNA) or a micro RNA (miRNA). In a preferred aspect, the dsRNA is small interfering RNA for inhibiting transcription. In another preferred aspect, the dsRNA is micro RNA for inhibiting translation.
The present invention also relates to such double-stranded RNA (dsRNA) molecules, comprising a portion of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9 for inhibiting expression of the polypeptide in a cell. While the present invention is not limited by any particular mechanism of action, the dsRNA can enter a cell and cause the degradation of a single-stranded RNA (ssRNA) of similar or identical sequences, including endogenous mRNAs. When a cell is exposed to dsRNA, mRNA from the homologous gene is selectively degraded by a process called RNA interference (RNAi).
The dsRNAs of the present invention can be used in gene-silencing. In one aspect, the invention provides methods to selectively degrade RNA using a dsRNAi of the present invention. The process may be practiced in vitro, ex vivo, or in vivo. In one aspect, the dsRNA molecules can be used to generate a loss-of-function mutation in a cell, an organ or an animal. Methods for making and using dsRNA molecules to selectively degrade RNA are well known in the art; see, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,489,127; 6,506,559; 6,511,824; and 6,515,109.
The present invention further relates to a mutant cell of a parent cell that comprises a disruption or deletion of a polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide or a control sequence thereof or a silenced gene encoding the polypeptide, which results in the mutant cell producing less of the polypeptide or no polypeptide compared to the parent cell.
The polypeptide-deficient mutant cells are particularly useful as host cells for expression of native and heterologous polypeptides. Therefore, the present invention further relates to methods of producing a native or heterologous polypeptide, comprising: (a) cultivating the mutant cell under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide; and (b) recovering the polypeptide. The term “heterologous polypeptides” means polypeptides that are not native to the host cell, e.g., a variant of a native protein. The host cell may comprise more than one copy of a polynucleotide encoding the native or heterologous polypeptide.
The methods used for cultivation and purification of the product of interest may be performed by methods known in the art.
The methods of the present invention for producing an essentially cellulolytic enhancing-free product are of particular interest in the production of eukaryotic polypeptides, in particular fungal proteins such as enzymes. The cellulolytic enhancing-deficient cells may also be used to express heterologous proteins of pharmaceutical interest such as hormones, growth factors, receptors, and the like. The term “eukaryotic polypeptides” includes not only native polypeptides, but also those polypeptides, e.g., enzymes, which have been modified by amino acid substitutions, deletions or additions, or other such modifications to enhance activity, thermostability, pH tolerance and the like.
In a further aspect, the present invention relates to a protein product essentially free from cellulolytic enhancing activity that is produced by a method of the present invention.
Fermentation Broth Formulations or Cell Compositions
The present invention also relates to a fermentation broth formulation or a cell composition comprising a polypeptide of the present invention. The fermentation broth product further comprises additional ingredients used in the fermentation process, such as, for example, cells (including, the host cells containing the gene encoding the polypeptide of the present invention which are used to produce the polypeptide of interest), cell debris, biomass, fermentation media and/or fermentation products. In some embodiments, the composition is a cell-killed whole broth containing organic acid(s), killed cells and/or cell debris, and culture medium.
The term “fermentation broth” as used herein refers to a preparation produced by cellular fermentation that undergoes no or minimal recovery and/or purification. For example, fermentation broths are produced when microbial cultures are grown to saturation, incubated under carbon-limiting conditions to allow protein synthesis (e.g., expression of enzymes by host cells) and secretion into cell culture medium. The fermentation broth can contain unfractionated or fractionated contents of the fermentation materials derived at the end of the fermentation. Typically, the fermentation broth is unfractionated and comprises the spent culture medium and cell debris present after the microbial cells (e.g., filamentous fungal cells) are removed, e.g., by centrifugation. In some embodiments, the fermentation broth contains spent cell culture medium, extracellular enzymes, and viable and/or nonviable microbial cells.
In an embodiment, the fermentation broth formulation and cell compositions comprise a first organic acid component comprising at least one 1-5 carbon organic acid and/or a salt thereof and a second organic acid component comprising at least one 6 or more carbon organic acid and/or a salt thereof. In a specific embodiment, the first organic acid component is acetic acid, formic acid, propionic acid, a salt thereof, or a mixture of two or more of the foregoing and the second organic acid component is benzoic acid, cyclohexanecarboxylic acid, 4-methylvaleric acid, phenylacetic acid, a salt thereof, or a mixture of two or more of the foregoing.
In one aspect, the composition contains an organic acid(s), and optionally further contains killed cells and/or cell debris. In one embodiment, the killed cells and/or cell debris are removed from a cell-killed whole broth to provide a composition that is free of these components.
The fermentation broth formulations or cell compostions may further comprise a preservative and/or anti-microbial (e.g., bacteriostatic) agent, including, but not limited to, sorbitol, sodium chloride, potassium sorbate, and others known in the art.
The cell-killed whole broth or composition may contain the unfractionated contents of the fermentation materials derived at the end of the fermentation. Typically, the cell-killed whole broth or composition contains the spent culture medium and cell debris present after the microbial cells (e.g., filamentous fungal cells) are grown to saturation, incubated under carbon-limiting conditions to allow protein synthesis (e.g., expression of cellulase and/or glucosidase enzyme(s)). In some embodiments, the cell-killed whole broth or composition contains the spent cell culture medium, extracellular enzymes, and killed filamentous fungal cells. In some embodiments, the microbial cells present in the cell-killed whole broth or composition can be permeabilized and/or lysed using methods known in the art.
A whole broth or cell composition as described herein is typically a liquid, but may contain insoluble components, such as killed cells, cell debris, culture media components, and/or insoluble enzyme(s). In some embodiments, insoluble components may be removed to provide a clarified liquid composition.
The whole broth formulations and cell compositions of the present invention may be produced by a method described in WO 90/15861 or WO 2010/096673.
Examples are given below of preferred uses of the compositions of the present invention. The dosage of the composition and other conditions under which the composition is used may be determined on the basis of methods known in the art.
Enzyme Compositions
The present invention also relates to compositions comprising a polypeptide of the present invention. Preferably, the compositions are enriched in such a polypeptide. The term “enriched” indicates that the cellulolytic enhancing activity of the composition has been increased, e.g., with an enrichment factor of at least 1.1.
The compositions may comprise a polypeptide of the present invention as the major enzymatic component, e.g., a mono-component composition. Alternatively, the compositions may comprise multiple enzymatic activities, such as one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an esterase, an expansin, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
The compositions may be prepared in accordance with methods known in the art and may be in the form of a liquid or a dry composition. The compositions may be stabilized in accordance with methods known in the art.
Examples are given below of preferred uses of the compositions of the present invention. The dosage of the composition and other conditions under which the composition is used may be determined on the basis of methods known in the art.
Uses
The present invention is also directed to the following methods for using the polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity, or compositions thereof.
The present invention also relates to methods for degrading a cellulosic material, comprising: treating the cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention. In one aspect, the methods further comprise recovering the degraded or converted cellulosic material. Soluble products of degradation or conversion of the cellulosic material can be separated from insoluble cellulosic material using a method known in the art such as, for example, centrifugation, filtration, or gravity settling.
The present invention also relates to methods of producing a fermentation product, comprising: (a) saccharifying a cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention; (b) fermenting the saccharified cellulosic material with one or more (e.g., several) fermenting microorganisms to produce the fermentation product; and (c) recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
The present invention also relates to methods of fermenting a cellulosic material, comprising: fermenting the cellulosic material with one or more (e.g., several) fermenting microorganisms, wherein the cellulosic material is saccharified with an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention. In one aspect, the fermenting of the cellulosic material produces a fermentation product. In another aspect, the methods further comprise recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
The methods of the present invention can be used to saccharify the cellulosic material to fermentable sugars and to convert the fermentable sugars to many useful fermentation products, e.g., fuel, potable ethanol, and/or platform chemicals (e.g., acids, alcohols, ketones, gases, and the like). The production of a desired fermentation product from the cellulosic material typically involves pretreatment, enzymatic hydrolysis (saccharification), and fermentation.
The processing of the cellulosic material according to the present invention can be accomplished using methods conventional in the art. Moreover, the methods of the present invention can be implemented using any conventional biomass processing apparatus configured to operate in accordance with the invention.
Hydrolysis (saccharification) and fermentation, separate or simultaneous, include, but are not limited to, separate hydrolysis and fermentation (SHF); simultaneous saccharification and fermentation (SSF); simultaneous saccharification and co-fermentation (SSCF); hybrid hydrolysis and fermentation (HHF); separate hydrolysis and co-fermentation (SHCF); hybrid hydrolysis and co-fermentation (HHCF); and direct microbial conversion (DMC), also sometimes called consolidated bioprocessing (CBP). SHF uses separate process steps to first enzymatically hydrolyze the cellulosic material to fermentable sugars, e.g., glucose, cellobiose, and pentose monomers, and then ferment the fermentable sugars to ethanol. In SSF, the enzymatic hydrolysis of the cellulosic material and the fermentation of sugars to ethanol are combined in one step (Philippidis, G. P., 1996, Cellulose bioconversion technology, in Handbook on Bioethanol: Production and Utilization, Wyman, C. E., ed., Taylor & Francis, Washington, DC, 179-212). SSCF involves the co-fermentation of multiple sugars (Sheehan, J., and Himmel, M., 1999, Enzymes, energy and the environment: A strategic perspective on the U.S. Department of Energy's research and development activities for bioethanol, Biotechnol. Prog. 15: 817-827). HHF involves a separate hydrolysis step, and in addition a simultaneous saccharification and hydrolysis step, which can be carried out in the same reactor. The steps in an HHF process can be carried out at different temperatures, i.e., high temperature enzymatic saccharification followed by SSF at a lower temperature that the fermentation strain can tolerate. DMC combines all three processes (enzyme production, hydrolysis, and fermentation) in one or more (e.g., several) steps where the same organism is used to produce the enzymes for conversion of the cellulosic material to fermentable sugars and to convert the fermentable sugars into a final product (Lynd, L. R., Weimer, P. J., van Zyl, W. H., and Pretorius, I. S., 2002, Microbial cellulose utilization: Fundamentals and biotechnology, Microbiol. Mol. Biol. Reviews 66: 506-577). It is understood herein that any method known in the art comprising pretreatment, enzymatic hydrolysis (saccharification), fermentation, or a combination thereof, can be used in the practicing the methods of the present invention.
A conventional apparatus can include a fed-batch stirred reactor, a batch stirred reactor, a continuous flow stirred reactor with ultrafiltration, and/or a continuous plug-flow column reactor (Fernanda de Castilhos Corazza, Flávio Faria de Moraes, Gisella Maria Zanin and Ivo Neitzel, 2003, Optimal control in fed-batch reactor for the cellobiose hydrolysis, Acta Scientiarum. Technology 25: 33-38; Gusakov, A. V., and Sinitsyn, A. P., 1985, Kinetics of the enzymatic hydrolysis of cellulose: 1. A mathematical model for a batch reactor process, Enz. Microb. Technol. 7: 346-352), an attrition reactor (Ryu, S. K., and Lee, J. M., 1983, Bioconversion of waste cellulose by using an attrition bioreactor, Biotechnol. Bioeng. 25: 53-65), or a reactor with intensive stirring induced by an electromagnetic field (Gusakov, A. V., Sinitsyn, A. P., Davydkin, I. Y., Davydkin, V. Y., Protas, O. V., 1996, Enhancement of enzymatic cellulose hydrolysis using a novel type of bioreactor with intensive stirring induced by electromagnetic field, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 56: 141-153). Additional reactor types include fluidized bed, upflow blanket, immobilized, and extruder type reactors for hydrolysis and/or fermentation.
Pretreatment. In practicing the methods of the present invention, any pretreatment process known in the art can be used to disrupt plant cell wall components of the cellulosic material (Chandra et al., 2007, Substrate pretreatment: The key to effective enzymatic hydrolysis of lignocellulosics?, Adv. Biochem. Engin./Biotechnol. 108: 67-93; Galbe and Zacchi, 2007, Pretreatment of lignocellulosic materials for efficient bioethanol production, Adv. Biochem. Engin./Biotechnol. 108: 41-65; Hendriks and Zeeman, 2009, Pretreatments to enhance the digestibility of lignocellulosic biomass, Bioresource Technol. 100: 10-18; Mosier et al., 2005, Features of promising technologies for pretreatment of lignocellulosic biomass, Bioresource Technol. 96: 673-686; Taherzadeh and Karimi, 2008, Pretreatment of lignocellulosic wastes to improve ethanol and biogas production: A review, Int. J. of Mol. Sci. 9: 1621-1651; Yang and Wyman, 2008, Pretreatment: the key to unlocking low-cost cellulosic ethanol, Biofuels Bioproducts and Biorefining-Biofpr. 2: 26-40).
The cellulosic material can also be subjected to particle size reduction, sieving, pre-soaking, wetting, washing, and/or conditioning prior to pretreatment using methods known in the art.
Conventional pretreatments include, but are not limited to, steam pretreatment (with or without explosion), dilute acid pretreatment, hot water pretreatment, alkaline pretreatment, lime pretreatment, wet oxidation, wet explosion, ammonia fiber explosion, organosolv pretreatment, and biological pretreatment. Additional pretreatments include ammonia percolation, ultrasound, electroporation, microwave, supercritical CO2, supercritical H2O, ozone, ionic liquid, and gamma irradiation pretreatments.
The cellulosic material can be pretreated before hydrolysis and/or fermentation. Pretreatment is preferably performed prior to the hydrolysis. Alternatively, the pretreatment can be carried out simultaneously with enzyme hydrolysis to release fermentable sugars, such as glucose, xylose, and/or cellobiose. In most cases the pretreatment step itself results in some conversion of biomass to fermentable sugars (even in absence of enzymes).
Steam Pretreatment. In steam pretreatment, the cellulosic material is heated to disrupt the plant cell wall components, including lignin, hemicellulose, and cellulose to make the cellulose and other fractions, e.g., hemicellulose, accessible to enzymes. The cellulosic material is passed to or through a reaction vessel where steam is injected to increase the temperature to the required temperature and pressure and is retained therein for the desired reaction time. Steam pretreatment is preferably performed at 140-250° C., e.g., 160-200° C. or 170-190° C., where the optimal temperature range depends on addition of a chemical catalyst. Residence time for the steam pretreatment is preferably 1-60 minutes, e.g., 1-30 minutes, 1-20 minutes, 3-12 minutes, or 4-10 minutes, where the optimal residence time depends on temperature range and addition of a chemical catalyst. Steam pretreatment allows for relatively high solids loadings, so that the cellulosic material is generally only moist during the pretreatment. The steam pretreatment is often combined with an explosive discharge of the material after the pretreatment, which is known as steam explosion, that is, rapid flashing to atmospheric pressure and turbulent flow of the material to increase the accessible surface area by fragmentation (Duff and Murray, 1996, Bioresource Technology 855: 1-33; Galbe and Zacchi, 2002, Appl. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 59: 618-628; U.S. Patent Application No. 20020164730). During steam pretreatment, hemicellulose acetyl groups are cleaved and the resulting acid autocatalyzes partial hydrolysis of the hemicellulose to monosaccharides and oligosaccharides. Lignin is removed to only a limited extent.
Chemical Pretreatment: The term “chemical treatment” refers to any chemical pretreatment that promotes the separation and/or release of cellulose, hemicellulose, and/or lignin. Such a pretreatment can convert crystalline cellulose to amorphous cellulose. Examples of suitable chemical pretreatment processes include, for example, dilute acid pretreatment, lime pretreatment, wet oxidation, ammonia fiber/freeze explosion (AFEX), ammonia percolation (APR), ionic liquid, and organosolv pretreatments.
A catalyst such as H2SO4 or SO2 (typically 0.3 to 5% w/w) is often added prior to steam pretreatment, which decreases the time and temperature, increases the recovery, and improves enzymatic hydrolysis (Ballesteros et al., 2006, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 129-132: 496-508; Varga et al., 2004, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 113-116: 509-523; Sassner et al., 2006, Enzyme Microb. Technol. 39: 756-762). In dilute acid pretreatment, the cellulosic material is mixed with dilute acid, typically H2SO4, and water to form a slurry, heated by steam to the desired temperature, and after a residence time flashed to atmospheric pressure. The dilute acid pretreatment can be performed with a number of reactor designs, e.g., plug-flow reactors, counter-current reactors, or continuous counter-current shrinking bed reactors (Duff and Murray, 1996, supra; Schell et al., 2004, Bioresource Technol. 91: 179-188; Lee et al., 1999, Adv. Biochem. Eng. Biotechnol. 65: 93-115).
Several methods of pretreatment under alkaline conditions can also be used. These alkaline pretreatments include, but are not limited to, sodium hydroxide, lime, wet oxidation, ammonia percolation (APR), and ammonia fiber/freeze explosion (AFEX).
Lime pretreatment is performed with calcium oxide or calcium hydroxide at temperatures of 85−150° C. and residence times from 1 hour to several days (VVyman et al., 2005, Bioresource Technol. 96: 1959-1966; Mosier et al., 2005, Bioresource Technol. 96: 673-686). WO 2006/110891, WO 2006/110899, WO 2006/110900, and WO 2006/110901 disclose pretreatment methods using ammonia.
Wet oxidation is a thermal pretreatment performed typically at 180-200° C. for 5-15 minutes with addition of an oxidative agent such as hydrogen peroxide or over-pressure of oxygen (Schmidt and Thomsen, 1998, Bioresource Technol. 64: 139-151; Palonen et al., 2004, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 117: 1-17; Varga et al., 2004, Biotechnol. Bioeng. 88: 567-574; Martin et al., 2006, J. Chem. Technol. Biotechnol. 81: 1669-1677). The pretreatment is performed preferably at 1-40% dry matter, e.g., 2-30% dry matter or 5-20% dry matter, and often the initial pH is increased by the addition of alkali such as sodium carbonate.
A modification of the wet oxidation pretreatment method, known as wet explosion (combination of wet oxidation and steam explosion) can handle dry matter up to 30%. In wet explosion, the oxidizing agent is introduced during pretreatment after a certain residence time. The pretreatment is then ended by flashing to atmospheric pressure (WO 2006/032282).
Ammonia fiber explosion (AFEX) involves treating the cellulosic material with liquid or gaseous ammonia at moderate temperatures such as 90-150° C. and high pressure such as 17-20 bar for 5-10 minutes, where the dry matter content can be as high as 60% (Gollapalli et al., 2002, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 98: 23-35; Chundawat et al., 2007, Biotechnol. Bioeng. 96: 219-231; Alizadeh et al., 2005, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 121: 1133-1141; Teymouri et al., 2005, Bioresource Technol. 96: 2014-2018). During AFEX pretreatment cellulose and hemicelluloses remain relatively intact. Lignin-carbohydrate complexes are cleaved.
Organosolv pretreatment delignifies the cellulosic material by extraction using aqueous ethanol (40-60% ethanol) at 160-200° C. for 30-60 minutes (Pan et al., 2005, Biotechnol. Bioeng. 90: 473-481; Pan et al., 2006, Biotechnol. Bioeng. 94: 851-861; Kurabi et al., 2005, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 121: 219-230). Sulphuric acid is usually added as a catalyst. In organosolv pretreatment, the majority of hemicellulose and lignin is removed.
Other examples of suitable pretreatment methods are described by Schell et al., 2003, Appl. Biochem. and Biotechnol. Vol. 105-108, p. 69-85, and Mosier et al., 2005, Bioresource Technology 96: 673-686, and U.S. Published Application 2002/0164730.
In one aspect, the chemical pretreatment is preferably carried out as a dilute acid treatment, and more preferably as a continuous dilute acid treatment. The acid is typically sulfuric acid, but other acids can also be used, such as acetic acid, citric acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, tartaric acid, succinic acid, hydrogen chloride, or mixtures thereof. Mild acid treatment is conducted in the pH range of preferably 1-5, e.g., 1-4 or 1-2.5. In one aspect, the acid concentration is in the range from preferably 0.01 to 10 wt % acid, e.g., 0.05 to 5 wt % acid or 0.1 to 2 wt % acid. The acid is contacted with the cellulosic material and held at a temperature in the range of preferably 140-200° C., e.g., 165-190° C., for periods ranging from 1 to 60 minutes.
In another aspect, pretreatment takes place in an aqueous slurry. In preferred aspects, the cellulosic material is present during pretreatment in amounts preferably between 10-80 wt %, e.g., 20-70 wt % or 30-60 wt %, such as around 40 wt %. The pretreated cellulosic material can be unwashed or washed using any method known in the art, e.g., washed with water.
Mechanical Pretreatment or Physical Pretreatment: The term “mechanical pretreatment” or “physical pretreatment” refers to any pretreatment that promotes size reduction of particles. For example, such pretreatment can involve various types of grinding or milling (e.g., dry milling, wet milling, or vibratory ball milling).
The cellulosic material can be pretreated both physically (mechanically) and chemically. Mechanical or physical pretreatment can be coupled with steaming/steam explosion, hydrothermolysis, dilute or mild acid treatment, high temperature, high pressure treatment, irradiation (e.g., microwave irradiation), or combinations thereof. In one aspect, high pressure means pressure in the range of preferably about 100 to about 400 psi, e.g., about 150 to about 250 psi. In another aspect, high temperature means temperatures in the range of about 100 to about 300° C., e.g., about 140 to about 200° C. In a preferred aspect, mechanical or physical pretreatment is performed in a batch-process using a steam gun hydrolyzer system that uses high pressure and high temperature as defined above, e.g., a Sunds Hydrolyzer available from Sunds Defibrator AB, Sweden. The physical and chemical pretreatments can be carried out sequentially or simultaneously, as desired.
Accordingly, in a preferred aspect, the cellulosic material is subjected to physical (mechanical) or chemical pretreatment, or any combination thereof, to promote the separation and/or release of cellulose, hemicellulose, and/or lignin.
Biological Pretreatment: The term “biological pretreatment” refers to any biological pretreatment that promotes the separation and/or release of cellulose, hemicellulose, and/or lignin from the cellulosic material. Biological pretreatment techniques can involve applying lignin-solubilizing microorganisms and/or enzymes (see, for example, Hsu, T.-A., 1996, Pretreatment of biomass, in Handbook on Bioethanol: Production and Utilization, Wyman, C. E., ed., Taylor & Francis, Washington, DC, 179-212; Ghosh and Singh, 1993, Physicochemical and biological treatments for enzymatic/microbial conversion of cellulosic biomass, Adv. Appl. Microbiol. 39: 295-333; McMillan, J. D., 1994, Pretreating lignocellulosic biomass: a review, in Enzymatic Conversion of Biomass for Fuels Production, Himmel, M. E., Baker, J. O., and Overend, R. P., eds., ACS Symposium Series 566, American Chemical Society, Washington, DC, chapter 15; Gong, C. S., Cao, N. J., Du, J., and Tsao, G. T., 1999, Ethanol production from renewable resources, in Advances in Biochemical Engineering/Biotechnology, Scheper, T., ed., Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg, Germany, 65: 207-241; Olsson and Hahn-Hagerdal, 1996, Fermentation of lignocellulosic hydrolysates for ethanol production, Enz. Microb. Tech. 18: 312-331; and Vallander and Eriksson, 1990, Production of ethanol from lignocellulosic materials: State of the art, Adv. Biochem. Eng./Biotechnol. 42: 63-95).
Saccharification. In the hydrolysis step, also known as saccharification, the cellulosic material, e.g., pretreated, is hydrolyzed to break down cellulose and/or hemicellulose to fermentable sugars, such as glucose, cellobiose, xylose, xylulose, arabinose, mannose, galactose, and/or soluble oligosaccharides. The hydrolysis is performed enzymatically by an enzyme composition in the presence of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of the present invention. The enzymes of the compositions can be added simultaneously or sequentially.
Enzymatic hydrolysis is preferably carried out in a suitable aqueous environment under conditions that can be readily determined by one skilled in the art. In one aspect, hydrolysis is performed under conditions suitable for the activity of the enzyme(s), i.e., optimal for the enzyme(s). The hydrolysis can be carried out as a fed batch or continuous process where the cellulosic material is fed gradually to, for example, an enzyme containing hydrolysis solution.
The saccharification is generally performed in stirred-tank reactors or fermentors under controlled pH, temperature, and mixing conditions. Suitable process time, temperature and pH conditions can readily be determined by one skilled in the art. For example, the saccharification can last up to 200 hours, but is typically performed for preferably about 12 to about 120 hours, e.g., about 16 to about 72 hours or about 24 to about 48 hours. The temperature is in the range of preferably about 25° C. to about 70° C., e.g., about 30° C. to about 65° C., about 40° C. to about 60° C., or about 50° C. to about 55° C. The pH is in the range of preferably about 3 to about 8, e.g., about 3.5 to about 7, about 4 to about 6, or about 5.0 to about 5.5. The dry solids content is in the range of preferably about 5 to about 50 wt %, e.g., about 10 to about 40 wt % or about 20 to about 30 wt %.
The enzyme compositions can comprise any protein useful in degrading the cellulosic material.
In one aspect, the enzyme composition comprises or further comprises one or more (e.g., several) proteins selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an esterase, an expansin, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin. In another aspect, the cellulase is preferably one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase. In another aspect, the hemicellulase is preferably one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an acetylmannan esterase, an acetylxylan esterase, an arabinanase, an arabinofuranosidase, a coumaric acid esterase, a feruloyl esterase, a galactosidase, a glucuronidase, a glucuronoyl esterase, a mannanase, a mannosidase, a xylanase, and a xylosidase.
In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises one or more (e.g., several) cellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises or further comprises one or more (e.g., several) hemicellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises one or more (e.g., several) cellulolytic enzymes and one or more (e.g., several) hemicellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises one or more (e.g., several) enzymes selected from the group of cellulolytic enzymes and hemicellulolytic enzymes. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a beta-glucosidase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a beta-glucosidase and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase and a cellobiohydrolase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase and a beta-glucosidase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase and a beta-glucosidase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a beta-glucosidase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a cellobiohydrolase, a beta-glucosidase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, a beta-glucosidase, and a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an acetylmannan esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an acetylxylan esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an arabinanase (e.g., alpha-L-arabinanase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an arabinofuranosidase (e.g., alpha-L-arabinofuranosidase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a coumaric acid esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a feruloyl esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a galactosidase (e.g., alpha-galactosidase and/or beta-galactosidase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a glucuronidase (e.g., alpha-D-glucuronidase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a glucuronoyl esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a mannanase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a mannosidase (e.g., beta-mannosidase). In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a xylanase. In a preferred aspect, the xylanase is a Family 10 xylanase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a xylosidase (e.g., beta-xylosidase).
In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an esterase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises an expansin. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a laccase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a ligninolytic enzyme. In a preferred aspect, the ligninolytic enzyme is a manganese peroxidase. In another preferred aspect, the ligninolytic enzyme is a lignin peroxidase. In another preferred aspect, the ligninolytic enzyme is a H2O2-producing enzyme. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a pectinase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a peroxidase. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a protease. In another aspect, the enzyme composition comprises a swollenin.
In the methods of the present invention, the enzyme(s) can be added prior to or during saccharification, saccharification and fermentation, or fermentation.
One or more (e.g., several) components of the enzyme composition may be wild-type proteins, recombinant proteins, or a combination of wild-type proteins and recombinant proteins. For example, one or more (e.g., several) components may be native proteins of a cell, which is used as a host cell to express recombinantly one or more (e.g., several) other components of the enzyme composition. One or more (e.g., several) components of the enzyme composition may be produced as monocomponents, which are then combined to form the enzyme composition. The enzyme composition may be a combination of multicomponent and monocomponent protein preparations.
The enzymes used in the methods of the present invention may be in any form suitable for use, such as, for example, a fermentation broth formulation or a cell composition, a cell lysate with or without cellular debris, a semi-purified or purified enzyme preparation, or a host cell as a source of the enzymes. The enzyme composition may be a dry powder or granulate, a non-dusting granulate, a liquid, a stabilized liquid, or a stabilized protected enzyme. Liquid enzyme preparations may, for instance, be stabilized by adding stabilizers such as a sugar, a sugar alcohol or another polyol, and/or lactic acid or another organic acid according to established methods.
The optimum amounts of the enzymes and polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity depend on several factors including, but not limited to, the mixture of component cellulolytic enzymes and/or hemicellulolytic enzymes, the cellulosic material, the concentration of cellulosic material, the pretreatment(s) of the cellulosic material, temperature, time, pH, and inclusion of fermenting organism (e.g., yeast for Simultaneous Saccharification and Fermentation).
In one aspect, an effective amount of cellulolytic or hemicellulolytic enzyme to the cellulosic material is about 0.5 to about 50 mg, e.g., about 0.5 to about 40 mg, about 0.5 to about 25 mg, about 0.75 to about 20 mg, about 0.75 to about 15 mg, about 0.5 to about 10 mg, or about 2.5 to about 10 mg per g of the cellulosic material.
In another aspect, an effective amount of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity to the cellulosic material is about 0.01 to about 50.0 mg, e.g., about 0.01 to about 40 mg, about 0.01 to about 30 mg, about 0.01 to about 20 mg, about 0.01 to about 10 mg, about 0.01 to about 5 mg, about 0.025 to about 1.5 mg, about 0.05 to about 1.25 mg, about 0.075 to about 1.25 mg, about 0.1 to about 1.25 mg, about 0.15 to about 1.25 mg, or about 0.25 to about 1.0 mg per g of the cellulosic material.
In another aspect, an effective amount of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity to cellulolytic or hemicellulolytic enzyme is about 0.005 to about 1.0 g, e.g., about 0.01 to about 1.0 g, about 0.15 to about 0.75 g, about 0.15 to about 0.5 g, about 0.1 to about 0.5 g, about 0.1 to about 0.25 g, or about 0.05 to about 0.2 g per g of cellulolytic or hemicellulolytic enzyme.
The polypeptides having cellulolytic enzyme activity or hemicellulolytic enzyme activity as well as other proteins/polypeptides useful in the degradation of the cellulosic material, e.g., GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity (collectively hereinafter “polypeptides having enzyme activity”) can be derived or obtained from any suitable origin, including, bacterial, fungal, yeast, plant, or mammalian origin. The term “obtained” also means herein that the enzyme may have been produced recombinantly in a host organism employing methods described herein, wherein the recombinantly produced enzyme is either native or foreign to the host organism or has a modified amino acid sequence, e.g., having one or more (e.g., several) amino acids that are deleted, inserted and/or substituted, i.e., a recombinantly produced enzyme that is a mutant and/or a fragment of a native amino acid sequence or an enzyme produced by nucleic acid shuffling processes known in the art. Encompassed within the meaning of a native enzyme are natural variants and within the meaning of a foreign enzyme are variants obtained recombinantly, such as by site-directed mutagenesis or shuffling.
A polypeptide having enzyme activity may be a bacterial polypeptide. For example, the polypeptide may be a Gram positive bacterial polypeptide such as a Bacillus, Streptococcus, Streptomyces, Staphylococcus, Enterococcus, Lactobacillus, Lactococcus, Clostridium, Geobacillus, Caldicellulosiruptor, Acidothermus, Thermobifidia, or Oceanobacillus polypeptide having enzyme activity, or a Gram negative bacterial polypeptide such as an E. coli, Pseudomonas, Salmonella, Campylobacter, Helicobacter, Flavobacterium, Fusobacterium, Ilyobacter, Neisseria, or Ureaplasma polypeptide having enzyme activity.
In one aspect, the polypeptide is a Bacillus alkalophilus, Bacillus amyloliquefaciens, Bacillus brevis, Bacillus circulans, Bacillus clausii, Bacillus coagulans, Bacillus firmus, Bacillus lautus, Bacillus lentus, Bacillus licheniformis, Bacillus megaterium, Bacillus pumilus, Bacillus stearothermophilus, Bacillus subtilis, or Bacillus thuringiensis polypeptide having enzyme activity.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is a Streptococcus equisimilis, Streptococcus pyogenes, Streptococcus uberis, or Streptococcus equi subsp. Zooepidemicus polypeptide having enzyme activity.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is a Streptomyces achromogenes, Streptomyces avermitilis, Streptomyces coelicolor, Streptomyces griseus, or Streptomyces lividans polypeptide having enzyme activity.
The polypeptide having enzyme activity may also be a fungal polypeptide, and more preferably a yeast polypeptide such as a Candida, Kluyveromyces, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Schizosaccharomyces, or Yarrowia polypeptide having enzyme activity; or more preferably a filamentous fungal polypeptide such as an Acremonium, Agaricus, Alternaria, Aspergillus, Aureobasidium, Botryosphaeria, Ceriporiopsis, Chaetomidium, Chrysosporium, Claviceps, Cochliobolus, Coprinopsis, Coptotermes, Corynascus, Cryphonectria, Cryptococcus, Diplodia, Exidia, Filibasidium, Fusarium, Gibberella, Holomastigotoides, Humicola, Irpex, Lentinula, Leptospaeria, Magnaporthe, Melanocarpus, Meripilus, Mucor, Myceliophthora, Neocallimastix, Neurospora, Paecilomyces, Penicillium, Phanerochaete, Piromyces, Poitrasia, Pseudoplectania, Pseudotrichonympha, Rhizomucor, Schizophyllum, Scytalidium, Talaromyces, Thermoascus, Thielavia, Tolypocladium, Trichoderma, Trichophaea, Verticillium, Volvariella, or Xylaria polypeptide having enzyme activity.
In one aspect, the polypeptide is a Saccharomyces carlsbergensis, Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Saccharomyces diastaticus, Saccharomyces douglasii, Saccharomyces kluyveri, Saccharomyces norbensis, or Saccharomyces oviformis polypeptide having enzyme activity.
In another aspect, the polypeptide is an Acremonium cellulolyticus, Aspergillus aculeatus, Aspergillus awamori, Aspergillus fumigatus, Aspergillus foetidus, Aspergillus japonicus, Aspergillus nidulans, Aspergillus niger, Aspergillus oryzae, Chrysosporium keratinophilum, Chrysosporium lucknowense, Chrysosporium tropicum, Chrysosporium merdarium, Chrysosporium inops, Chrysosporium pannicola, Chrysosporium queenslandicum, Chrysosporium zonatum, Fusarium bactridioides, Fusarium cerealis, Fusarium crookwellense, Fusarium culmorum, Fusarium graminearum, Fusarium graminum, Fusarium heterosporum, Fusarium negundi, Fusarium oxysporum, Fusarium reticulatum, Fusarium roseum, Fusarium sambucinum, Fusarium sarcochroum, Fusarium sporotrichioides, Fusarium sulphureum, Fusarium torulosum, Fusarium trichothecioides, Fusarium venenatum, Humicola grisea, Humicola insolens, Humicola lanuginosa, Irpex lacteus, Mucor miehei, Myceliophthora thermophila, Neurospora crassa, Penicillium funiculosum, Penicillium purpurogenum, Phanerochaete chrysosporium, Thielavia achromatica, Thielavia albomyces, Thielavia albopilosa, Thielavia australeinsis, Thielavia fimeti, Thielavia microspora, Thielavia ovispora, Thielavia peruviana, Thielavia spededonium, Thielavia setosa, Thielavia subthermophila, Thielavia terrestris, Trichoderma harzianum, Trichoderma koningii, Trichoderma longibrachiatum, Trichoderma reesei, Trichoderma viride, or Trichophaea saccata polypeptide having enzyme activity.
Chemically modified or protein engineered mutants of polypeptides having enzyme activity may also be used.
One or more (e.g., several) components of the enzyme composition may be a recombinant component, i.e., produced by cloning of a DNA sequence encoding the single component and subsequent cell transformed with the DNA sequence and expressed in a host (see, for example, WO 91/17243 and WO 91/17244). The host is preferably a heterologous host (enzyme is foreign to host), but the host may under certain conditions also be a homologous host (enzyme is native to host). Monocomponent cellulolytic proteins may also be prepared by purifying such a protein from a fermentation broth.
In one aspect, the one or more (e.g., several) cellulolytic enzymes comprise a commercial cellulolytic enzyme preparation. Examples of commercial cellulolytic enzyme preparations suitable for use in the present invention include, for example, CELLIC® CTec (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® CTec2 (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® CTec3 (Novozymes A/S), CELLUCLAST™ (Novozymes A/S), NOVOZYM™ 188 (Novozymes A/S), CELLUZYME™ (Novozymes A/S), CEREFLO™ (Novozymes A/S), and ULTRAFLO™ (Novozymes A/S), ACCELERASE™ (Genencor Int.), LAMINEX™ (Genencor Int.), SPEZYME™ CP (Genencor Int.), FILTRASE® NL (DSM); METHAPLUS® S/L 100 (DSM), ROHAMENT™ 7069 W (Röhm GmbH), FIBREZYME® LDI (Dyadic International, Inc.), FIBREZYME® LBR (Dyadic International, Inc.), or VISCOSTAR® 150L (Dyadic International, Inc.). The cellulase enzymes are added in amounts effective from about 0.001 to about 5.0 wt % of solids, e.g., about 0.025 to about 4.0 wt % of solids or about 0.005 to about 2.0 wt % of solids.
Examples of bacterial endoglucanases that can be used in the methods of the present invention, include, but are not limited to, an Acidothermus cellulolyticus endoglucanase (WO 91/05039; WO 93/15186; U.S. Pat. No. 5,275,944; WO 96/02551; U.S. Pat. No. 5,536,655, WO 00/70031, WO 05/093050); Thermobifida fusca endoglucanase III (WO 05/093050); and Thermobifida fusca endoglucanase V (WO 05/093050).
Examples of fungal endoglucanases that can be used in the present invention, include, but are not limited to, a Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase I (Penttila et al., 1986, Gene 45: 253-263, Trichoderma reesei CeI7B endoglucanase I (GENBANK™ accession no. M15665), Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase II (Saloheimo, et al., 1988, Gene 63:11-22), Trichoderma reesei CeI5A endoglucanase II (GENBANK™ accession no. M19373), Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase III (Okada et al., 1988, Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 64: 555-563, GENBANK™ accession no. AB003694), Trichoderma reesei endoglucanase V (Saloheimo et al., 1994, Molecular Microbiology 13: 219-228, GENBANK™ accession no. Z33381), Aspergillus aculeatus endoglucanase (Ooi et al., 1990, Nucleic Acids Research 18: 5884), Aspergillus kawachii endoglucanase (Sakamoto et al., 1995, Current Genetics 27: 435-439), Erwinia carotovara endoglucanase (Saarilahti et al., 1990, Gene 90: 9-14), Fusarium oxysporum endoglucanase (GENBANK™ accession no. L29381), Humicola grisea var. thermoidea endoglucanase (GENBANK™ accession no. AB003107), Melanocarpus albomyces endoglucanase (GENBANK™ accession no. MAL515703), Neurospora crassa endoglucanase (GENBANK™ accession no. XM_324477), Humicola insolens endoglucanase V, Myceliophthora thermophila CBS 117.65 endoglucanase, basidiomycete CBS 495.95 endoglucanase, basidiomycete CBS 494.95 endoglucanase, Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 CEL6B endoglucanase, Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 CEL6C endoglucanase, Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 CEL7C endoglucanase, Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 CEL7E endoglucanase, Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 CEL7F endoglucanase, Cladorrhinum foecundissimum ATCC 62373 CEL7A endoglucanase, and Trichoderma reesei strain No. VTT-D-80133 endoglucanase (GENBANK™ accession no. M15665).
Examples of cellobiohydrolases useful in the present invention include, but are not limited to, Aspergillus aculeatus cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2011/059740), Chaetomium thermophilum cellobiohydrolase I, Chaetomium thermophilum cellobiohydrolase II, Humicola insolens cellobiohydrolase I, Myceliophthora thermophila cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2009/042871), Thielavia hyrcanie cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2010/141325), Thielavia terrestris cellobiohydrolase II (CEL6A, WO 2006/074435), Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase I, Trichoderma reesei cellobiohydrolase II, and Trichophaea saccata cellobiohydrolase II (WO 2010/057086).
Examples of beta-glucosidases useful in the present invention include, but are not limited to, beta-glucosidases from Aspergillus aculeatus (Kawaguchi et al., 1996, Gene 173: 287-288), Aspergillus fumigatus (WO 2005/047499), Aspergillus niger (Dan et al., 2000, J. Biol. Chem. 275: 4973-4980), Aspergillus oryzae (WO 2002/095014), Penicillium brasilianum IBT 20888 (WO 2007/019442 and WO 2010/088387), Thielavia terrestris (WO 2011/035029), and Trichophaea saccata (WO 2007/019442).
The beta-glucosidase may be a fusion protein. In one aspect, the beta-glucosidase is an Aspergillus oryzae beta-glucosidase variant BG fusion protein (WO 2008/057637) or an Aspergillus oryzae beta-glucosidase fusion protein (WO 2008/057637).
Other useful endoglucanases, cellobiohydrolases, and beta-glucosidases are disclosed in numerous Glycosyl Hydrolase families using the classification according to Henrissat B., 1991, A classification of glycosyl hydrolases based on amino-acid sequence similarities, Biochem. J. 280: 309-316, and Henrissat B., and Bairoch A., 1996, Updating the sequence-based classification of glycosyl hydrolases, Biochem. J. 316: 695-696.
Other cellulolytic enzymes that may be used in the present invention are described in WO 98/13465, WO 98/015619, WO 98/015633, WO 99/06574, WO 99/10481, WO 99/025847, WO 99/031255, WO 2002/101078, WO 2003/027306, WO 2003/052054, WO 2003/052055, WO 2003/052056, WO 2003/052057, WO 2003/052118, WO 2004/016760, WO 2004/043980, WO 2004/048592, WO 2005/001065, WO 2005/028636, WO 2005/093050, WO 2005/093073, WO 2006/074005, WO 2006/117432, WO 2007/071818, WO 2007/071820, WO 2008/008070, WO 2008/008793, U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,457,046, 5,648,263, and 5,686,593.
In the methods of the present invention, any GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity can be used as a component of the enzyme composition.
Examples of GH61 polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, GH61 polypeptides from Thielavia terrestris (WO 2005/074647, WO 2008/148131, and WO 2011/035027), Thermoascus aurantiacus (WO 2005/074656 and WO 2010/065830), Trichoderma reesei (WO 2007/089290), Myceliophthora thermophila (WO 2009/085935, WO 2009/085859, WO 2009/085864, WO 2009/085868), Aspergillus fumigatus (WO 2010/138754), GH61 polypeptides from Penicillium pinophilum (WO 2011/005867), Thermoascus sp. (WO 2011/039319), Penicillium sp. (WO 2011/041397), and Thermoascus crustaceous (WO 2011/041504).
In one aspect, the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is used in the presence of a soluble activating divalent metal cation according to WO 2008/151043, e.g., manganese sulfate.
In another aspect, the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is used in the presence of a dioxy compound, a bicylic compound, a heterocyclic compound, a nitrogen-containing compound, a quinone compound, a sulfur-containing compound, or a liquor obtained from a pretreated cellulosic material such as pretreated corn stover (PCS).
The dioxy compound may include any suitable compound containing two or more oxygen atoms. In some aspects, the dioxy compounds contain a substituted aryl moiety as described herein. The dioxy compounds may comprise one or more (e.g., several) hydroxyl and/or hydroxyl derivatives, but also include substituted aryl moieties lacking hydroxyl and hydroxyl derivatives. Non-limiting examples of the dioxy compounds include pyrocatechol or catechol; caffeic acid; 3,4-dihydroxybenzoic acid; 4-tert-butyl-5-methoxy-1,2-benzenediol; pyrogallol; gallic acid; methyl-3,4,5-trihydroxybenzoate; 2,3,4-trihydroxybenzophenone; 2,6-dimethoxyphenol; sinapinic acid; 3,5-dihydroxybenzoic acid; 4-chloro-1,2-benzenediol; 4-nitro-1,2-benzenediol; tannic acid; ethyl gallate; methyl glycolate; dihydroxyfumaric acid; 2-butyne-1,4-diol; (croconic acid; 1,3-propanediol; tartaric acid; 2,4-pentanediol; 3-ethyoxy-1,2-propanediol; 2,4,4′-trihydroxybenzophenone; cis-2-butene-1,4-diol; 3,4-dihydroxy-3-cyclobutene-1,2-dione; dihydroxyacetone; acrolein acetal; methyl-4-hydroxybenzoate; 4-hydroxybenzoic acid; and methyl-3,5-dimethoxy-4-hydroxybenzoate; or a salt or solvate thereof.
The bicyclic compound may include any suitable substituted fused ring system as described herein. The compounds may comprise one or more (e.g., several) additional rings, and are not limited to a specific number of rings unless otherwise stated. In one aspect, the bicyclic compound is a flavonoid. In another aspect, the bicyclic compound is an optionally substituted isoflavonoid. In another aspect, the bicyclic compound is an optionally substituted flavylium ion, such as an optionally substituted anthocyanidin or optionally substituted anthocyanin, or derivative thereof. Non-limiting examples of the bicyclic compounds include epicatechin; quercetin; myricetin; taxifolin; kaempferol; morin; acacetin;
naringenin; isorhamnetin; apigenin; cyanidin; cyanin; kuromanin; keracyanin; or a salt or solvate thereof.
The heterocyclic compound may be any suitable compound, such as an optionally substituted aromatic or non-aromatic ring comprising a heteroatom, as described herein. In one aspect, the heterocyclic is a compound comprising an optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl moiety or an optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety. In another aspect, the optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl moiety or optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety is an optionally substituted 5-membered heterocycloalkyl or an optionally substituted 5-membered heteroaryl moiety. In another aspect, the optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl or optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety is an optionally substituted moiety selected from pyrazolyl, furanyl, imidazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, oxazolyl, pyrrolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyridazinyl, thiazolyl, triazolyl, thienyl, dihydrothieno-pyrazolyl, thianaphthenyl, carbazolyl, benzimidazolyl, benzothienyl, benzofuranyl, indolyl, quinolinyl, benzotriazolyl, benzothiazolyl, benzooxazolyl, benzimidazolyl, isoquinolinyl, isoindolyl, acridinyl, benzoisazolyl, dimethylhydantoin, pyrazinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, pyrrolinyl, pyrrolidinyl, morpholinyl, indolyl, diazepinyl, azepinyl, thiepinyl, piperidinyl, and oxepinyl. In another aspect, the optionally substituted heterocycloalkyl moiety or optionally substituted heteroaryl moiety is an optionally substituted furanyl. Non-limiting examples of the heterocyclic compounds include (1,2-dihydroxyethyl)-3,4-dihydroxyfuran-2(5H)-one; 4-hydroxy-5-methyl-3-furanone; 5-hydroxy-2(5H)-furanone; [1,2-dihydroxyethyl]furan-2,3,4(5H)-trione; α-hydroxy-γ-butyrolactone; ribonic γ-lactone; aldohexuronicaldohexuronic acid γ-lactone; gluconic acid δ-lactone; 4-hydroxycoumarin; dihydrobenzofuran; 5-(hydroxymethyl)furfural; furoin; 2(5H)-furanone; 5,6-dihydro-2H-pyran-2-one; and 5,6-dihydro-4-hydroxy-6-methyl-2H-pyran-2-one; or a salt or solvate thereof.
The nitrogen-containing compound may be any suitable compound with one or more nitrogen atoms. In one aspect, the nitrogen-containing compound comprises an amine, imine, hydroxylamine, or nitroxide moiety. Non-limiting examples of the nitrogen-containing compounds include acetone oxime; violuric acid; pyridine-2-aldoxime; 2-aminophenol; 1,2-benzenediamine; 2,2,6,6-tetramethyl-1-piperidinyloxy; 5,6,7,8-tetrahydrobiopterin; 6,7-dimethyl-5,6,7,8-tetrahydropterine; and maleamic acid; or a salt or solvate thereof.
The quinone compound may be any suitable compound comprising a quinone moiety as described herein. Non-limiting examples of the quinone compounds include 1,4-benzoquinone; 1,4-naphthoquinone; 2-hydroxy-1,4-naphthoquinone; 2,3-dimethoxy-5-methyl-1,4-benzoquinone or coenzyme Q0; 2,3,5,6-tetramethyl-1,4-benzoquinone or duroquinone; 1,4-dihydroxyanthraquinone; 3-hydroxy-1-methyl-5,6-indolinedione or adrenochrome; 4-tert-butyl-5-methoxy-1,2-benzoquinone; pyrroloquinoline quinone; or a salt or solvate thereof.
The sulfur-containing compound may be any suitable compound comprising one or more sulfur atoms. In one aspect, the sulfur-containing comprises a moiety selected from thionyl, thioether, sulfinyl, sulfonyl, sulfamide, sulfonamide, sulfonic acid, and sulfonic ester. Non-limiting examples of the sulfur-containing compounds include ethanethiol; 2-propanethiol; 2-propene-1-thiol; 2-mercaptoethanesulfonic acid; benzenethiol; benzene-1,2-dithiol; cysteine; methionine; glutathione; cystine; or a salt or solvate thereof.
In one aspect, an effective amount of such a compound described above to cellulosic material as a molar ratio to glucosyl units of cellulose is about 10−6 to about 10, e.g., about 10−6 to about 7.5, about 10−6 to about 5, about 10−6 to about 2.5, about 10−6 to about 1, about 10−5 to about 1, about 10−5 to about 10−1, about 10−4 to about 10−1, about 10−3 to about 10−1, or about 10−3 to about 10−2. In another aspect, an effective amount of such a compound described above is about 0.1 μM to about 1 M, e.g., about 0.5 μM to about 0.75 M, about 0.75 μM to about 0.5 M, about 1 μM to about 0.25 M, about 1 μM to about 0.1 M, about 5 μM to about 50 mM, about 10 μM to about 25 mM, about 50 μM to about 25 mM, about 10 μM to about 10 mM, about 5 μM to about 5 mM, or about 0.1 mM to about 1 mM.
The term “liquor” means the solution phase, either aqueous, organic, or a combination thereof, arising from treatment of a lignocellulose and/or hemicellulose material in a slurry, or monosaccharides thereof, e.g., xylose, arabinose, mannose, etc., under conditions as described herein, and the soluble contents thereof. A liquor for cellulolytic enhancement of a GH61 polypeptide can be produced by treating a lignocellulose or hemicellulose material (or feedstock) by applying heat and/or pressure, optionally in the presence of a catalyst, e.g., acid, optionally in the presence of an organic solvent, and optionally in combination with physical disruption of the material, and then separating the solution from the residual solids. Such conditions determine the degree of cellulolytic enhancement obtainable through the combination of liquor and a GH61 polypeptide during hydrolysis of a cellulosic substrate by a cellulase preparation. The liquor can be separated from the treated material using a method standard in the art, such as filtration, sedimentation, or centrifugation.
In one aspect, an effective amount of the liquor to cellulose is about 10−6 to about 10 g per g of cellulose, e.g., about 10−6 to about 7.5 g, about 10−6 to about 5 g, about 10−6 to about 2.5 g, about 10−6 to about 1 g, about 10−5 to about 1 g, about 10−5 to about 10−1 g, about 10−4 to about 10−1 g, about 10−3 to about 10−1 g, or about 10−3 to about 10−2 g per g of cellulose.
In one aspect, the one or more (e.g., several) hemicellulolytic enzymes comprise a commercial hemicellulolytic enzyme preparation. Examples of commercial hemicellulolytic enzyme preparations suitable for use in the present invention include, for example, SHEARZYME™ (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® HTec (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® HTec2 (Novozymes A/S), CELLIC® HTec3 (Novozymes A/S), VISCOZYME® (Novozymes A/S), ULTRAFLO® (Novozymes A/S), PULPZYME® HC (Novozymes A/S), MULTIFECT® Xylanase (Genencor), ACCELLERASE® XY (Genencor), ACCELLERASE® XC (Genencor), ECOPULP® TX-200A (AB Enzymes), HSP 6000 Xylanase (DSM), DEPOL™ 333P (Biocatalysts Limit, Wales, UK), DEPOL™ 740L. (Biocatalysts Limit, Wales, UK), and DEPOL™ 762P (Biocatalysts Limit, Wales, UK).
Examples of xylanases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, xylanases from Aspergillus aculeatus (GeneSeqP:AAR63790; WO 94/21785), Aspergillus fumigatus (WO 2006/078256), Penicillium pinophilum (WO 2011/041405), Penicillium sp. (WO 2010/126772), Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 (WO 2009/079210), and Trichophaea saccata GH10 (WO 2011/057083).
Examples of beta-xylosidases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, beta-xylosidases from Neurospora crassa (SwissProt accession number Q7SOW4), Trichoderma reesei (UniProtKB/TrEMBL accession number Q92458), and Talaromyces emersonii (SwissProt accession number Q8X212).
Examples of acetylxylan esterases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, acetylxylan esterases from Aspergillus aculeatus (WO 2010/108918), Chaetomium globosum (Uniprot accession number Q2GWX4), Chaetomium gracile (GeneSeqP accession number AAB82124), Humicola insolens DSM 1800 (WO 2009/073709), Hypocrea jecorina (WO 2005/001036), Myceliophtera thermophila (WO 2010/014880), Neurospora crassa (UniProt accession number q7s259), Phaeosphaeria nodorum (Uniprot accession number QOUHJ1), and Thielavia terrestris NRRL 8126 (WO 2009/042846).
Examples of feruloyl esterases (ferulic acid esterases) useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, feruloyl esterases form Humicola insolens DSM 1800 (WO 2009/076122), Neosartorya fischeri (UniProt Accession number A1D9T4), Neurospora crassa (UniProt accession number Q9HGR3), Penicillium aurantiogriseum (WO 2009/127729), and Thielavia terrestris (WO 2010/053838 and WO 2010/065448).
Examples of arabinofuranosidases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, arabinofuranosidases from Aspergillus niger (GeneSeqP accession number AAR94170), Humicola insolens DSM 1800 (WO 2006/114094 and WO 2009/073383), and M. giganteus (WO 2006/114094).
Examples of alpha-glucuronidases useful in the methods of the present invention include, but are not limited to, alpha-glucuronidases from Aspergillus clavatus (UniProt accession number alcc12), Aspergillus fumigatus (SwissProt accession number Q4VVVV45), Aspergillus niger (Uniprot accession number Q96WX9), Aspergillus terreus (SwissProt accession number Q0CJP9), Humicola insolens (WO 2010/014706), Penicillium aurantiogriseum (WO 2009/068565), Talaromyces emersonii (UniProt accession number Q8X211), and Trichoderma reesei (Uniprot accession number Q99024).
The polypeptides having enzyme activity used in the methods of the present invention may be produced by fermentation of the above-noted microbial strains on a nutrient medium containing suitable carbon and nitrogen sources and inorganic salts, using procedures known in the art (see, e.g., Bennett, J. W. and LaSure, L. (eds.), More Gene Manipulations in Fungi, Academic Press, C A, 1991). Suitable media are available from commercial suppliers or may be prepared according to published compositions (e.g., in catalogues of the American Type Culture Collection). Temperature ranges and other conditions suitable for growth and enzyme production are known in the art (see, e.g., Bailey, J. E., and Ollis, D. F., Biochemical Engineering Fundamentals, McGraw-Hill Book Company, NY, 1986).
The fermentation can be any method of cultivation of a cell resulting in the expression or isolation of an enzyme or protein. Fermentation may, therefore, be understood as comprising shake flask cultivation, or small- or large-scale fermentation (including continuous, batch, fed-batch, or solid state fermentations) in laboratory or industrial fermentors performed in a suitable medium and under conditions allowing the enzyme to be expressed or isolated. The resulting enzymes produced by the methods described above may be recovered from the fermentation medium and purified by conventional procedures.
Fermentation. The fermentable sugars obtained from the hydrolyzed cellulosic material can be fermented by one or more (e.g., several) fermenting microorganisms capable of fermenting the sugars directly or indirectly into a desired fermentation product. “Fermentation” or “fermentation process” refers to any fermentation process or any process comprising a fermentation step. Fermentation processes also include fermentation processes used in the consumable alcohol industry (e.g., beer and wine), dairy industry (e.g., fermented dairy products), leather industry, and tobacco industry. The fermentation conditions depend on the desired fermentation product and fermenting organism and can easily be determined by one skilled in the art.
In the fermentation step, sugars, released from the cellulosic material as a result of the pretreatment and enzymatic hydrolysis steps, are fermented to a product, e.g., ethanol, by a fermenting organism, such as yeast. Hydrolysis (saccharification) and fermentation can be separate or simultaneous, as described herein.
Any suitable hydrolyzed cellulosic material can be used in the fermentation step in practicing the present invention. The material is generally selected based on the desired fermentation product, i.e., the substance to be obtained from the fermentation, and the process employed, as is well known in the art.
The term “fermentation medium” is understood herein to refer to a medium before the fermenting microorganism(s) is(are) added, such as, a medium resulting from a saccharification process, as well as a medium used in a simultaneous saccharification and fermentation process (SSF).
“Fermenting microorganism” refers to any microorganism, including bacterial and fungal organisms, suitable for use in a desired fermentation process to produce a fermentation product. The fermenting organism can be hexose and/or pentose fermenting organisms, or a combination thereof. Both hexose and pentose fermenting organisms are well known in the art. Suitable fermenting microorganisms are able to ferment, i.e., convert, sugars, such as glucose, xylose, xylulose, arabinose, maltose, mannose, galactose, and/or oligosaccharides, directly or indirectly into the desired fermentation product. Examples of bacterial and fungal fermenting organisms producing ethanol are described by Lin et al., 2006, Appl. MicrobioL Biotechnol. 69: 627-642.
Examples of fermenting microorganisms that can ferment hexose sugars include bacterial and fungal organisms, such as yeast. Preferred yeast includes strains of Candida, Kluyveromyces, and Saccharomyces, e.g., Candida sonorensis, Kluyveromyces marxianus, and Saccharomyces cerevisiae.
Examples of fermenting organisms that can ferment pentose sugars in their native state include bacterial and fungal organisms, such as some yeast. Preferred xylose fermenting yeast include strains of Candida, preferably C. sheatae or C. sonorensis; and strains of Pichia, preferably P. stipitis, such as P. stipitis CBS 5773. Preferred pentose fermenting yeast include strains of Pachysolen, preferably P. tannophilus. Organisms not capable of fermenting pentose sugars, such as xylose and arabinose, may be genetically modified to do so by methods known in the art.
Examples of bacteria that can efficiently ferment hexose and pentose to ethanol include, for example, Bacillus coagulans, Clostridium acetobutylicum, Clostridium thermocellum, Clostridium phytofermentans, Geobacillus sp., Thermoanaerobacter saccharolyticum, and Zymomonas mobilis (Philippidis, 1996, supra).
Other fermenting organisms include strains of Bacillus, such as Bacillus coagulans; Candida, such as C. sonorensis, C. methanosorbosa, C. diddensiae, C. parapsilosis, C. naedodendra, C. blankii, C. entomophilia, C. brassicae, C. pseudotropicalis, C. boidinii, C. utilis, and C. scehatae; Clostridium, such as C. acetobutylicum, C. thermocellum, and C. phytofermentans; E. coli, especially E. coli strains that have been genetically modified to improve the yield of ethanol; Geobacillus sp.; Hansenula, such as Hansenula anomala; Klebsiella, such as K. oxytoca; Kluyveromyces, such as K. marxianus, K. lactis, K. thermotolerans, and K. fragilis; Schizosaccharomyces, such as S. pombe; Thermoanaerobacter, such as Thermoanaerobacter saccharolyticum; and Zymomonas, such as Zymomonas mobilis.
In a preferred aspect, the yeast is a Bretannomyces. In a more preferred aspect, the yeast is Bretannomyces clausenii. In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Candida. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida sonorensis. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida boidinii. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida blankii. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida brassicae. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida diddensii. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida entomophiliia. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida pseudotropicalis. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida scehatae. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Candida utilis. In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Clavispora. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Clavispora lusitaniae. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Clavispora opuntiae. In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Kluyveromyces. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Kluyveromyces fragilis. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Kluyveromyces marxianus. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Kluyveromyces thermotolerans. In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Pachysolen. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Pachysolen tannophilus. In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Pichia. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is a Pichia stipitis. In another preferred aspect, the yeast is a Saccharomyces spp. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Saccharomyces cerevisiae. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Saccharomyces distaticus. In another more preferred aspect, the yeast is Saccharomyces uvarum.
In a preferred aspect, the bacterium is a Bacillus. In a more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Bacillus coagulans. In another preferred aspect, the bacterium is a Clostridium. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Clostridium acetobutylicum. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Clostridium phytofermentans. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Clostridium thermocellum. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Geobacillus sp. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is a Thermoanaerobacter. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Thermoanaerobacter saccharolyticum. In another preferred aspect, the bacterium is a Zymomonas. In another more preferred aspect, the bacterium is Zymomonas mobilis.
Commercially available yeast suitable for ethanol production include, e.g., BIOFERM™ AFT and XR (NABC—North American Bioproducts Corporation, GA, USA), ETHANOL RED™ yeast (Fermentis/Lesaffre, USA), FALI™ (Fleischmann's Yeast, USA), FERMIOL™ (DSM Specialties), GERT STRAND™ (Gert Strand AB, Sweden), and SUPERSTART™ and THERMOSACC™ fresh yeast (Ethanol Technology, WI, USA).
In a preferred aspect, the fermenting microorganism has been genetically modified to provide the ability to ferment pentose sugars, such as xylose utilizing, arabinose utilizing, and xylose and arabinose co-utilizing microorganisms.
The cloning of heterologous genes into various fermenting microorganisms has led to the construction of organisms capable of converting hexoses and pentoses to ethanol (co-fermentation) (Chen and Ho, 1993, Cloning and improving the expression of Pichia stipitis xylose reductase gene in Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 39-40: 135-147; Ho et al., 1998, Genetically engineered Saccharomyces yeast capable of effectively cofermenting glucose and xylose, Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 64: 1852-1859; Kotter and Ciriacy, 1993, Xylose fermentation by Saccharomyces cerevisiae, Appl. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 38: 776-783; Walfridsson et al., 1995, Xylose-metabolizing Saccharomyces cerevisiae strains overexpressing the TKL1 and TALI genes encoding the pentose phosphate pathway enzymes transketolase and transaldolase, Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 61: 4184-4190; Kuyper et al., 2004, Minimal metabolic engineering of Saccharomyces cerevisiae for efficient anaerobic xylose fermentation: a proof of principle, FEMS Yeast Research 4: 655-664; Beall et al., 1991, Parametric studies of ethanol production from xylose and other sugars by recombinant Escherichia coli, Biotech. Bioeng. 38: 296-303; Ingram et al., 1998, Metabolic engineering of bacteria for ethanol production, Biotechnol. Bioeng. 58: 204-214; Zhang et al., 1995, Metabolic engineering of a pentose metabolism pathway in ethanologenic Zymomonas mobilis, Science 267: 240-243; Deanda et al., 1996, Development of an arabinose-fermenting Zymomonas mobilis strain by metabolic pathway engineering, Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 62: 4465-4470; WO 2003/062430, xylose isomerase).
In a preferred aspect, the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Candida sonorensis. In another preferred aspect, the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Escherichia coli. In another preferred aspect, the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Klebsiella oxytoca. In another preferred aspect, the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Kluyveromyces marxianus. In another preferred aspect, the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Saccharomyces cerevisiae. In another preferred aspect, the genetically modified fermenting microorganism is Zymomonas mobilis.
It is well known in the art that the organisms described above can also be used to produce other substances, as described herein.
The fermenting microorganism is typically added to the degraded cellulosic material or hydrolysate and the fermentation is performed for about 8 to about 96 hours, e.g., about 24 to about 60 hours. The temperature is typically between about 26° C. to about 60° C., e.g., about 32° C. or 50° C., and about pH 3 to about pH 8, e.g., pH 4-5, 6, or 7.
In one aspect, the yeast and/or another microorganism are applied to the degraded cellulosic material and the fermentation is performed for about 12 to about 96 hours, such as typically 24-60 hours. In another aspect, the temperature is preferably between about 20° C. to about 60° C., e.g., about 25° C. to about 50° C., about 32° C. to about 50° C., or about 32° C. to about 50° C., and the pH is generally from about pH 3 to about pH 7, e.g., about pH 4 to about pH 7. However, some fermenting organisms, e.g., bacteria, have higher fermentation temperature optima. Yeast or another microorganism is preferably applied in amounts of approximately 105 to 1012, preferably from approximately 107 to 1010, especially approximately 2×108 viable cell count per ml of fermentation broth. Further guidance in respect of using yeast for fermentation can be found in, e.g., “The Alcohol Textbook” (Editors K. Jacques, T. P. Lyons and D. R. Kelsall, Nottingham University Press, United Kingdom 1999), which is hereby incorporated by reference.
A fermentation stimulator can be used in combination with any of the processes described herein to further improve the fermentation process, and in particular, the performance of the fermenting microorganism, such as, rate enhancement and ethanol yield. A “fermentation stimulator” refers to stimulators for growth of the fermenting microorganisms, in particular, yeast. Preferred fermentation stimulators for growth include vitamins and minerals. Examples of vitamins include multivitamins, biotin, pantothenate, nicotinic acid, meso-inositol, thiamine, pyridoxine, para-aminobenzoic acid, folic acid, riboflavin, and Vitamins A, B, C, D, and E. See, for example, Alfenore et al., Improving ethanol production and viability of Saccharomyces cerevisiae by a vitamin feeding strategy during fed-batch process, Springer-Verlag (2002), which is hereby incorporated by reference. Examples of minerals include minerals and mineral salts that can supply nutrients comprising P, K, Mg, S, Ca, Fe, Zn, Mn, and Cu.
Fermentation Products: A fermentation product can be any substance derived from the fermentation. The fermentation product can be, without limitation, an alcohol (e.g., arabinitol, n-butanol, isobutanol, ethanol, glycerol, methanol, ethylene glycol, 1,3-propanediol [propylene glycol], butanediol, glycerin, sorbitol, and xylitol); an alkane (e.g., pentane, hexane, heptane, octane, nonane, decane, undecane, and dodecane), a cycloalkane (e.g., cyclopentane, cyclohexane, cycloheptane, and cyclooctane), an alkene (e.g. pentene, hexene, heptene, and octene); an amino acid (e.g., aspartic acid, glutamic acid, glycine, lysine, serine, and threonine); a gas (e.g., methane, hydrogen (H2), carbon dioxide (CO2), and carbon monoxide (CO)); isoprene; a ketone (e.g., acetone); an organic acid (e.g., acetic acid, acetonic acid, adipic acid, ascorbic acid, citric acid, 2,5-diketo-D-gluconic acid, formic acid, fumaric acid, glucaric acid, gluconic acid, glucuronic acid, glutaric acid, 3-hydroxypropionic acid, itaconic acid, lactic acid, malic acid, malonic acid, oxalic acid, oxaloacetic acid, propionic acid, succinic acid, and xylonic acid); and polyketide. The fermentation product can also be protein as a high value product.
In a preferred aspect, the fermentation product is an alcohol. It will be understood that the term “alcohol” encompasses a substance that contains one or more hydroxyl moieties. In a more preferred aspect, the alcohol is n-butanol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is isobutanol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is ethanol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is methanol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is arabinitol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is butanediol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is ethylene glycol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is glycerin. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is glycerol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is 1,3-propanediol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is sorbitol. In another more preferred aspect, the alcohol is xylitol. See, for example, Gong, C. S., Cao, N. J., Du, J., and Tsao, G. T., 1999, Ethanol production from renewable resources, in Advances in Biochemical Engineering/Biotechnology, Scheper, T., ed., Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg, Germany, 65: 207-241; Silveira, M. M., and Jonas, R., 2002, The biotechnological production of sorbitol, Appl. Microbiol. Biotechnol. 59: 400-408; Nigam, P., and Singh, D., 1995, Processes for fermentative production of xylitol—a sugar substitute, Process Biochemistry 30 (2): 117-124; Ezeji, T. C., Qureshi, N. and Blaschek, H. P., 2003, Production of acetone, butanol and ethanol by Clostridium beijerinckii BA101 and in situ recovery by gas stripping, World Journal of Microbiology and Biotechnology 19 (6): 595-603.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is an alkane. The alkane can be an unbranched or a branched alkane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is pentane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is hexane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is heptane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is octane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is nonane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is decane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is undecane. In another more preferred aspect, the alkane is dodecane.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is a cycloalkane. In another more preferred aspect, the cycloalkane is cyclopentane. In another more preferred aspect, the cycloalkane is cyclohexane. In another more preferred aspect, the cycloalkane is cycloheptane. In another more preferred aspect, the cycloalkane is cyclooctane.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is an alkene. The alkene can be an unbranched or a branched alkene. In another more preferred aspect, the alkene is pentene. In another more preferred aspect, the alkene is hexene. In another more preferred aspect, the alkene is heptene. In another more preferred aspect, the alkene is octene.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is an amino acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is aspartic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the amino acid is glutamic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the amino acid is glycine. In another more preferred aspect, the amino acid is lysine. In another more preferred aspect, the amino acid is serine. In another more preferred aspect, the amino acid is threonine. See, for example, Richard, A., and Margaritis, A., 2004, Empirical modeling of batch fermentation kinetics for poly(glutamic acid) production and other microbial biopolymers, Biotechnology and Bioengineering 87 (4): 501-515.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is a gas. In another more preferred aspect, the gas is methane. In another more preferred aspect, the gas is H2. In another more preferred aspect, the gas is CO2. In another more preferred aspect, the gas is CO. See, for example, Kataoka, N., A. Miya, and K. Kiriyama, 1997, Studies on hydrogen production by continuous culture system of hydrogen-producing anaerobic bacteria, Water Science and Technology 36 (6-7): 41-47; and Gunaseelan V. N. in Biomass and Bioenergy, Vol. 13 (1-2), pp. 83-114, 1997, Anaerobic digestion of biomass for methane production: A review.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is isoprene.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is a ketone. It will be understood that the term “ketone” encompasses a substance that contains one or more ketone moieties. In another more preferred aspect, the ketone is acetone. See, for example, Qureshi and Blaschek, 2003, supra.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is an organic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is acetic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is acetonic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is adipic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is ascorbic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is citric acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is 2,5-diketo-D-gluconic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is formic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is fumaric acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is glucaric acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is gluconic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is glucuronic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is glutaric acid. In another preferred aspect, the organic acid is 3-hydroxypropionic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is itaconic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is lactic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is malic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is malonic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is oxalic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is propionic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is succinic acid. In another more preferred aspect, the organic acid is xylonic acid. See, for example, Chen, R., and Lee, Y. Y., 1997, Membrane-mediated extractive fermentation for lactic acid production from cellulosic biomass, Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 63-65: 435-448.
In another preferred aspect, the fermentation product is polyketide.
Recovery. The fermentation product(s) can be optionally recovered from the fermentation medium using any method known in the art including, but not limited to, chromatography, electrophoretic procedures, differential solubility, distillation, or extraction. For example, alcohol is separated from the fermented cellulosic material and purified by conventional methods of distillation. Ethanol with a purity of up to about 96 vol. % can be obtained, which can be used as, for example, fuel ethanol, drinking ethanol, i.e., potable neutral spirits, or industrial ethanol.
Signal Peptide
The present invention also relates to an isolated polynucleotide encoding a signal peptide comprising or consisting of amino acids 1 to 20 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 1 to 17 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 1 to 23 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 1 to 16 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 1 to 19 of SEQ ID NO: 10. The polynucleotides may further comprise a gene encoding a protein, which is operably linked to the signal peptide. The protein is preferably foreign to the signal peptide. In one aspect, the polynucleotide for the signal peptide is nucleotides 1 to 60 of SEQ ID NO: 1, nucleotides 1 to 51 of SEQ ID NO: 3, nucleotides 1 to 69 of SEQ ID NO: 5, nucleotides 1 to 48 of SEQ ID NO: 7, or nucleotides 1 to 57 of SEQ ID NO: 9.
The present invention also relates to nucleic acid constructs, expression vectors and recombinant host cells comprising such polynucleotides.
The present invention also relates to methods of producing a protein, comprising: (a) cultivating a recombinant host cell comprising such polynucleotide; and (b) recovering the protein
The protein may be native or heterologous to a host cell. The term “protein” is not meant herein to refer to a specific length of the encoded product and, therefore, encompasses peptides, oligopeptides, and polypeptides. The term “protein” also encompasses two or more polypeptides combined to form the encoded product. The proteins also include hybrid polypeptides and fused polypeptides.
Preferably, the protein is a hormone, enzyme, receptor or portion thereof, antibody or portion thereof, or reporter. For example, the protein may be a hydrolase, isomerase, ligase, lyase, oxidoreductase, or transferase, e.g., an alpha-galactosidase, alpha-glucosidase, aminopeptidase, amylase, beta-galactosidase, beta-glucosidase, beta-xylosidase, carbohydrase, carboxypeptidase, catalase, cellobiohydrolase, cellulase, chitinase, cutinase, cyclodextrin glycosyltransferase, deoxyribonuclease, endoglucanase, esterase, glucoamylase, invertase, laccase, lipase, mannosidase, mutanase, oxidase, pectinolytic enzyme, peroxidase, phytase, polyphenoloxidase, proteolytic enzyme, ribonuclease, transglutaminase, or xylanase.
The gene may be obtained from any prokaryotic, eukaryotic, or other source.
The present invention is further described by the following examples that should not be construed as limiting the scope of the invention.
Media
PDA plates were composed of 39 grams of potato dextrose agar and deionized water to 1 liter.
YG agar plates were composed of 5.0 g of yeast extract, 10.0 g of glucose, 20.0 g of agar, and deionized water to 1 liter.
YP medium was composed of 10 g of yeast extract, 20 g of Bactopeptone, and deionized water to 1 liter.
YPG medium was composed of 2% peptone, 1% yeast extract, and 2% glucose in deionized water.
LB medium was composed of 10 g of tryptone, 5 g of yeast extract, 5 g of sodium chloride, and deionized water to 1 liter.
LB plates were composed of LB medium and 15 g of Bacto agar per liter of LB medium.
NNCYP-PCS medium was composed of 5.0 g of NaNO3, 3.0 g of NH4CI, 2.0 g of MES, 2.5 g of citric acid, 0.2 g of CaCl2 2H2O, 1.0 g of Bacto Peptone, 5.0 g of yeast extract, 0.2 g of MgSO4 7H2O, 4.0 g of K2HPO4, 1.0 ml of COVE trace elements solution, 2.5 g of glucose, 25.0 g of pretreated corn stover (PCS), and deionized water to 1 liter.
COVE trace elements solution was composed of 0.04 g of Na2B4O7.10H2O, 0.4 g of CuSO4.5H2O, 1.2 g of FeSO4.7H2O, 0.7 g of MnSO4. H2O, 0.8 g of Na2MoO2.2H2O, 10 g of ZnSO4.7H2O, and deionized water to 1 liter.
Aurantiporus alborubescens strain NN008024 was isolated from a soil from Yunnan, China by directly plating the soil sample onto a PDA plate followed by incubation at 37° C. for 5 days. The strain was then purified by transferring the mycelia onto an YG agar plate and identified as Aurantiporus alborubescens based on both morphological and molecular characterization (ITS sequencing).
The Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned as described below. Genomic DNA from Aurantiporus alborubescens strain NN008024 was isolated using a FASTDNA® SPIN Kit for Soil (MP Biomedicals, Solon, Ohio, USA) using a modification of the manufacturer's instructions. Briefly, the Kit was used with a FASTPREP®-24 Homogenization System (MP Biomedicals, Solon, Ohio, USA). A. alborubescens was grown in 5 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose for 48 hours at 30° C. Two ml of fungal material from the cultures were harvested by centrifugation at 14,000×g for 2 minutes. The supernatant was removed and the pellet resuspended in 500 μl of deionized water. The suspension was transferred to a Lysing Matrix E tube (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) and 790 μl of sodium phosphate buffer and 100 μl of MT buffer (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) were added to the tube. The sample was then secured in a FASTPREP™ System (MP Biomedicals, Solon, Ohio, USA) and processed for 60 seconds at a speed of 5.5 m/second. The sample was then centrifuged at 14,000×g for two minutes and the supernatant transferred to an EPPENDORF® tube. A 250 μl volume of PPS reagent from the FASTDNA® SPIN Kit was added and then the sample was mixed gently by inversion. The sample was again centrifuged at 14,000×g for 5 minutes. The supernatant was transferred to a 15 ml FALCON® 2059 tube. One ml of Binding Matrix suspension (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) was added and then mixed by inversion for two minutes. The sample was placed in a stationary tube rack and the Binding Matrix was allowed to settle for 3 minutes. Then 500 μl of the supernatant were removed and discarded and the remaining sample was resuspended in the Binding Matrix. This sample was then transferred to a SPIN™ filter (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) and centrifuged at 14,000×g for 1 minute. The catch tube was emptied and the remaining matrix suspension added to the SPIN™ filter. The sample was again centrifuged at 14,000×g for 1 minute. A 500 μl volume of SEWS-M solution (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) was added to the SPIN™ filter and the sample was centrifuged at the same speed for 1 minute. The catch tube was emptied and the SPIN™ filter replaced in the catch tube. The unit was centrifuged at 14,000×g for 2 minutes to dry the matrix of residual SEWS-M wash solution. The SPIN™ filter was placed in a fresh catch tube and allowed to air dry for 5 minutes at room temperature. The matrix was gently resuspended in 100 μl of DES (FASTDNA® SPIN Kit) with a pipet tip. The unit was centrifuged at 14,000×g for 1 minute. The concentration of the DNA harvested from the catch tube was determined at 260 nm.
The Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned using the primers shown below. The PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon through the termination codon. The primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the Eco RI-Not I cloning site of plasmid pXYG1051 (WO 2005/080559).
Primer Aua2-RI: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 11) | |
5′-GCGGAATTCAACATGCGAACCATCGCCA-3′ | |
Primer Aua2-NotI: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 12) | |
5′-ATATGCGGCCGCATAAGCAACTCCCTCAGAG-3′ |
Bold letters represent A. alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence. The underlined sequence contains the Eco RI restriction site on the forward primer (Aua2-RI) and the Not I restriction site on the reverse primer (Aua2-NotI). When the primers are used in a PCR reaction with cDNA or genomic DNA from A. alborubescens, a fragment can be produced that can be restricted with Eco RI and Not I to produce another fragment that can be cloned directionally into a suitable vector with the same restriction sites.
The PCR reaction (50 μl) was composed of 25 μl of 2×IPROOF™ HF Master Mix (Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc., Hercules, Calif., USA), 1 μl of primer Aua2-RI (100 μM), 1 μl of primer Aua2-NotI (100 μM), 1 μl of A. alborubescens genomic DNA (200 ng/μl), and 22 μl of deionized water. The IPROOF™ HF Master Mix contains buffer, dNTPs, and a thermostable DNA polymerase blend. The PCR reaction was incubated in a DYAD® Dual-Block Thermal Cycler (MJ Research, Waltham, Mass., USA) programmed for 1 cycle at 98° C. for 60 seconds; 30 cycles each at 98° C. for 10 seconds, 50° C. for 30 seconds, and 72° C. for 60 seconds; and 1 cycle at 72° C. for 10 minutes. Samples were cooled to 10° C. before removal and further processing.
Five μl of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using 40 mM Tris base-20 mM sodium acetate-1 mM disodium EDTA (TAE) buffer where an approximately 1.1 kb product band was observed. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit (GE Healthcare, Buckinghamshire, UK) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
The methodology for cloning the A. alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence into a suitable expression vector and transformation of the vector into Aspergillus oryzae and selection of Aspergillus transformants producing the GH61 polypeptide is described in Example 2 of WO 2005/080559. Briefly, the purified PCR product was ligated into the Aspergillus expression vector pXYG1051 (WO 2005/080559), which is a derivative of pMSTr46 (WO 2003/070956) modified as described in WO 2005/080559. Plasmid pXYG1051 was digested with Eco RI-Not I. The 1.1 kb gene fragment and the digested vector were ligated together in a reaction (10.2 μl) composed of 1 μl of Eco RI-Not I digested pXYG1051 (10 ng/μl of 10 mM Tris, 1 mM EDTA pH 7.5 [TE]), 8 μl of the Aua2 PCR fragment (30 ng/μl), 1 μl of 10× T4 DNA ligase buffer (Promega Corp., Madison, Wis., USA), and 0.2 μl of T4 DNA ligase (Promega Corp., Madison, Wis., USA). The reaction was incubated overnight at 16° C.
A 1 μl volume of the ligation reaction mixture was transformed into ONE SHOT® TOP10 Chemically Competent E. coli cells (50 μl; Invitrogen, Carlsbad, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions. The transformation was plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 100 μg of ampicillin per ml and the plates were incubated overnight at 37° C. Six colonies were chosen from several hundred that grew under selection and inoculated into 2 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 μg of ampicillin per ml in FALCON® tubes. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a QIAprep Spin Miniprep Kit (Qiagen GmBH, Hilden Germany) according to the manufacturer's instructions. The plasmid DNA was digested with Eco RI and Hind III and the digests analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using 90 mM Tris-borate and 1 mM EDTA (TBE) buffer, which indicated that all six clones contained an insert of the correct size of 1.5 kb. The clones were then sequenced using an ABI 3730 XL Genetic Analyzer (Applied Biosystems, Foster City, Calif., USA). One error free clone designated E. coli NP001127-5 comprising the A. alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide genomic DNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 was selected.
E. coli NP001127-5 was cultivated in 50 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 μg of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated and purified using a Plasmid Midi Kit (Qiagen GmBH, Hilden Germany) according to the manufacturer's instructions. A quantity of 1.6 μg of Aua2 GH61 plasmid DNA was used to transform Aspergillus oryzae JaL355 (WO 2001/98484) protoplasts prepared according to the method of EP0238023 B1, (pages 14-15) for A. oryzae MT3568 protoplasts. Transformants were re-isolated twice under selective and non-inducing conditions on COVE minimal plates (Cove, 1966, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 133: 51-56) with 1 M sucrose as a carbon source and 10 mM nitrate. To test expression of the Aau2 GH61 polypeptide, 18 transformants were grown for 3 days and 4 days at 30° C. in tubes with 10 ml of YPG medium. Supernatants were analyzed by SDS-PAGE using NUPAGE® 10% Bis-Tris SDS gels (Invitrogen, Carlsbad, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer. All Aspergillus isolates grew well in YPG medium when induced for expression of the Aau2 GH61 polypeptide. One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing the Aau2 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis, was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP3192. A. oryzae EXP3192 was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
An alternative method for cloning and expressing the Aua2 GH61 polypeptide is described below. Based on the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art (GENEART AG, Regensburg, Germany) or DNA 2.0 (DNA2.0, Menlo Park, Calif., USA). The synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector. Using the two synthetic oligonucleotide primers Aua2-RI and Aua2-NotI described above, a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 1. The gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae. The GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 2.
The genomic DNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 1 and SEQ ID NO: 2, respectively. The genomic DNA sequence contains 8 introns of 55 bp (nucleotides 120 to 174), 57 bp (nucleotides 232 to 288), 52 bp (nucleotides 437 to 488), 56 bp (nucleotides 555 to 610), 48 bp (nucleotides 782 to 829), 123 bp (nucleotides 933 to 1055), 55 bp (nucleotides 1151 to 1205), and 53 bp (nucleotides 1393 to 1445). The genomic DNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 322 amino acids. The % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 55.6%. Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, Protein Engineering 10: 1-6), a signal peptide of 20 residues was predicted. The SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, Biochemistry 49: 3305, and Quinlan et al., 2011, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 108: 15079). The predicted mature protein contains 302 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 31 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 6.64. The protein contains a carbohydrate binding module of the CBM1 type at the C terminus (amino acids 288 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2).
A comparative alignment of mature Family 61 amino acid sequences, without the signal peptides, was determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, J. Mol. Biol. 48: 443-453) as implemented in the Needle program of EMBOSS with a gap open penalty of 10, a gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EBLOSUM62 matrix. The alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 76.83% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Moniliophthora perniciosa (SWI SSP ROT E2 LXA6).
Culture broth prepared as described in Example 1 was concentrated approximately 20-fold using an Amicon ultrafiltration device (Millipore, Bedford, Mass., USA, 10 kDa polyethersulfone membrane, 40 psi, 4° C.). Protein concentration was determined using a BCA Protein Assay (BCA Protein Assay Kit; Thermo Fisher Scientific, Waltham, Mass., USA). Corn stover was pretreated and prepared as an assay substrate as described in WO 2005/074647 to generate pretreated corn stover (PCS). The base cellulase mixture used to assay enhancing activity was prepared from Trichoderma reesei strain SMA135 (WO 2008/057637).
Hydrolysis of PCS was conducted using 1.6 ml deep-well plates (Axygen, Santa Clara, Calif., USA) with a total reaction volume of 1.0 ml and a PCS concentration of 50 mg/ml in 1 mM manganese sulfate-50 mM sodium acetate pH 5.0. The Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide was separately added to the base cellulase mixture at concentrations ranging from 0 to 100% of the protein concentration of the base cellulase mixture. Incubation was at 50° C. for 72 hours. Assays were performed in triplicate. Aliquots were centrifuged, and the supernatant liquid was filtered by centrifugation (MULTISCREEN® HV 0.45 μm, Millipore, Billerica, Mass., USA) at 3000 rpm for 10 minutes using a plate centrifuge (SORVALL® RT7, Thermo Fisher Scientific, Waltham, Mass., USA). When not used immediately, filtered hydrolysate aliquots were frozen at −20° C. Sugar concentrations of samples diluted in 0.005 M H2SO4 with 0.05% w/w benzoic acid were measured after elution by 0.005 M H2SO4 with 0.05% w/w benzoic acid at a flow rate of 0.6 ml/minute from a 4.6×250 mm AMINEX® HPX-87H column (Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc., Hercules, Calif., USA) at 65° C. with quantitation by integration of glucose and cellobiose signals from refractive index detection (CHEMSTATION®, AGILENT® 1100 HPLC, Agilent Technologies, Santa Clara, Calif., USA) calibrated by pure sugar samples (Absolute Standards Inc., Hamden, Conn., USA). The resultant equivalents were used to calculate the percentage of cellulose conversion for each reaction. The degree of cellulose conversion to glucose plus cellobiose sugars (conversion, %) was calculated using the following equation:
Conversion(%)=(glucose+cellobiose×1.053)(mg/ml)×100×162/(Cellulose(mg/ml)×180)=(glucose+cellobiose×1.053)(mg/ml)×100/(Cellulose (mg/ml)×1.111)
In this equation the factor 1.111 reflects the weight gain in converting cellulose to glucose, and the factor 1.053 reflects the weight gain in converting cellobiose to glucose. Cellulose in PCS was determined by a limit digest of PCS to release glucose and cellobiose.
Conversion(%)=(glucose+cellobiose×1.053)(mg/ml)×100×162/(Cellulose(mg/ml)×180)=(glucose+cellobiose×1.053)(mg/ml)×100/(Cellulose (mg/ml)×1.111)
In this equation the factor 1.111 reflects the weight gain in converting cellulose to glucose, and the factor 1.053 reflects the weight gain in converting cellobiose to glucose. Cellulose in PCS was determined by a limit digest of PCS to release glucose and cellobiose.
The result of adding increasing amounts of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2GH61 polypeptide to the base cellulase mix are shown in FIG. 1 . Addition of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua2 GH61 polypeptide provided a stimulation factor of 1.17 at a 100% addition level.
The Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned from a cDNA library using the primers shown below for cloning into plasmid pDau109 (WO 2005/042735). The PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon until the termination codon. The primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the Hind III-Bam HI cloning site of pDau109.
Primer F-Aua1: |
(SEQ ID NO: 13) |
5′-ACACAACTGGGGATCCACCATGAAGGCTATCTTGGCTATTT-3′ |
Primer R-Aua1: |
(SEQ ID NO: 14) |
5′-AGATCTCGAGAAGCTTAACCACGCCACACAGCAGG-3′ |
Bold letters represent A. alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence. The underlined sequence contains the Bam HI restriction site on the forward primer (F-Aua1) and the Hind III restriction site on the reverse primer (R-Aua1). When the primers are used in a PCR reaction with cDNA or genomic DNA from A. alborubescens, a fragment can be produced that can be restricted with Bam HI and Hind III to produce another fragment that can be cloned directionally into a suitable vector with the same restriction sites. Additionally, the unrestricted fragment can be used for recombinational cloning into pDau109 using an IN-FUSION™ PCR Cloning Kit (Clontech Laboratories, Inc., Mountain View, Calif., USA).
A cDNA library was generated from A. alborubescens strain NN008024 according to the following protocol. A. alborubesens was inoculated into 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks containing 100 ml of NNCYP+PCS medium and incubated at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. The fungal mycelia were harvested by filtration through MIRACLOTH® (Calbiochem, San Diego, Calif., USA) before being frozen in liquid nitrogen. The mycelia were then pulverized into a powder by milling the frozen mycelia together with an equal volume of dry ice in a KRUPS® KM 75 coffee grinder (Krups, Shelton, Conn., USA) precooled with liquid nitrogen. The powder was transferred into a liquid nitrogen prechilled mortar and pestle (previously baked at 250° C. for 12 hours) and ground to a fine powder with a small amount of baked quartz sand (baked at 250° C. for 12 hours). The powdered mycelial material was kept at −80° C. until use. Total RNA was extracted according to a modified TRIZOL® method adapted for total RNA extraction for fungi. Briefly, to each of six 2 ml EPPENDORF® tubes, 800 μl of TRIZOL® (Life Technologies, Carlsbad, Calif., USA) was added. The powdered mycelia were distributed evenly with a metal spoon (baked at 250° C. for 12 hours) to the EPPENDORF® tubes in a quantity that did not exceed the total 2 ml volume of the tube. The samples were incubated in a 50° C. water bath for 5 minutes and then 200 μl of RNase-free chloroform was added. The samples were vortexed vigorously for 20 seconds and allowed to stand at room temperature for 10 minutes. The samples were centrifuged at 12,000×g for 10 minutes at room temperature and the top phase was then decanted to a new tube in which an equal volume of phenol-chloroform mix (Sigma Chemical, Co., St. Louis, Mo., USA) was added. The samples were centrifuged at 12,000×g for 10 minutes. The top phase was transferred to a new tube and an equal volume of chloroform-isoamyl alcohol (24:1 v/v) was added. The samples were again centrifuged at 12,000×g for 10 minutes. The aqueous phase was transferred to a new tube and 250 μl of RNase-free isopropanol (Fluka, Milwaukee, Wis., USA) were added and the samples mixed after which they were incubated at room temperature for 15 minutes. The samples were centrifuged at 20,000×g for 15 minutes at 4° C. The supernatants were carefully removed and 700 μl of RNase-free 70% ethanol were added to each of the RNA pellets, which were then centrifuged at 20,000×g for 5 minutes at 4° C. The supernatants were carefully removed and the RNA pellets air dried. The RNA pellets were resuspended in 300 μl of diethylpyrocarbonate (DEPC)-treated water. The samples were heated at 65° C. for 10 minutes to aid in resuspension. The six dissolved RNA samples were all pooled into one tube and then ethanol precipitated. Briefly, 1/10 volume of RNase-free 3 M sodium acetate pH 5.2 was added followed by 2 volumes of RNase-free 96% ethanol. The sample was mixed and left to precipitate overnight at −20 C. The sample was then centrifuged at 20,000×g for 30 minutes at 4° C. The supernatant was removed and the pellet washed with 250 μl of RNase-free 70% ethanol. The supernatant was carefully removed and the pellet allowed to air dry. The RNA pellet was then resuspended in 300 μl of DEPC-treated water and stored at −80° C. until use.
PolyA enriched RNA was made from the total RNA and isolated using an mTRAP™ Maxi mRNA Purification Kit (ActiveMotif Inc., Carlsbad, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
The cDNA library was constructed with a SMART™ cDNA Library Construction Kit (Clontech Laboratories, Inc., Mountain View, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions. The cDNA was size selected with a molecular weight cut-off of 500 base pairs by agarose gel electrophoresis. The plasmid pMHas10 (SEQ ID NO: 11) was used instead of the phage vector supplied with the Kit. Plasmid pMHas10 was prepared by restricting 5 μg of the plasmid with Sfi I and isolating the plasmid from the stuffer insert by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer. Plasmid DNA was isolated from a pool of 50,000 colonies, scraped from LB plates supplemented with 50 μg of kanamycin per ml. Plasmid DNA from the pooled bacteria was used for preparation of a plasmid library using the JETSTAR® 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol (GenoMed GmbH, Löhne, Germany).
The cDNA library was diluted to 100 ng/μl in MilliQ water and used as template for a PCR reaction using the Aua1 primers. The conditions were identical to those used for producing the PCR fragment in Example 1 except that primer F-Aua1 and primer R-Aua1 were used.
Five μl of the PCR product were analyzed by 1% agarose electrophoresis using TAE buffer, which showed the presence of a single band with the predicted size of 740 bp. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit. An IN-FUSION™ PCR Cloning Kit was used for cloning the fragments into plasmid pDau109. Two μg of pDau109 was digested with Bam HI and Hind III and the digested plasmid was run on a 1% agarose gel using TBE buffer in order to remove the stuffer fragment from the restricted plasmid. The bands were visualized by the addition of SYBR® Safe DNA gel stain (Invitrogen Inc., Carlsbad, Calif., USA) into the agarose gel and use of a 470 nm wavelength transilluminator. The band corresponding to the restricted plasmid was excised from the gel and purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit. The plasmid was eluted into 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 and its concentration adjusted to 20 ng/μl. Using the IN-FUSION™ PCR Cloning Kit the 750 bp PCR fragment (50 ng) was cloned into plasmid pDau109 (20 ng) digested with Bam HI and Hind III. The reaction was transformed into FUSION-BLUE™ E. coli cells (Clontech Laboratories, Inc., Mountain View, Calif., USA) according to the manufacturer's protocol and plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 50 μg of ampicillin per ml. After incubation overnight at 37° C., colonies were observed growing under selection on the LB ampicillin plates. Ten colonies transformed with the Aau1 GH61 construct were cultivated in LB medium supplemented with 50 μg of ampicillin per ml and plasmid was isolated using a JETQUICK™ Plasmid Purification Spin Kit (GenoMed GmbH, Löhne, Germany) according to the manufacturer's instructions.
Isolated plasmids were sequenced with vector primers in order to determine a representative plasmid expression clone that was free of PCR errors. One error free Aau1 GH61 clone comprising SEQ ID NO: 3 was selected for further work. Plasmid DNA was then isolated using a JETQUICK™ 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol (GenoMed GmbH, LOhne, Germany). Transformation of the selected plasmid into Aspergillus oryzae JaL355 was performed as described in Example 1. One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing acceptable levels of the Aau1 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis (Example 1), was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP3380. A. oryzae EXP3380 strain was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
An alternative method for cloning and expressing the Aua1 GH61 gene is described below. Based on the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0. The synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector. Using the two synthetic oligonucleotide primers Aua2-RI and Aua2-NotI described above, a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 3. The gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described in Example 1 and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae. The GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 4.
The cDNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the A. alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 3 and SEQ ID NO: 4, respectively. The cDNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 234 amino acids. The % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 56%. Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 17 residues was predicted. The SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra). The predicted mature protein contains 217 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 23 kDa and an isoelectric point of 5.97.
A comparative alignment of mature Family 61 amino acid sequences, without the signal peptides, was determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, supra) as implemented in the Needle program of EMBOSS with gap open penalty of 10, gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EBLOSUM62 matrix. The alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the A. alborubescens Aua1 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 62.09% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Schizophyllum commune H4-8 (SWISSPROT D8QHH2).
Culture broth was prepared as described in Example 4 and concentrated approximately 20-fold as described in Example 3. PCS hydrolysis experiments and determination of the degree of cellulose conversion was performed according to the procedures described in Example 3.
The result of adding increasing amounts of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide to the base cellulase mix are shown in FIG. 2 . Addition of the Aurantiporus alborubescens Aua1 GH61 polypeptide provided a stimulation factor of 1.17 at a 100% addition level.
Two synthetic oligonucleotide primers shown below were designed to PCR amplify the Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70 GH61 gene from a cDNA library prepared according to WO 2010/088387. The PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon until the termination codon. The primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the cloning site for Hind III-Bam HI digested pDau109.
Primer F-Tsa1: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 15) | |
5′-ACACAACTGGGGATCCACCATGACGCCCCTGAAACTCC-3′ | |
Primer R-Tsa1: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 16) | |
5′-AGATCTCGAGAAGCTTACTTACCGGTCCAAACCGGT-3′ |
Bold letters represent Trichophaea saccata Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence. Restriction sites are underlined. The remaining sequence is homologous to the insertion sites of pDau109.
The PCR reaction (40 μl) was composed of 20 μl of 2× IPROOF™ HF Master Mix, 1 μl of primer F-Tsa1 (100 μM), 1 μl of primer R-Tsa1 (100 μM), 1 μl of cDNA (100 ng/μl), and 17 μl of deionized water. The PCR reaction was incubated in a DYAD® Dual-Block Thermal Cycler programmed for 1 cycle at 98° C. for 60 seconds; 30 cycles each at 98° C. for 10 seconds, 55° C. for 10 seconds, and 72° C. for 60 seconds; and 1 cycle at 72° C. for 10 minutes. Samples were cooled to 10° C. before removal and further processing.
Five μl of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 750 bp product band was observed. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
Plasmid pDau109 (2 μg) was digested with the restriction enzymes Bam HI and Hind III and the digested plasmid was run on a 1% agarose gel using TBE buffer in order to remove the stuffer fragment from the restricted plasmid. The bands were visualized by the addition of SYBR® Safe DNA gel stain into the agarose gel and use of a 470 nm wavelength transilluminator. The band corresponding to the restricted plasmid was excised and purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit. The plasmid was eluted into 10 mM Tris pH 8.0 and its concentration adjusted to 20 ng/μl. An IN-FUSION™ PCR Cloning Kit was used to clone the 750 bp PCR fragment (50 ng) into pDau109 digested with Bam HI and Hind III (20 ng). The IN-FUSION™ reaction was transformed into FUSION-BLUE™ E. coli cells according to the manufacturer's protocol and plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 50 μg of ampicillin per ml. After incubation overnight at 37° C., colonies were observed growing under selection on the LB ampicillin plates. Ten transformants were selected at random and cultivated in LB medium supplemented with 50 μg of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a JETQUICK™ Plasmid Purification Spin Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
Isolated plasmids were sequenced with vector primers in order to determine a representative plasmid expression clone that was free of PCR errors. One error-free Tsa1 GH61 clone was selected. Plasmid DNA was then isolated using the JETSTAR® 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol. The purified plasmid DNA was transformed into Aspergillus oryzae Bech2 according to the method described in WO 2005/042735, pages 34-35. Aspergillus transformants were grown and then analyzed for production of Tsa1 GH61 protein by SDS-PAGE analysis according to Example 1. Two bands were observed for all transformants analyzed, a 23 kDa band and a 27 kDa band. The larger band may be the result of glycosylation. One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing the Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis, was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP3315. A. oryzae EXP3315 was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
An alternative method for cloning and expressing the Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide is described below. Based on the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 5, a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0. The synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector. Using the two synthetic oligonucleotide primers F-Tsa1 and R-Tsa1 described above, a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 5. The gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae. The GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 6.
The cDNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70 Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 5 and SEQ ID NO: 6, respectively. The cDNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 233 amino acids. The G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 59%. Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 23 residues was predicted. The SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra). The predicted mature protein contains 210 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 23 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 5.08.
A comparative alignment of mature Family 61 amino acid sequences, without the signal peptides, was determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, supra) as implemented in the Needle program of EMBOSS with a gap open penalty of 10, a gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EBLOSUM62 matrix. The alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa1 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 57.21% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Aspergillus terreus (SWISSPROT Q0CJQ7).
Culture broth was prepared as described in Example 7 and concentrated approximately 20-fold as described in Example 3. PCS hydrolysis experiments and determination of the degree of cellulose conversion was performed according to the procedures described in Example 3.
The result of adding increasing amounts of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide to the base cellulase mix are shown in FIG. 3 . Addition of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa1 GH61 polypeptide provided a stimulation factor of 1.31 at a 100% addition level.
The Trichophaea saccata CBS 804.70 Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide gene was cloned using the cDNA library obtained according to Example 7 and the primers shown below for cloning into pDau109. The PCR primers were designed to amplify the entire open reading frame from the ATG start codon through the termination codon. The primers were synthesized with 15 base pair 5′ sequences homologous to the border of the Hind III-Bam HI cloning site of pDau109.
Primer F-Tsa2: |
(SEQ ID NO: 17) |
5′-ACACAACTGGGGATCCACCATGAAATGCCTTCTCTCCCT-3′ |
Primer R-Tsa2: |
(SEQ ID NO: 18) |
5′-AGATCTCGAGAAGCTTAGCATGTAAACGGCCTTGGG-3′ |
Bold letters represent T. saccata Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence. Restriction site are underlined. The remaining sequence is homologous to the insertion sites of pDau109.
The PCR reaction (40 μl) was composed of 20 μl of 2× IPROOF™ HF Master Mix, 1 μl of primer F-Tsa2 (100 μM), 1 μl of primer R-Tsa2 (100 μM), 1 μl of cDNA (100 ng/μl), and 17 μl of deionized water. The PCR reaction was incubated in a DYAD® Dual-Block Thermal Cycler programmed for 1 cycle at 98° C. for 60 seconds; 30 cycles each at 98° C. for 10 seconds, 55° C. for 10 seconds, and 72° C. for 60 seconds; and 1 cycle at 72° C. for 10 minutes. Samples were cooled to 10° C. before removal and further processing.
Five μl of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 735 bp product band was observed. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
An IN-FUSION™ PCR Cloning Kit was used for cloning the 735 bp PCR fragment into the vector pDau109 prepared as described in Example 4. The IN-FUSION™ cloning was performed according to the manufacturer's instructions and Example 4 for pDau109 and the Tsa2 insert. The IN-FUSION™ reaction was then transformed into FUSION-BLUE™ E. coli cells according to the manufacturer's protocol and plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 50 μg of ampicillin per ml. After incubation overnight at 37° C., colonies were observed growing under selection. Ten transformants were selected at random and cultivated in LB medium supplemented with 50 μg of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a JETQUICK™ Plasmid Purification Spin Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions.
Isolated plasmids were sequenced with vector primers in order to determine a representative plasmid expression clone that was free of PCR errors. One error-free Tsa2 GH61 clone was selected. Plasmid DNA was then isolated using the JETSTAR® 2.0 Plasmid Mini/Midi/Maxi-Protocol. The purified plasmid DNA was transformed into Aspergillus oryzae Bech2 according to the method described in WO 2005/042735, pages 34-35. The transformants were grown and their culture broths analyzed as described in Example 1. For transformants producing recombinant protein, a protein band of 23 kDa was observed. One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing acceptable levels of the Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis, was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP3316. A. oryzae EXP3316 was fermented as described in Example 7 to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
An alternative method for cloning and expressing the Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide is described below. Based on the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 7, a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0. The synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector. Using the two synthetic oligonucleotide primers F-Tsa2 and R-Tsa2 described above, a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 7. The gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae. The GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 8.
The cDNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 7 and SEQ ID NO: 8, respectively. The cDNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 237 amino acids. The % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 54%. Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 16 residues was predicted. The SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra). The predicted mature protein contains 221 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 24 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 6.2.
A comparative alignment of mature Family 61 amino acid sequences, without the signal peptides, was determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, supra) as implemented in the Needle program of EMBOSS with gap open penalty of 10, gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EBLOSUM62 matrix. The alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa2 GH61 mature polypeptide shares 56.62% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Moniliophthora perniciosa FA553 (SWISSPROT E2LQM6) and Coprinopsis cinerea (SWISSPROT_A8NRC9).
Culture broth was prepared as described in Example 10 and concentrated approximately 20-fold as described in Example 3. PCS hydrolysis experiments and determination of the degree of cellulose conversion was performed according to the procedures described in Example 3.
The result of adding increasing amounts of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide to the base cellulase mix are shown in FIG. 4 . Addition of the Trichophaea saccata Tsa2 GH61 polypeptide provided a stimulation factor of 1.11 at a 100% addition level.
Penicillium thomii was isolated from a Crocus bulb in Denmark by Prof. Jen Frisvad at the Danish Technical University (DTU) and preserved under the accession number IBT 10776 at the IBT Culture Collection of Fungi, Danish Technical University, Denmark.
A Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 core fragment was cloned by PCR using the degenerate primers shown below, which were designed to amplify a conserved core region of the GH61 polypeptide gene utilizing the Codehop procedure (Rose et al., 1998, Nucleic Acids Res. 26: 1628-1635). Genomic DNA was isolated from Penicillium thomii according to the method in Example 1.
Primer GH61CHS3: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 19) | |
5′-ACCGTCGACAAGACCCAGCTCGAGTTYTTYAARAT-3′ | |
Primer GH61A_76_a: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 20) | |
5′-GGCGCCGTGGAGGGCDATGATYTCRTGNC-3′ |
The PCR reaction (15 μl) was composed of 7.5 μl of Extensor Hi-Fidelity Master Mix (ABgene, Epsom, United Kingdom), 0.5 μl of P. thomii genomic DNA (100 ng), 0.5 μl of primer GH61CHS3 (10 mM), 0.5 μl of primer GH61A_76_a (10 mM), and 6.0 μl of deionized water. The PCR reaction was incubated in a DNA Engine Cycler (MJ Research, Waltham, Mass., USA) programmed for:
Step 1 at 94° C. for 2 minutes;
Step 2 at 94° C. for 15 seconds;
Step 3 at 68° C. for 30 seconds; the temperature was decreased by 1° C. per cycle.
Step 4 at 68° C. for 1 minutes and 45 seconds;
Steps 2-4 were repeated for 9 cycles;
Step 6 at 94° C. for 2 minutes;
Step 7 at 94° C. for 15 seconds;
Step 8 at 58° C. for 30 seconds;
Step 9 at 68° C. for 1 minute and 45 seconds;
Step 11 at 68° C. for 7 minutes.
Samples were cooled to 10° C. before removal and further processing.
Five μl of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 200 bp product band was observed. The band was excised from the gel, purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions, and sequenced using appropriately diluted PCR primers for Sanger sequencing.
In order to obtain a full-length open reading frame for the GH61 core fragment obtained from the P. thomii Codehop procedure, the core fragment sequence was used to design DNA primers shown below for primer walking using a DNA Walking SpeedUp™ Kit I (Seegene Inc., Rockville, Md., USA).
Primer PtzTCPD1: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 21) | |
5′-TGATCAGCGATACCACCGAGC-3′ | |
Primer Pt-TSP1D: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 22) | |
5′-CAATAGCCGTACTGTCACCGTCC-3′ | |
Primer Pt-TSP2D: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 23) | |
5′-CAGGGTGGTTTGATCAGCGATACCAC-3′ |
The amplification was performed according to the Kit's protocol, except that the Extensor Hi Fidelity PCR Master Mix was used. The first round of PCR with the above primers resulted in three PCR bands each of about 3 kb in size. The PCR bands were sequenced with the PTSP1D primer. The resulting sequence was assembled onto the existing previous 500 bp DNA fragment using the SeqMan sequence assembly program of the DNAStar v6.1 software suite (DNA Star Inc., Madison, Wis., USA). The resulting 744 bp fragment was used to design three new DNA walking primers shown below.
Primer Pt-TSP1U: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 24) | |
5′-GGACGGTGACAGTACGGCTATTG-3′ | |
Primer PtzTCP2u: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 25) | |
5′-CGATGAGGTTGTCAGTTGCCCAGG-3′ | |
Primer Pt-TSP2U: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 26) | |
5′-GTGGTATCGCTGATCAAACCACCCTG-3′ |
The PCR reaction was composed of 4 μl of P. thomii genomic DNA (50 ng/μl), 1 μl of DNA Walking primer (DW-ACP 1, 2, 3, or 4), 1 μl of primer Pt-TSP1U (100 mM), 25 μl of 2× REDDYMIX™ (AB Gene, ABgene, Epsom, United Kingdom), which includes, buffer, dNTPs, and DNA polymerase, (AB Gene, ABgene, Epsom, United Kingdom), and 18 μl of deionized water. DNA cycling conditions and the two subsequent PCR steps were performed according to the protocol described for the DNA Walking SpeedUp™ Kit I with the following primers:
2nd PCR: | |
Primer PTZTCP2U | |
3rd PCR: | |
Primer PT-TSP2U |
The PCR fragments were cloned into a TA cloning vector using a pGEM®-T Vector System I (Promega Corp., Madison, Wis., USA) according to the manufacturer's instructions. Ligated products were transformed into ONE SHOT® TOP10 Chemically Competent E. coli cells and E. coli colonies were selected based on blue white selection as detailed in the pGEM®-T Vector System I instructions. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a JETQUICK™ Plasmid Purification Spin Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions and the pGEM plasmids were sequenced using vector primers also detailed in the pGEM®-T Vector System I instructions. Sequence results were added to the SeqMan assembly described previously in this Example and a full-length genomic sequence was obtained by the use of the customized primers below. The following customized primers allowed for PCR amplification of the entire contiguous Pt1 GH61 polypeptide genomic fragment using Penicillium thomii genomic DNA obtained according to Example 1. The sequence of the GH61 subgenomic fragment was 1485 bp in length.
Primer PtSeqDwn: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 27) | |
5′-CCCAGCTCATCAATCGTCAGT-3′ | |
Primer PtSeqUpl: | |
(SEQ ID NO: 28) | |
5′-GGTCATTGGTGATCACGACA-3′ |
Use of the two sequencing primers above permitted the completion of the genomic GH61 polypeptide coding sequence (SEQ ID NO: 9). The PCR generated fragment containing the GH61 polypeptide coding sequence is 1455 bp (including stop codon) and contains no introns.
Construction of a vector for expression of the Pt1 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence was performed as described in Example 1, with the exception that genomic DNA from Penicillium thomii was used for PCR of the expression cassette. The following primers were used in the amplification:
Primer F-P33YA: |
(SEQ ID NO: 29) |
5′-GCGGAATTCACCATGTCTCTGTCTAAGATTTCTGGA-3′ |
Primer R-P33YA: |
(SEQ ID NO: 30) |
5′-ATATGCGGCCGCC TTCTAGTTGATGGTAATATCACGAGC-3′ |
Bold letters represent Pt1 GH61 polypeptide coding sequence. The underlined sequence contains the Eco RI restriction site on the forward PCR primer (F-P33YA) and the Not I restriction site on the reverse primer (R-P33YA). When the primers are used in a PCR reaction with cDNA or genomic DNA from P. thomii, a fragment can be produced that can be restricted with Eco RI and Not I to produce a fragment that can be cloned directionally into a suitable vector with the same restriction sites.
Five μl of the PCR reaction were analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TAE buffer where an approximately 1.4 kb product band was observed. The remaining PCR reaction was purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions. The purified PCR fragment was then digested with Eco RI and Not I and again purified using an ILLUSTRA™ GFX™ PCR DNA and Gel Band Purification Kit with a final elution volume of 50 μl of 10 mM Tris pH 8.0.
The purified and Eco RI-Not I digested 1.4 kb PCR product was ligated into the Aspergillus expression vector pXYG1051 digested with Eco RI-Not I. The ligation (10.2 μl) was composed of 1 μl of Eco RI-Not I digested pXYG1051 (10 ng/μl of TE), 8 μl of the Pt1 PCR fragment (approximately 50 ng/μl), 1 μl of 10× T4 DNA ligase buffer, and 0.2 μl of T4 DNA ligase. The reaction was incubated overnight at 16° C.
A 1 μl volume of the ligation reaction mixture was transformed into ONE SHOT® TOP10 Chemically Competent E. coli cells (50 μl) according to the manufacturer's instructions. The transformation was plated onto LB agar plates supplemented with 100 μg of ampicillin per ml and the plates were incubated overnight at 37° C. Six colonies were chosen that grew under selection and inoculated into 2 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 μg of ampicillin per ml in FALCON® tubes. Plasmid DNA was isolated using a QIAprep Spin Miniprep Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions. The plasmid DNA was digested with Eco RI and Hind III and the digests analyzed by 1% agarose gel electrophoresis using TBE buffer, which indicated that all six clones contained an insert of the correct size (1450 bp). The clones were then sequenced with an ABI 3730 XL Genetic Analyzer. One error-free clone comprising the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 polypeptide genomic DNA sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9 was selected.
The E. coli clone was cultivated in 50 ml of LB medium supplemented with 100 μg of ampicillin per ml. Plasmid DNA was isolated and purified using a Plasmid Midi Kit according to the manufacturer's instructions. A quantity of 1.6 μg of Pt1 GH61 μlasmid DNA was used to transform Aspergillus oryzae JaL355 (WO 2001/98484) according to the protocol described in Example 1. Eighteen transformants were selected for further characterization by SDS-PAGE analysis of the culture broths as described in Example 1. Several transformant culture fluids contained a protein band of 65 kDa. An explanation of the larger than predicted size of 45 kDa is probably the result of glycosylation. One Aspergillus oryzae transformant producing Pt11 GH61 polypeptide, as judged by SDS-PAGE analysis, was chosen for further work and designated A. oryzae EXP03119. A. oryzae EXP03119 was fermented in 1000 ml Erlenmeyer shake flasks with 100 ml of YP medium supplemented with 2% glucose at 26° C. for 4 days with agitation at 85 rpm. Several shake flasks were used to provide enough culture broth for subsequent filtration, concentration, and/or purification of the recombinantly produced polypeptide.
An alternative method for cloning and expressing the Pt1 GH61 polypeptide is described below. Based on the nucleotide sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9, a synthetic gene can be obtained from a number of vendors such as Gene Art or DNA 2.0. The synthetic gene can be designed to incorporate additional DNA sequences such as restriction sites or homologous recombination regions to facilitate cloning into an expression vector. Using the two synthetic oligonucleotide primers F-P33YA and R-P33YA described above, a simple PCR reaction can be used to amplify the full-length open reading frame from the synthetic gene of SEQ ID NO: 9. The gene can then be cloned into an expression vector, for example, as described above and expressed in a host cell, for example, Aspergillus oryzae. The GH61 polypeptide expressed in this way corresponds to SEQ ID NO: 10.
The genomic DNA sequence and deduced amino acid sequence of the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 polypeptide encoding sequence are shown in SEQ ID NO: 9 and SEQ ID NO: 10, respectively. The genomic DNA fragment encodes a polypeptide of 484 amino acids. The % G+C content of the polypeptide encoding sequence is 53.4%. Using the SignalP software program (Nielsen et al., 1997, supra), a signal peptide of 19 residues was predicted. The SignalP prediction is in accord with the necessity for having a histidine reside at the N-terminus in order for proper metal binding and hence protein function to occur (See Harris et al., 2010, supra, and Quinlan et al., 2011, supra). The predicted mature protein contains 465 amino acids with a predicted molecular mass of 48 kDa and a predicted isoelectric point of 4.4. The GH61 core catalytic domain is amino acids 20 to 247 of SEQ ID NO: 10.
A comparative alignment of mature Family 61 amino acid sequences, without the signal peptides, was determined using the Needleman-Wunsch algorithm (Needleman and Wunsch, 1970, supra) as implemented in the Needle program of EMBOSS with gap open penalty of 10, gap extension penalty of 0.5, and the EBLOSUM62 matrix. The alignment showed that the deduced amino acid sequence of the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61A mature polypeptide shares 65.2% identity (excluding gaps) to the deduced amino acid sequence of a GH61 polypeptide from Neosartorya fischeri (SWISSPROT A1D2G7).
Culture broth was prepared as described in Example 13 and concentrated approximately 20-fold as described in Example 3. PCS hydrolysis experiments and determination of the degree of cellulose conversion was performed according to the procedures described in Example 3.
The result of adding increasing amounts of the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 polypeptide to the base cellulase mix are shown in FIG. 5 . Addition of the Penicillium thomii Pt1 GH61 polypeptide provided a stimulation factor of 1.11 at a 100% addition level.
The present invention is further described by the following numbered paragraphs:
[1] An isolated polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, selected from the group consisting of: (a) a polypeptide having at least 60% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6 or SEQ ID NO: 8; at least 65% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4; at least 70% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10; or at least 80% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2; (b) a polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under medium-high conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (iii) the full-length complement of (i) or (ii); (c) a polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide having at least 60% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 5 or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 65% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 70% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9; or at least 80% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof; (d) a variant of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 comprising a substitution, deletion, and/or insertion at one or more (e.g., several) positions; and (e) a fragment of the polypeptide of (a), (b), (c), or (d) that has cellulolytic enhancing activity.
[2] The polypeptide of paragraph 1, having at least 60%, at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6 or SEQ ID NO: 8; at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 4; at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 10; or at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2.
[3] The polypeptide of paragraph 1 or 2, which is encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under medium-high, high, or very high stringency conditions with (i) the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, SEQ ID NO: 7, or SEQ ID NO: 9, (ii) the genomic DNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the cDNA sequence of the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1, or (iii) the full-length complement of (i) or (ii).
[4] The polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-3, which is encoded by a polynucleotide having at least 60%, at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 5 or SEQ ID NO: 7, or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 65%, at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 3 or the genomic DNA sequence thereof; at least 70%, at least 75%, at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 9; or at least 80%, at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the mature polypeptide coding sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1 or the cDNA sequence thereof.
[5] The polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-4, comprising or consisting of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
[6] The polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-4, comprising or consisting of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10.
[7] The polypeptide of paragraph 6, wherein the mature polypeptide is amino acids 21 to 322 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 18 to 234 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 24 to 233 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 17 to 237 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 20 to 484 of SEQ ID NO: 10.
[8] The polypeptide of paragraph 1, wherein the variant of the mature polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10 comprises a substitution, deletion, and/or insertion at one or more (e.g., several) positions.
[9] The polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-4, which is a fragment of SEQ ID NO: 2, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 6, SEQ ID NO: 8, or SEQ ID NO: 10, wherein the fragment has cellulolytic enhancing activity.
[10] A composition comprising the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9.
[11] An isolated polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9.
[12] A nucleic acid construct or expression vector comprising the polynucleotide of paragraph 11 operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the production of the polypeptide in an expression host.
[13] A recombinant host cell comprising the polynucleotide of paragraph 11 operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the production of the polypeptide.
[14] A method of producing the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9, comprising cultivating a cell, which in its wild-type form produces the polypeptide, under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
[15] The method of paragraph 14, further comprising recovering the polypeptide.
[16] A method of producing a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, comprising cultivating the host cell of paragraph 13 under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
[17] The method of paragraph 16, further comprising recovering the polypeptide.
[18] A transgenic plant, plant part or plant cell transformed with a polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9.
[19] A method of producing a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, comprising cultivating the transgenic plant or plant cell of paragraph 18 under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
[20] The method of paragraph 19, further comprising recovering the polypeptide.
[21] A method of producing a mutant of a parent cell, comprising inactivating a polynucleotide encoding the polypeptide of any of paragraphs 1-9, which results in the mutant producing less of the polypeptide than the parent cell.
[22] A mutant cell produced by the method of paragraph 21.
[23] The mutant cell of paragraph 22, further comprising a gene encoding a native or heterologous protein.
[24] A method of producing a protein, comprising cultivating the mutant cell of paragraph 22 or 23 under conditions conducive for production of the protein.
[25] The method of paragraph 24, further comprising recovering the protein.
[26] A double-stranded inhibitory RNA (dsRNA) molecule comprising a subsequence of the polynucleotide of paragraph 11, wherein optionally the dsRNA is a siRNA or a miRNA molecule.
[27] The double-stranded inhibitory RNA (dsRNA) molecule of paragraph 26, which is about 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25 or more duplex nucleotides in length.
[28] A method of inhibiting the expression of a polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity in a cell, comprising administering to the cell or expressing in the cell the double-stranded inhibitory RNA (dsRNA) molecule, wherein the dsRNA of paragraph 26 or 27.
[29] A cell produced by the method of paragraph 28.
[30] The cell of paragraph 29, further comprising a gene encoding a native or heterologous protein.
[31] A method of producing a protein, comprising cultivating the cell of paragraph 29 or 30 under conditions conducive for production of the protein.
[32] The method of paragraph 31, further comprising recovering the protein.
[33] An isolated polynucleotide encoding a signal peptide comprising or consisting of amino acids 1 to 20 of SEQ ID NO: 2, amino acids 1 to 17 of SEQ ID NO: 4, amino acids 1 to 23 of SEQ ID NO: 6, amino acids 1 to 16 of SEQ ID NO: 8, or amino acids 1 to 19 of SEQ ID NO: 10.
[34] A nucleic acid construct or expression vector comprising a gene encoding a protein operably linked to the polynucleotide of paragraph 33, wherein the gene is foreign to the polynucleotide encoding the signal peptide.
[35] A recombinant host cell comprising a gene encoding a protein operably linked to the polynucleotide of paragraph 33, wherein the gene is foreign to the polynucleotide encoding the signal peptide.
[36] A method of producing a protein, comprising cultivating a recombinant host cell comprising a gene encoding a protein operably linked to the polynucleotide of paragraph 33, wherein the gene is foreign to the polynucleotide encoding the signal peptide, under conditions conducive for production of the protein.
[37] The method of paragraph 36, further comprising recovering the protein.
[38] A method for degrading or converting a cellulosic material, comprising: treating the cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of the polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of any of paragraphs 1-9.
[39] The method of paragraph 38, wherein the cellulosic material is pretreated.
[40] The method of paragraph 38 or 39, wherein the enzyme composition comprises one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an expansin, an esterase, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
[41] The method of paragraph 40, wherein the cellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase.
[42] The method of paragraph 40, wherein the hemicellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a xylanase, an acetyxylan esterase, a feruloyl esterase, an arabinofuranosidase, a xylosidase, and a glucuronidase.
[43] The method of any of paragraphs 38-42, further comprising recovering the degraded cellulosic material.
[44] The method of paragraph 43, wherein the degraded cellulosic material is a sugar.
[45] The method of paragraph 44, wherein the sugar is selected from the group consisting of glucose, xylose, mannose, galactose, and arabinose.
[46] A method for producing a fermentation product, comprising: (a) saccharifying a cellulosic material with an enzyme composition in the presence of the polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of any of paragraphs 1-9; (b) fermenting the saccharified cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms to produce the fermentation product; and (c) recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
[47] The method of paragraph 46, wherein the cellulosic material is pretreated.
[48] The method of paragraph 46 or 47, wherein the enzyme composition comprises one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an expansin, an esterase, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
[49] The method of paragraph 48, wherein the cellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase.
[50] The method of paragraph 48, wherein the hemicellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a xylanase, an acetyxylan esterase, a feruloyl esterase, an arabinofuranosidase, a xylosidase, and a glucuronidase.
[51] The method of any of paragraphs 46-50, wherein steps (a) and (b) are performed simultaneously in a simultaneous saccharification and fermentation.
[52] The method of any of paragraphs 46-51, wherein the fermentation product is an alcohol, an organic acid, a ketone, an amino acid, an alkane, a cycloalkane, an alkene, isoprene, polyketide, or a gas.
[53] A method of fermenting a cellulosic material, comprising: fermenting the cellulosic material with one or more fermenting microorganisms, wherein the cellulosic material is saccharified with an enzyme composition in the presence of the polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity of any of paragraphs 1-9.
[54] The method of paragraph 53, wherein the fermenting of the cellulosic material produces a fermentation product.
[55] The method of paragraph 54, further comprising recovering the fermentation product from the fermentation.
[56] The method of any of paragraphs 53-55, wherein the cellulosic material is pretreated before saccharification.
[57] The method of any of paragraphs 53-56, wherein the enzyme composition comprises one or more enzymes selected from the group consisting of a cellulase, a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, a hemicellulase, an expansin, an esterase, a laccase, a ligninolytic enzyme, a pectinase, a peroxidase, a protease, and a swollenin.
[58] The method of paragraph 57, wherein the cellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of an endoglucanase, a cellobiohydrolase, and a beta-glucosidase.
[59] The method of paragraph 57, wherein the hemicellulase is one or more (several) enzymes selected from the group consisting of a xylanase, an acetyxylan esterase, a feruloyl esterase, an arabinofuranosidase, a xylosidase, and a glucuronidase.
[60] The method of any of paragraphs 54-59, wherein the fermentation product is an alcohol, an organic acid, a ketone, an amino acid, an alkane, a cycloalkane, an alkene, isoprene, polyketide, or a gas.
[61] A whole broth formulation or cell culture composition comprising the polypeptide of any of claims 1-9.
The invention described and claimed herein is not to be limited in scope by the specific aspects herein disclosed, since these aspects are intended as illustrations of several aspects of the invention. Any equivalent aspects are intended to be within the scope of this invention. Indeed, various modifications of the invention in addition to those shown and described herein will become apparent to those skilled in the art from the foregoing description. Such modifications are also intended to fall within the scope of the appended claims. In the case of conflict, the present disclosure including definitions will control.
Claims (34)
1. An isolated recombinant host cell transformed with nucleic acid construct comprising a polynucleotide encoding a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, wherein the polynucleotide is operably linked to one or more control sequences that direct the production of the polypeptide, wherein the polynucleotide encoding the GH61 polypeptide is heterologous to the recombinant host cell, and wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is selected from the group consisting of:
(a) a GH61 polypeptide having at least 90% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6;
(b) a GH61 polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under high stringency conditions with (i) the full-length complement of nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i), wherein high stringency conditions are defined as prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, and washing three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 65° C.;
(c) a GH61 polypeptide encoded by (i) a polynucleotide having at least 90% sequence identity to nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i); and
(d) a fragment of the GH61 polypeptide of (a), (b), or (c), wherein the fragment has cellulolytic enhancing activity.
2. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 90% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
3. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 91% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
4. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 92% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
5. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 93% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
6. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 94% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
7. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 95% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
8. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 96% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
9. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 97% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
10. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 98% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
11. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 99% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
12. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprises (i) the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6; (ii) amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6; or (iii) a fragment of (i) or (ii) having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
13. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under high stringency conditions with (i) the full-length complement of nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i), wherein high stringency conditions are defined as prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, and washing three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 65° C.
14. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under very high stringency conditions with (i) the full-length complement of nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i), wherein very high stringency conditions are defined as prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, and washing three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 70° C.
15. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is encoded by (i) a polynucleotide comprising SEQ ID NO: 5, (ii) a polynucleotide comprising nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (iii) the cDNA of (i) or (ii).
16. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein one or more of the control sequences is heterologous to the polynucleotide encoding the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
17. A method of producing a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, comprising cultivating the recombinant host cell of claim 1 under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
18. A nucleic acid construct comprising a polynucleotide encoding a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, wherein the polynucleotide is operably linked to one or more heterologous control sequences that direct the production of the polypeptide, and wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is selected from the group consisting of:
(a) a GH61 polypeptide having at least 90% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6;
(b) a GH61 polypeptide encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under high stringency conditions with (i) the full-length complement of nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i), wherein high stringency conditions are defined as prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, and washing three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 65° C.;
(c) a GH61 polypeptide encoded by (i) a polynucleotide having at least 90% sequence identity to nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i); and
(d) a fragment of the GH61 polypeptide of (a), (b), or (c), wherein the fragment has cellulolytic enhancing activity.
19. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprises (i) the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6; (ii) amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6; or (iii) a fragment of (i) or (ii) having cellulolytic enhancing activity.
20. A method of producing a GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity, comprising cultivating a recombinant host cell transformed with the nucleic acid construct of claim 18 under conditions conducive for production of the polypeptide.
21. The recombinant host cell of claim 1 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprises amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
22. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 90% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
23. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 91% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
24. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 92% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
25. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 93% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
26. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 94% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
27. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 95% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
28. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 96% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
29. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 97% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
30. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 98% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
31. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity has at least 99% sequence identity to amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
32. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity comprises amino acids 24 to 233 of the polypeptide of SEQ ID NO: 6.
33. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under high stringency conditions with (i) the full-length complement of nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i), wherein high stringency conditions are defined as prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, and washing three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 65° C.
34. The nucleic acid construct of claim 18 , wherein the GH61 polypeptide having cellulolytic enhancing activity is encoded by a polynucleotide that hybridizes under very high stringency conditions with (i) the full-length complement of nucleotides 70 to 699 of the polynucleotide of SEQ ID NO: 5, or (ii) the cDNA of (i), wherein very high stringency conditions are defined as prehybridization and hybridization at 42° C. in 5×SSPE, 0.3% SDS, 200 micrograms/ml sheared and denatured salmon sperm DNA, and 50% formamide, and washing three times each for 15 minutes using 2×SSC, 0.2% SDS at 70° C.
Priority Applications (3)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US15/182,170 US9605037B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2016-06-14 | Recombinant host cells and nucleic acid constructs encoding polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity |
US15/439,569 US9725489B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2017-02-22 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US15/642,988 US10035828B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2017-07-06 | Methods of using polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity |
Applications Claiming Priority (4)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US201161451413P | 2011-03-10 | 2011-03-10 | |
PCT/US2012/028483 WO2012122477A1 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2012-03-09 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US201314004141A | 2013-12-04 | 2013-12-04 | |
US15/182,170 US9605037B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2016-06-14 | Recombinant host cells and nucleic acid constructs encoding polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity |
Related Parent Applications (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/US2012/028483 Division WO2012122477A1 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2012-03-09 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US14/004,141 Division US9409958B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2012-03-09 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US15/439,569 Division US9725489B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2017-02-22 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20160297856A1 US20160297856A1 (en) | 2016-10-13 |
US9605037B2 true US9605037B2 (en) | 2017-03-28 |
Family
ID=45876912
Family Applications (4)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/004,141 Expired - Fee Related US9409958B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2012-03-09 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US15/182,170 Active US9605037B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2016-06-14 | Recombinant host cells and nucleic acid constructs encoding polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity |
US15/439,569 Expired - Fee Related US9725489B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2017-02-22 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US15/642,988 Expired - Fee Related US10035828B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2017-07-06 | Methods of using polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity |
Family Applications Before (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/004,141 Expired - Fee Related US9409958B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2012-03-09 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
Family Applications After (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US15/439,569 Expired - Fee Related US9725489B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2017-02-22 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US15/642,988 Expired - Fee Related US10035828B2 (en) | 2011-03-10 | 2017-07-06 | Methods of using polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity |
Country Status (2)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (4) | US9409958B2 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2012122477A1 (en) |
Families Citing this family (46)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US9617528B2 (en) * | 2012-02-20 | 2017-04-11 | Novozymes A/S | Endoglucanase-producing recombinant host cells and methods of producing polypeptides having endoglucanase activity |
BR112014026625A2 (en) | 2012-04-27 | 2017-07-18 | Novozymes Inc E Novozymes As | polypeptide variant, isolated polynucleotide, recombinant host cell, methods for producing a polypeptide variant and for obtaining a transgenic polypeptide variant, plant, plant part or cell, processes for degradation or conversion of a cellulosic material to production of a fermentation product and for the fermentation of a cellulosic material, composition, and whole broth cell culture formulation or composition |
WO2014092832A2 (en) | 2012-09-19 | 2014-06-19 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods for enhancing the degradation or conversion of cellulosic material |
EP3586610B1 (en) | 2012-10-08 | 2024-09-25 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US20150275194A1 (en) | 2012-10-24 | 2015-10-01 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides Having Cellulolytic Enhancing Activity And Polynucleotides Encoding Same |
PL3115372T3 (en) * | 2012-11-27 | 2019-09-30 | Biomarin Pharmaceutical Inc. | Targeted therapeutic lysosomal enzyme fusion proteins and uses thereof |
CN104870639A (en) | 2012-12-14 | 2015-08-26 | 诺维信公司 | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2014099798A1 (en) | 2012-12-19 | 2014-06-26 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancinc activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2014138672A1 (en) | 2013-03-08 | 2014-09-12 | Novozymes A/S | Cellobiohydrolase variants and polynucleotides encoding same |
EP2994529B1 (en) | 2013-05-10 | 2018-11-21 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having xylanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
EP3013956B1 (en) * | 2013-06-27 | 2023-03-01 | Novozymes A/S | Subtilase variants and polynucleotides encoding same |
DK3052620T3 (en) | 2013-09-04 | 2020-09-07 | Novozymes As | PROCEDURES FOR INCREASING ENZYMATIC HYDROLYSIS OF CELLULOSIZED MATERIAL |
CN111851077A (en) * | 2013-10-25 | 2020-10-30 | 诺维信公司 | Polypeptides having endoglucanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2015081139A1 (en) | 2013-11-26 | 2015-06-04 | Novozymes A/S | Enzyme compositions and uses thereof |
EP3092312B1 (en) | 2014-01-07 | 2018-12-12 | Novozymes A/S | Saccharification of mannan-containing cellulosic materials |
EP3152315B1 (en) | 2014-06-06 | 2018-08-15 | Novozymes A/S | Enzyme compositions and uses thereof |
DK3186372T3 (en) | 2014-08-28 | 2020-12-21 | Novozymes As | Solubilization of municipal solid waste (MSW) using an enzyme mixture |
CN107002056A (en) * | 2014-09-05 | 2017-08-01 | 诺维信公司 | Carbohydrate binding module variant and the polynucleotides for encoding them |
MX2017003639A (en) | 2014-09-23 | 2017-07-13 | Novozymes As | Processes for producing ethanol and fermenting organisms. |
WO2016087445A1 (en) * | 2014-12-01 | 2016-06-09 | Novozymes A/S | Improved production of glucose syrups |
EP3262165B1 (en) | 2015-02-24 | 2020-06-03 | Novozymes A/S | Cellobiohydrolase variants and polynucleotides encoding same |
EP3268484B1 (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2020-06-17 | Novozymes A/S | Multi-stage enzymatic hydrolysis of lignocellulosic biomass |
EP3268485A1 (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2018-01-17 | Novozymes A/S | Enzymatic hydrolysis with hemicellulolytic enzymes |
BR112017018461A2 (en) | 2015-03-12 | 2018-04-17 | Novozymes As | multistage hydrolysis processes for producing a fermentation product and for increasing hydrolysis sugar yield. |
US10519520B2 (en) | 2015-05-27 | 2019-12-31 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellobiohydrolase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US20180216089A1 (en) | 2015-07-24 | 2018-08-02 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides Having Beta-Xylosidase Activity And Polynucleotides Encoding Same |
WO2017019490A1 (en) | 2015-07-24 | 2017-02-02 | Novozymes Inc. | Polypeptides having arabinofuranosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2017040907A1 (en) | 2015-09-04 | 2017-03-09 | Novozymes A/S | Methods of inhibiting aa9 lytic polysaccharide monooxygenase catalyzed inactivation of enzyme compositions |
EP3353195B1 (en) | 2015-09-22 | 2021-11-10 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellobiohydrolase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
CA2998059A1 (en) * | 2015-09-25 | 2017-03-30 | Dsm Ip Assets B.V. | Asparaginase |
WO2017070219A1 (en) | 2015-10-20 | 2017-04-27 | Novozymes A/S | Lytic polysaccharide monooxygenase (lpmo) variants and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2017076421A1 (en) | 2015-11-02 | 2017-05-11 | Renescience A/S | Solubilization of msw with blend enzymes |
BR112018015184B1 (en) | 2016-02-19 | 2022-09-06 | Intercontinental Great Brands Llc | PROCESSES TO CREATE MULTIPLE VALUE CHAINS FROM BIOMASS SOURCES |
EP4410974A2 (en) | 2016-03-02 | 2024-08-07 | Novozymes A/S | Cellobiohydrolase variants and polynucleotides encoding same |
DK3433358T3 (en) | 2016-03-24 | 2022-09-26 | Novozymes As | Cellobiohydrolase variants and polynucleotides encoding them |
WO2017205535A1 (en) | 2016-05-27 | 2017-11-30 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having endoglucanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2018026868A1 (en) | 2016-08-01 | 2018-02-08 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having endoglucanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2018085370A1 (en) | 2016-11-02 | 2018-05-11 | Novozymes A/S | Processes for reducing production of primeverose during enzymatic saccharification of lignocellulosic material |
EP3701037A1 (en) | 2017-10-23 | 2020-09-02 | Novozymes A/S | Processes for reducing lactic acid in a biofuel fermentation system |
US10975363B2 (en) * | 2018-03-30 | 2021-04-13 | Inv Nylon Chemicals Americas, Llc | Materials and methods for biosynthetic manufacture and utilization of synthetic polypeptides, and products therefrom |
WO2019201765A1 (en) | 2018-04-20 | 2019-10-24 | Renescience A/S | Method for determining chemical compounds in waste |
US10988746B2 (en) * | 2018-10-08 | 2021-04-27 | Neutrolis, Inc. | Manufacturing and engineering of DNASE enzymes for therapy |
US20220025348A1 (en) | 2018-12-12 | 2022-01-27 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides Having Xylanase Activity And Polynucleotides Encoding Same |
CN115348967A (en) * | 2019-12-03 | 2022-11-15 | 洪明奇 | Oligopeptide, detection kit thereof, pharmaceutical composition thereof and application of pharmaceutical composition |
GB202005073D0 (en) | 2020-04-06 | 2020-05-20 | Mellizyme Biotechnology Ltd | Enzymatic degradation of plastics |
AU2021374777A1 (en) | 2020-11-04 | 2023-06-15 | Renescience A/S | Method for enzymatic and/or microbial processing of waste comprising recirculation of process water |
Citations (12)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
WO2005074656A2 (en) | 2004-02-06 | 2005-08-18 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2005074647A2 (en) | 2004-01-30 | 2005-08-18 | Novozymes Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2007089290A2 (en) | 2005-09-30 | 2007-08-09 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods for enhancing the degradation or conversion of cellulosic material |
WO2008148131A1 (en) | 2007-05-31 | 2008-12-04 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2008151079A2 (en) | 2007-05-31 | 2008-12-11 | Novozymes, Inc. | Compositions for degrading cellulosic material |
WO2009085859A2 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2009085935A2 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2009085864A2 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2009085868A1 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2010065830A1 (en) | 2008-12-04 | 2010-06-10 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2010080527A1 (en) | 2008-12-19 | 2010-07-15 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods for determining cellulolytic enhancing activity of a polypeptide |
WO2012030799A1 (en) | 2010-08-30 | 2012-03-08 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
Family Cites Families (100)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
DK122686D0 (en) | 1986-03-17 | 1986-03-17 | Novo Industri As | PREPARATION OF PROTEINS |
US5989870A (en) | 1986-04-30 | 1999-11-23 | Rohm Enzyme Finland Oy | Method for cloning active promoters |
US5776757A (en) | 1988-03-24 | 1998-07-07 | Novo Nordisk A/S | Fungal cellulase composition containing alkaline CMC-endoglucanase and essentially no cellobiohydrolase and method of making thereof |
US5223409A (en) | 1988-09-02 | 1993-06-29 | Protein Engineering Corp. | Directed evolution of novel binding proteins |
AU641169B2 (en) | 1989-06-13 | 1993-09-16 | Genencor International, Inc. | A method for killing cells without cell lysis |
US5275944A (en) | 1989-09-26 | 1994-01-04 | Midwest Research Institute | Thermostable purified endoglucanas from acidothermus cellulolyticus ATCC 43068 |
US5110735A (en) | 1989-09-26 | 1992-05-05 | Midwest Research Institute | Thermostable purified endoglucanase from thermophilic bacterium acidothermus cellulolyticus |
US5536655A (en) | 1989-09-26 | 1996-07-16 | Midwest Research Institute | Gene coding for the E1 endoglucanase |
IL97645A (en) | 1990-03-23 | 1997-03-18 | Gist Brocades Nv | Production of enzymes in seeds and their use |
DK115890D0 (en) | 1990-05-09 | 1990-05-09 | Novo Nordisk As | ENZYME |
AU639570B2 (en) | 1990-05-09 | 1993-07-29 | Novozymes A/S | A cellulase preparation comprising an endoglucanase enzyme |
US6395966B1 (en) | 1990-08-09 | 2002-05-28 | Dekalb Genetics Corp. | Fertile transgenic maize plants containing a gene encoding the pat protein |
IL99552A0 (en) | 1990-09-28 | 1992-08-18 | Ixsys Inc | Compositions containing procaryotic cells,a kit for the preparation of vectors useful for the coexpression of two or more dna sequences and methods for the use thereof |
ATE412048T1 (en) | 1993-03-10 | 2008-11-15 | Novozymes As | ENZYMES WITH XYLANASE ACTIVITY FROM ASPERGILLUS ACULEATUS |
FR2704860B1 (en) | 1993-05-05 | 1995-07-13 | Pasteur Institut | NUCLEOTIDE SEQUENCES OF THE LOCUS CRYIIIA FOR THE CONTROL OF THE EXPRESSION OF DNA SEQUENCES IN A CELL HOST. |
DE4343591A1 (en) | 1993-12-21 | 1995-06-22 | Evotec Biosystems Gmbh | Process for the evolutionary design and synthesis of functional polymers based on shape elements and shape codes |
US5605793A (en) | 1994-02-17 | 1997-02-25 | Affymax Technologies N.V. | Methods for in vitro recombination |
CN1192108C (en) | 1994-06-03 | 2005-03-09 | 诺沃奇梅兹生物技术有限公司 | Purified myceliophthora laccase and nucleic acid encoding same |
ATE294871T1 (en) | 1994-06-30 | 2005-05-15 | Novozymes Biotech Inc | NON-TOXIC, NON-TOXIGEN, NON-PATHOGENIC FUSARIUM EXPRESSION SYSTEM AND PROMOTORS AND TERMINATORS FOR USE THEREIN |
US20030044956A1 (en) | 1995-08-23 | 2003-03-06 | Short Jay M. | Enzymes having carboxymethyl cellulase activity and methods of use thereof |
US6451063B1 (en) | 1996-09-25 | 2002-09-17 | Genencor International, Inc. | Cellulase for use in industrial processes |
US6017870A (en) | 1996-10-09 | 2000-01-25 | Genencor International, Inc. | Purified cellulase and method of producing |
US7883872B2 (en) | 1996-10-10 | 2011-02-08 | Dyadic International (Usa), Inc. | Construction of highly efficient cellulase compositions for enzymatic hydrolysis of cellulose |
US5811381A (en) | 1996-10-10 | 1998-09-22 | Mark A. Emalfarb | Cellulase compositions and methods of use |
WO1999006574A1 (en) | 1997-07-31 | 1999-02-11 | Dsm N.V. | Cellulose degrading enzymes of aspergillus |
US5871550A (en) | 1997-08-26 | 1999-02-16 | Genencor International, Inc. | Mutant Thermonospora spp. cellulase |
WO1999025847A2 (en) | 1997-11-19 | 1999-05-27 | Genencor International, Inc. | Cellulase produced by actinomycetes and method of producing same |
DK1038008T3 (en) | 1997-12-16 | 2007-03-12 | Genencor Int | Process for the preparation of EGIII-like enzymes |
US6506559B1 (en) | 1997-12-23 | 2003-01-14 | Carnegie Institute Of Washington | Genetic inhibition by double-stranded RNA |
US5955310A (en) | 1998-02-26 | 1999-09-21 | Novo Nordisk Biotech, Inc. | Methods for producing a polypeptide in a bacillus cell |
AU6188599A (en) | 1998-10-26 | 2000-05-15 | Novozymes A/S | Constructing and screening a dna library of interest in filamentous fungal cells |
US6511824B1 (en) | 1999-03-17 | 2003-01-28 | Exelixis, Inc. | Nucleic acids and polypeptides of invertebrate TWIK channels and methods of use |
EP2278016B1 (en) | 1999-03-22 | 2012-09-26 | Novozymes Inc. | Promoter sequences derived from Fusarium Venenatum and uses thereof |
AU5279100A (en) | 1999-05-19 | 2000-12-05 | Midwest Research Institute | E1 endoglucanase variants y245g, y82r and w42r |
US6531644B1 (en) | 2000-01-14 | 2003-03-11 | Exelixis, Inc. | Methods for identifying anti-cancer drug targets |
ES2166316B1 (en) | 2000-02-24 | 2003-02-16 | Ct Investig Energeticas Ciemat | PROCEDURE FOR THE PRODUCTION OF ETHANOL FROM LIGNOCELLULOSIC BIOMASS USING A NEW THERMOTOLERING YEAST. |
CA2412502A1 (en) | 2000-06-21 | 2001-12-27 | Novozymes A/S | Method for genome mining for secreted protein genes |
CA2425671A1 (en) | 2000-10-12 | 2002-04-18 | Exelixis, Inc. | Human ect2 and methods of use |
US7151204B2 (en) | 2001-01-09 | 2006-12-19 | Monsanto Technology Llc | Maize chloroplast aldolase promoter compositions and methods for use thereof |
US20060075519A1 (en) | 2001-05-18 | 2006-04-06 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellobiase activity and ploynucleotides encoding same |
US6982159B2 (en) | 2001-09-21 | 2006-01-03 | Genencor International, Inc. | Trichoderma β-glucosidase |
US7045331B2 (en) | 2001-12-18 | 2006-05-16 | Genencor International, Inc. | EGVII endoglucanase and nucleic acids encoding the same |
US7045332B2 (en) | 2001-12-18 | 2006-05-16 | Genencor International, Inc. | BGL4 β-glucosidase and nucleic acids encoding the same |
US7056721B2 (en) | 2001-12-18 | 2006-06-06 | Genencor International, Inc. | EGVI endoglucanase and nucleic acids encoding the same |
US7005289B2 (en) | 2001-12-18 | 2006-02-28 | Genencor International, Inc. | BGL5 β-glucosidase and nucleic acids encoding the same |
US7049125B2 (en) | 2001-12-18 | 2006-05-23 | Genencor International, Inc. | EGVIII endoglucanase and nucleic acids encoding the same |
DE60325457D1 (en) | 2002-01-23 | 2009-02-05 | Royal Nedalco B V | FERMENTATION OF PENTOSE SUGAR |
ATE432355T1 (en) | 2002-02-19 | 2009-06-15 | Novozymes As | EXPRESSION CLONING PROCESS IN FILAMENTOUS FUNGI |
DK1578943T3 (en) | 2002-08-16 | 2012-01-09 | Danisco Us Inc | New variant Hypocrea jecorina CBH1 cellulases |
DK1556512T3 (en) | 2002-11-07 | 2016-09-12 | Danisco Us Inc | BGL6 BETA-GLUCOSIDASE AND NUCLEIC ACIDS THEREOF CODED |
US7407788B2 (en) | 2002-11-21 | 2008-08-05 | Danisco A/S, Genencor Division | BGL7 beta-glucosidase and nucleic acids encoding the same |
WO2005028636A2 (en) | 2003-03-21 | 2005-03-31 | Genencor International, Inc. | Novel cbh1 homologs and variant cbh1 cellulases |
SI1627050T1 (en) | 2003-04-01 | 2014-01-31 | Danisco Us Inc. | Variant humicola grisea cbh1.1 |
WO2005001036A2 (en) | 2003-05-29 | 2005-01-06 | Genencor International, Inc. | Novel trichoderma genes |
WO2005047499A1 (en) | 2003-10-28 | 2005-05-26 | Novozymes Inc. | Polypeptides having beta-glucosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
EP1682655B1 (en) | 2003-10-30 | 2009-09-02 | Novozymes A/S | Carbohydrate-binding modules |
CN101389645B (en) | 2004-02-12 | 2016-08-03 | 诺维信股份有限公司 | There are polypeptide and its polynucleotide of coding of xylanase activity |
NZ549198A (en) | 2004-02-25 | 2009-05-31 | Novozymes As | Fungal cell wall degrading lysozyme for use as an inhibitor of dental biofilms |
BRPI0509212A (en) | 2004-03-25 | 2007-08-28 | Genencor Int | cellulase fusion protein and heterologous cellulase fusion construct encoding the same |
US8097445B2 (en) | 2004-03-25 | 2012-01-17 | Danisco Us Inc. | Exo-endo cellulase fusion protein |
DK176540B1 (en) | 2004-09-24 | 2008-07-21 | Cambi Bioethanol Aps | Process for the treatment of biomass and organic waste in order to extract desired biologically based products |
WO2006074005A2 (en) | 2004-12-30 | 2006-07-13 | Genencor International, Inc. | Variant hypocrea jecorina cbh2 cellulases |
MX2007008050A (en) | 2005-01-06 | 2007-08-21 | Novozymes Inc | Polypeptides having cellobiohydrlase activity and polynucleotides encoding same. |
CA2603128C (en) | 2005-04-12 | 2014-04-08 | E.I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company | Treatment of biomass to obtain fermentable sugars |
AR053066A1 (en) | 2005-04-26 | 2007-04-18 | Novozymes As | ARABINOFURANOSIDASAS |
DK1874927T3 (en) | 2005-04-29 | 2014-04-22 | Ab Enzymes Oy | IMPROVED CELLULASES |
JP5221347B2 (en) | 2005-08-04 | 2013-06-26 | ノボザイムス,インコーポレイティド | Polypeptide having β-glucosidase activity and polynucleotide encoding the same |
FI120045B (en) | 2005-12-22 | 2009-06-15 | Roal Oy | Treatment of cellulose materials and enzymes useful therein |
EP1969123B1 (en) | 2005-12-22 | 2017-07-12 | AB Enzymes Oy | Novel enzymes |
US8304212B2 (en) | 2006-07-10 | 2012-11-06 | Dyadic International, Inc. | Methods and compositions for degradation of lignocellulosic material |
EP2046819B1 (en) | 2006-07-21 | 2015-03-18 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods of increasing secretion of polypeptides having biological activity |
BRPI0817471A2 (en) | 2007-09-28 | 2014-10-14 | Novozymes As | ISOLATED POLYPEPTIDE, ISOLATED POLYNUCLEOTIDE, NUCLEIC ACID CONSTRUCTION, RECOMBINANT HOST CELL, METHODS TO PRODUCE A MUTANT OF A PRECURSION CELL FOR EXDUCTING A CELL FOR EXDUCTING A CELL, ACETILED, TRANSGENIC PLANT, PART OF PLANT OR PLANT CELL, AND DOUBLE FILM-INHIBITOR RNA Molecules |
BRPI0817474B1 (en) | 2007-09-28 | 2018-04-24 | Novozymes A/S | TRANSGENIC MICROBIAN HOST CELL, NUCLEIC ACID CONSTRUCTION, EXPRESSION VECTOR, DETERGENT COMPOSITION, AND METHODS FOR PRODUCING A PROTEIN, FOR DEGRADING OR CONVERTING CELLULIC MATERIAL, AND FOR PRODUCING A PRODUCT |
US7867745B2 (en) | 2007-11-27 | 2011-01-11 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having alpha-glucuronidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
EP2238243B1 (en) | 2007-11-30 | 2019-01-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having arabinofuranosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
BRPI0820102A2 (en) | 2007-12-05 | 2017-05-23 | Novozymes As | isolated polypeptide, nucleic acid construct, recombinant host cell, methods of producing the polypeptide, producing a precursor cell mutant, inhibiting expression of a polypeptide having xylanase activity in a cell, producing a protein and degrading a xylan-containing material, mutant cell, transgenic plant, plant part or plant cell, and double stranded inhibitor rna molecule |
BRPI0820615B1 (en) | 2007-12-06 | 2020-05-12 | Novozymes A/S | RECOMBINANT HOSTED MICROBIAL CELL, METHODS TO PRODUCE A POLYPEPTIDE HAVING ACETYL-XYLAN STERASE ACTIVITY, METHOD TO PRODUCE A PROTEIN AND METHOD OF DEGRADING A MATERIAL CONTAINING XYLAN |
CA2708268A1 (en) | 2007-12-07 | 2009-06-18 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having feruloyl esterase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
EP2274322A1 (en) | 2008-04-17 | 2011-01-19 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having ferulic acid esterase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
BRPI0914835B1 (en) | 2008-07-29 | 2019-04-24 | Novozymes A/S | TRANSGENIC MICROBIAN HOST CELL, METHODS FOR PRODUCING A POLYPEPTIDE AND FOR PRODUCING PROTEIN, NUCLEIC ACID CONSTRUCTIONS, AND, EXPRESSION VECTOR. |
US8071335B2 (en) | 2008-07-31 | 2011-12-06 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having acetylxylan esterase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US20110223671A1 (en) | 2008-09-30 | 2011-09-15 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods for using positively and negatively selectable genes in a filamentous fungal cell |
EP2356136A1 (en) | 2008-11-10 | 2011-08-17 | Novozymes Inc. | Polypeptides having feruloyl esterase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US8805427B2 (en) | 2008-11-14 | 2014-08-12 | Microsoft Corporation | Channel reuse with cognitive low interference signals |
US8609933B2 (en) | 2008-12-04 | 2013-12-17 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having feruloyl esterase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
CN102388134A (en) | 2009-01-28 | 2012-03-21 | 诺维信股份有限公司 | Polypeptides having beta-glucosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
BRPI1008890A2 (en) | 2009-02-20 | 2015-08-25 | Danisco Us Inc | Fermentation Broth Formulations |
WO2010108918A1 (en) | 2009-03-24 | 2010-09-30 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having acetyl xylan esterase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2010126772A1 (en) | 2009-04-30 | 2010-11-04 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having xylanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
DK2435561T3 (en) | 2009-05-29 | 2018-11-05 | Novozymes Inc | PROCEDURES FOR IMPROVING THE DEGRADATION OR CONVERSION OF CELLULOSE SUBSTANCES |
US8278507B2 (en) | 2009-06-02 | 2012-10-02 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellobiohydrolase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
BR112012000260B1 (en) | 2009-07-07 | 2020-11-17 | Novozymes A/S | transgenic microbial host cell, methods to produce a polypeptide, to produce a mutant of a precursor cell, to inhibit expression of a polypeptide, to produce a protein, to degrade or convert a cellulosic material, to produce a fermentation product, to ferment a cellulosic material, nucleic acid constructs, expression vector, isolated polypeptide having cellulolytic intensification activity, and isolated polynucleotide that encodes the same |
EP2478096B1 (en) | 2009-09-17 | 2017-05-24 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
EP2478095A1 (en) | 2009-09-18 | 2012-07-25 | Novozymes Inc. | Polypeptides having beta-glucosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
CN107338233A (en) | 2009-09-29 | 2017-11-10 | 诺维信股份有限公司 | Polypeptide with xylanase activity and the polynucleotides for encoding the polypeptide |
WO2011041397A1 (en) | 2009-09-29 | 2011-04-07 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
US8586829B2 (en) | 2009-09-30 | 2013-11-19 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
CN102695720B (en) | 2009-09-30 | 2018-02-16 | 诺维信股份有限公司 | Polypeptide with cellulolytic enhancing activity and the polynucleotides for encoding the polypeptide |
WO2011059740A1 (en) | 2009-10-29 | 2011-05-19 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellobiohydrolase activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
ES2574054T3 (en) | 2009-11-06 | 2016-06-14 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides with xylanase activity and polynucleotides that encode them |
-
2012
- 2012-03-09 US US14/004,141 patent/US9409958B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2012-03-09 WO PCT/US2012/028483 patent/WO2012122477A1/en active Application Filing
-
2016
- 2016-06-14 US US15/182,170 patent/US9605037B2/en active Active
-
2017
- 2017-02-22 US US15/439,569 patent/US9725489B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
- 2017-07-06 US US15/642,988 patent/US10035828B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
Patent Citations (13)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
WO2005074647A2 (en) | 2004-01-30 | 2005-08-18 | Novozymes Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2005074656A2 (en) | 2004-02-06 | 2005-08-18 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2007089290A2 (en) | 2005-09-30 | 2007-08-09 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods for enhancing the degradation or conversion of cellulosic material |
WO2008148131A1 (en) | 2007-05-31 | 2008-12-04 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2008151079A2 (en) | 2007-05-31 | 2008-12-11 | Novozymes, Inc. | Compositions for degrading cellulosic material |
WO2008151043A1 (en) | 2007-05-31 | 2008-12-11 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods of increasing the cellulolytic enhancing activity of a polypeptide |
WO2009085859A2 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2009085935A2 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2009085864A2 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2009085868A1 (en) | 2007-12-19 | 2009-07-09 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2010065830A1 (en) | 2008-12-04 | 2010-06-10 | Novozymes, Inc. | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
WO2010080527A1 (en) | 2008-12-19 | 2010-07-15 | Novozymes, Inc. | Methods for determining cellulolytic enhancing activity of a polypeptide |
WO2012030799A1 (en) | 2010-08-30 | 2012-03-08 | Novozymes A/S | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same |
Non-Patent Citations (5)
Title |
---|
Branden et al (eds), 1991, Introduction to Protein Structure, Garland Pub, 247. |
Harris et al, 2010, Biochem 49 (15), 3305-3316. |
Sadowski et al, 2009, Curr Opinion Struc Biol 357-362. |
Seffernick et al, 2001, J Bacteriol 183(8), 2405-2410. |
Witkowski et al, 1999, Biochem 38(36), 11643-11650. |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
US9725489B2 (en) | 2017-08-08 |
US20160297856A1 (en) | 2016-10-13 |
US9409958B2 (en) | 2016-08-09 |
US10035828B2 (en) | 2018-07-31 |
US20170166613A1 (en) | 2017-06-15 |
WO2012122477A1 (en) | 2012-09-13 |
US20140080178A1 (en) | 2014-03-20 |
US20170305977A1 (en) | 2017-10-26 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US10035828B2 (en) | Methods of using polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity | |
US10167461B2 (en) | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US9683225B2 (en) | Polypeptides having xylanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US10364423B2 (en) | Polypeptides having beta-xylosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US20150031082A1 (en) | Polypeptides Having Beta-Glucosidase Activity, Beta-Xylosidase Activity, or Beta-Glucosidase Activity and Beta-Xylosidase Activity And Polynucleotides Encoding Same | |
US10066251B2 (en) | Polypeptides having catalase activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US20200024587A1 (en) | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US9695433B2 (en) | Polypeptides having beta-xylosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US10059933B2 (en) | Polypeptides having endoglucanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US20180298362A1 (en) | Polypeptides having cellulolytic enhancing activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US10900047B2 (en) | Polypeptides having beta-xylosidase activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US20130180013A1 (en) | Polypeptides Having Xylanase Activity And Polynucleotides Encoding Same | |
US10704034B2 (en) | Polypeptides having xylanase activity and polynucleotides encoding same | |
US20140342408A1 (en) | Polypeptides Having Xylanase Activity and Polynucleotides Encoding Same | |
US20140289905A1 (en) | Polypeptides Having Xylanase Activity and Polynucleotides Encoding Same |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
STCF | Information on status: patent grant |
Free format text: PATENTED CASE |
|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF ENERGY, DISTRICT OF CO Free format text: CONFIRMATORY LICENSE;ASSIGNOR:NOVOZYMES, INC.;REEL/FRAME:049825/0593 Effective date: 20160630 |
|
MAFP | Maintenance fee payment |
Free format text: PAYMENT OF MAINTENANCE FEE, 4TH YEAR, LARGE ENTITY (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: M1551); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: LARGE ENTITY Year of fee payment: 4 |